]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
(defcustom): Doc fix.
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.11}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
363 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
364
365 @end ifinfo
366
367 @iftex
368
369 @iflatex
370 \tableofcontents
371 \gnuscleardoublepage
372 @end iflatex
373
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
379
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
384
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
390 the program.
391
392 @end iftex
393
394 @menu
395 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
396 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
397 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
398 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
399 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
400 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
401 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
402 * Various:: General purpose settings.
403 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
404 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
405 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
406 * Key Index:: Key Index.
407
408 Other related manuals
409
410 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
411 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
412 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
413 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
414
415 @detailmenu
416 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
417
418 Starting Gnus
419
420 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
421 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
422 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
423 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
424 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
425 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
426 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
427 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
428 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
429 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
430 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
431
432 New Groups
433
434 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
435 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
436 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
437
438 Group Buffer
439
440 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
441 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
442 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
443 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
444 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
445 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
446 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
447 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
448 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
449 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
450 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
451 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
452 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
453 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
454 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
455 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
456 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
457
458 Group Buffer Format
459
460 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
461 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
462 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
463
464 Group Topics
465
466 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
467 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
468 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
469 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
470 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
471
472 Misc Group Stuff
473
474 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
475 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
476 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
477 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
478 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
479
480 Summary Buffer
481
482 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
483 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
484 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
485 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
486 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
487 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
488 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
489 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
490 * Threading:: How threads are made.
491 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
492 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
493 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
494 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
495 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
496 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
497 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
498 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
499 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
500 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
501 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
502 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
503 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
504 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
505 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
506 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
507 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
508 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
509 or reselecting the current group.
510 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
511 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
512 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
513 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
514
515 Summary Buffer Format
516
517 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
518 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
519 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
520 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
521
522 Choosing Articles
523
524 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
525 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
526
527 Reply, Followup and Post
528
529 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
530 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
531 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
532 * Canceling and Superseding::
533
534 Marking Articles
535
536 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
537 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
538 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
539 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
540 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
541 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
542
543 Threading
544
545 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
546 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
547
548 Customizing Threading
549
550 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
551 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
552 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
553 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
554
555 Decoding Articles
556
557 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
558 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
559 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
560 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
561 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
562 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
563
564 Decoding Variables
565
566 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
567 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
568 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
569
570 Article Treatment
571
572 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
573 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
574 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
575 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
576 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
577 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
578 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
579 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
580 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
581 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
582 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
583
584 Alternative Approaches
585
586 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
587 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
588
589 Various Summary Stuff
590
591 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
592 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
593 * Summary Generation Commands::
594 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
595
596 Article Buffer
597
598 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
599 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
600 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
601 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
602 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
603
604 Composing Messages
605
606 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
607 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
608 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
609 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
610 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
611 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
612 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
613 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
614 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
615
616 Select Methods
617
618 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
619 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
620 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
621 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
622 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
623 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
624 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
625 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
626
627 Server Buffer
628
629 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
630 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
631 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
632 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
633 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
634 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
635 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
636
637 Getting News
638
639 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
640 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
641
642 @acronym{NNTP}
643
644 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
645 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
646 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
647
648 Getting Mail
649
650 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
651 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
652 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
653 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
654 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
655 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
656 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
657 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
658 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
659 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
660 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
661 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
662 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
663
664 Mail Sources
665
666 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
667 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
668 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
669
670 Choosing a Mail Back End
671
672 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
673 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
674 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
675 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
676 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
677 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
678 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
679
680 Browsing the Web
681
682 * Archiving Mail::
683 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
684 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
685 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
686 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
687 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
688 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
689
690 @acronym{IMAP}
691
692 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
693 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
694 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
695 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
696 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
697 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
698
699 Other Sources
700
701 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
702 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
703 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
704 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
705 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
706
707 Document Groups
708
709 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
710
711 SOUP
712
713 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
714 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
715 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
716
717 Combined Groups
718
719 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
720 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
721
722 Gnus Unplugged
723
724 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
725 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
726 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
727 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
728 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
729 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
730 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
731 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
732 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
733 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
734 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
735 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
736 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
737
738 Agent Categories
739
740 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
741 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
742 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
743
744 Agent Commands
745
746 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
747 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
748 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
749
750 Scoring
751
752 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
753 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
754 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
755 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
756 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
757 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
758 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
759 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
760 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
761 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
762 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
763 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
764 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
765 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
766 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
767 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
768 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
769
770 GroupLens
771
772 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
773 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
774 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
775 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
776
777 Advanced Scoring
778
779 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
780 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
781 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
782
783 Various
784
785 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
786 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
787 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
788 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
789 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
790 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
791 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
792 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
793 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
794 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
795 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
796 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
797 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
798 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
799 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
800 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
801 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
802 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
803 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
804 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
805 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
806
807 Formatting Variables
808
809 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
810 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
811 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
812 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
813 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
814 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
815 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
816 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
817
818 Image Enhancements
819
820 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
821 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
822 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
823 meant to be shown.
824 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
825 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
826
827 Thwarting Email Spam
828
829 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
830 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
831 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
832 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
833
834 Spam Package
835
836 * Spam Package Introduction::
837 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
838 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
839 * Spam and Ham Processors::
840 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
841 * Spam Back Ends::
842 * Extending the Spam package::
843 * Spam Statistics Package::
844
845 Spam Statistics Package
846
847 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
848 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
849 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
850
851 Appendices
852
853 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
854 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
855 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
856 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
857 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
858 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
859 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
860 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
861 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
862
863 History
864
865 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
866 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
867 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
868 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
869 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
870 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
871 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
872 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
873 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
874
875 New Features
876
877 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
878 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
879 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
880 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
881 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
882 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
883
884 Customization
885
886 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
887 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
888 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
889 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
890
891 Gnus Reference Guide
892
893 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
894 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
895 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
896 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
897 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
898 * Group Info:: The group info format.
899 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
900 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
901 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
902
903 Back End Interface
904
905 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
906 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
907 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
908 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
909 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
910 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
911
912 Various File Formats
913
914 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
915 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
916
917 Emacs for Heathens
918
919 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
920 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
921
922 @end detailmenu
923 @end menu
924
925 @node Starting Up
926 @chapter Starting Gnus
927 @cindex starting up
928
929 If you are haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs
930 for Heathens} first.
931
932 @kindex M-x gnus
933 @findex gnus
934 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
935 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
936 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
937 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
938 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
939 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
940
941 @findex gnus-other-frame
942 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
943 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
944 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
945
946 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
947 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
948 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
949
950 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
951 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
952
953 @menu
954 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
955 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
956 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
957 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
958 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
959 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
960 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
961 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
962 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
963 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
964 @end menu
965
966
967 @node Finding the News
968 @section Finding the News
969 @cindex finding news
970
971 @vindex gnus-select-method
972 @c @head
973 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
974 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
975 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
976 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
977 foreign groups.
978
979 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
980 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
981
982 @lisp
983 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
984 @end lisp
985
986 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
987
988 @lisp
989 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
990 @end lisp
991
992 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
993 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
994 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
995 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
996
997 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
998 @cindex NNTPSERVER
999 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1000 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1001 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1002 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1003 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1004 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1005 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1006
1007 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1008 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1009 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1010 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1011
1012 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1013 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1014 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1015 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1016 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1017 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1018 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1019 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1020 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1021 server.)
1022
1023 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1024 @kindex B (Group)
1025 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1026 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1027 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1028 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1029 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1030 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1031
1032 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1033 @c @head
1034 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1035 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1036 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1037 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1038 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1039 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1040 groups are.
1041
1042 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1043 you would typically set this variable to
1044
1045 @lisp
1046 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1047 @end lisp
1048
1049
1050 @node The First Time
1051 @section The First Time
1052 @cindex first time usage
1053
1054 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1055 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1056
1057 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1058 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1059 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1060 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1061 something useful.
1062
1063 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1064 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1065 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1066
1067 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1068 help you with most common problems.
1069
1070 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1071 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1072 special.
1073
1074
1075 @node The Server is Down
1076 @section The Server is Down
1077 @cindex server errors
1078
1079 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1080 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1081 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1082
1083 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1084 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1085 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1086 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1087 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1088 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1089 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1090
1091 @findex gnus-no-server
1092 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1093 @c @head
1094 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1095 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1096 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1097 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1098 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1099 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1100 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1101
1102
1103 @node Slave Gnusae
1104 @section Slave Gnusae
1105 @cindex slave
1106
1107 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1108 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1109 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1110 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1111
1112 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1113 @file{.newsrc} file.
1114
1115 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1116 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1117 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1118 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1119 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1120 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1121 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1122
1123 @findex gnus-slave
1124 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1125 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1126 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1127 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1128 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1129 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1130 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1131 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1132
1133 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1134 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1135
1136 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1137 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1138 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1139 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1140 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1141
1142
1143
1144 @node New Groups
1145 @section New Groups
1146 @cindex new groups
1147 @cindex subscription
1148
1149 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1150 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1151 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1152 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1153 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1154 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1155 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1156 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1157 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1158
1159 @menu
1160 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1161 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1162 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1163 @end menu
1164
1165
1166 @node Checking New Groups
1167 @subsection Checking New Groups
1168
1169 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1170 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1171 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1172 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1173 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1174 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1175 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1176 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1177 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1178 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1179
1180 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1181 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1182 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1183 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1184 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1185 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1186 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1187 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1188 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1189 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1190 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1191
1192 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1193 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1194 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1195 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1196 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1197 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1198
1199
1200 @node Subscription Methods
1201 @subsection Subscription Methods
1202
1203 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1204 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1205 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1206
1207 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1208 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1209
1210 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1211
1212 @table @code
1213
1214 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1216 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1217 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1218 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1219
1220 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1223 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1224
1225 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1228
1229 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1232 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1233 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1234 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1235 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1236 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1237 up. Or something like that.
1238
1239 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1242 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1243 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1244
1245 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1247 Kill all new groups.
1248
1249 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1251 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1252 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1253 topic parameter that looks like
1254
1255 @example
1256 "nnslashdot"
1257 @end example
1258
1259 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1260 that topic.
1261
1262 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1263 top-level topic.
1264
1265 @end table
1266
1267 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1268 A closely related variable is
1269 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1270 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1271 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1272 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1273 hierarchy or not.
1274
1275 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1276 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1277 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1278 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1279
1280
1281 @node Filtering New Groups
1282 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1283
1284 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1285 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1286 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1287
1288 @example
1289 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1290 @end example
1291
1292 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1293 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1294 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1295 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1296 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1297 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1298 subscribing these groups.
1299 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1300 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1301
1302 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1303 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1304 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1305 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1306 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1307 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1308 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1309 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1310
1311 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1312 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1313 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1314 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1315 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1316 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1317 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1318 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1319 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1320 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1321 @code{nil}.
1322
1323 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1324 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1325
1326
1327 @node Changing Servers
1328 @section Changing Servers
1329 @cindex changing servers
1330
1331 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1332 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1333 very flaky and you want to use another.
1334
1335 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1336 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1337
1338 @emph{Wrong!}
1339
1340 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1341 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1342 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1343 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1344 worthless.
1345
1346 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1347 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1348 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1349 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1350
1351 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1352 @findex gnus-change-server
1353 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1354 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1355 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1356 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1357 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1358
1359 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1360 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1361 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1362 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1363 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1364
1365 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1366 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1367 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1368 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1369 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1370 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1371
1372 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1373 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1374 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1375 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1376
1377 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1378 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1379 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1380 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1381 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1382 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1383 cache for all groups).
1384
1385
1386 @node Startup Files
1387 @section Startup Files
1388 @cindex startup files
1389 @cindex .newsrc
1390 @cindex .newsrc.el
1391 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1392
1393 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1394 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1395 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1396 read.
1397
1398 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1399 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1400 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1401 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1402 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1403 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1404 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1405
1406 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1407 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1408 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1409 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1410 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1411 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1412
1413 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1414 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1415 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1416 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1417 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1418 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1419 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1420 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1421 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1422 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1423 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1424 news reader.
1425
1426 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1427 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1428 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1429 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1430 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1431 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1432 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1433 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1434 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1435 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1436 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1437 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1438
1439 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1440 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1441 @vindex version-control
1442 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1443 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1444 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1445 If you want version control for this file, set
1446 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1447 @code{version-control} variable.
1448
1449 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1450 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1451 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1452 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1453 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1454 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1455 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1456 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1457 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1458 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1459
1460 @lisp
1461 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1462 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1463
1464 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1465 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1466 @end lisp
1467
1468 @vindex gnus-init-file
1469 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1470 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1471 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1472 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1473 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1474 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1475 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1476 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1477 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1478 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1479 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1480 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1481 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1482
1483
1484 @node Auto Save
1485 @section Auto Save
1486 @cindex dribble file
1487 @cindex auto-save
1488
1489 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1490 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1491 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1492 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1493 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1494 this file.
1495
1496 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1497 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1498 saved.
1499
1500 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1501 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1502 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1503
1504 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1505 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1506 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1507 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1508 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1509 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1510
1511 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1512 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1513 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1514
1515
1516 @node The Active File
1517 @section The Active File
1518 @cindex active file
1519 @cindex ignored groups
1520
1521 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1522 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1523 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1524
1525 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1526 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1527 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1528 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1529 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1530 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1531 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1532
1533 @c This variable is
1534 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1535 @c if you set it to anything else.
1536
1537 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1538 @c @head
1539 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1540 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1541 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1542
1543 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1544 you actually subscribe to.
1545
1546 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1547 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1548 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1549 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1550
1551 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1552 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1553 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1554 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1555 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1556 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1557
1558 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1559 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1560 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1561 variable.
1562
1563 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1564 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1565 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1566 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1567 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1568 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1569
1570 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1571 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1572
1573 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1574 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1575
1576 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1577 secondary select methods.
1578
1579
1580 @node Startup Variables
1581 @section Startup Variables
1582
1583 @table @code
1584
1585 @item gnus-load-hook
1586 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1587 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1588 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1589 times you start Gnus.
1590
1591 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1592 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1593 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1594
1595 @item gnus-startup-hook
1596 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1597 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1598
1599 @item gnus-started-hook
1600 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1601 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1602 successfully.
1603
1604 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1605 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1606 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1607 generating the group buffer.
1608
1609 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1610 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1611 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1612 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1613 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1614 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1615 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1616 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1617
1618 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1619 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1620 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1621 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1622 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1623 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1624
1625 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1626 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1627 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1628
1629 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1630 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1631 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1632
1633 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1634 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1635 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1636 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1637
1638 @end table
1639
1640
1641 @node Group Buffer
1642 @chapter Group Buffer
1643 @cindex group buffer
1644
1645 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1646 @c
1647 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1648 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1649 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1650 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1651 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1652 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1653 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1654 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1655 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1656 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1657 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1658 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1659 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1660 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1661 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1662 @c human rights at 9...
1663
1664
1665 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1666 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1667 long as Gnus is active.
1668
1669 @iftex
1670 @iflatex
1671 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1672 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1673 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1674 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1675 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1676 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1677 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1678 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1679 }
1680 @end iflatex
1681 @end iftex
1682
1683 @menu
1684 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1685 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1686 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1687 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1688 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1689 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1690 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1691 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1692 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1693 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1694 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1695 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1696 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1697 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1698 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1699 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1700 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1701 @end menu
1702
1703
1704 @node Group Buffer Format
1705 @section Group Buffer Format
1706
1707 @menu
1708 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1709 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1710 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1711 @end menu
1712
1713 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1714 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1715 available in Emacs.
1716
1717 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1718 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1719 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1720 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1721 Emacs version.
1722
1723 @node Group Line Specification
1724 @subsection Group Line Specification
1725 @cindex group buffer format
1726
1727 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1728 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1729
1730 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1731
1732 @example
1733 25: news.announce.newusers
1734 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1735 @end example
1736
1737 Quite simple, huh?
1738
1739 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1740 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1741 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1742 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1743
1744 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1745 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1746 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1747 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1748 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1749 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1750
1751 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1752
1753 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1754 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1755 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1756 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1757 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1758
1759 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1760 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1761 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1762
1763 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1764
1765 @table @samp
1766
1767 @item M
1768 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1769
1770 @item S
1771 Whether the group is subscribed.
1772
1773 @item L
1774 Level of subscribedness.
1775
1776 @item N
1777 Number of unread articles.
1778
1779 @item I
1780 Number of dormant articles.
1781
1782 @item T
1783 Number of ticked articles.
1784
1785 @item R
1786 Number of read articles.
1787
1788 @item U
1789 Number of unseen articles.
1790
1791 @item t
1792 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1793 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1794
1795 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1796 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1797 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1798 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1799 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1800 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1801 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1802 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1803
1804 @item y
1805 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1806
1807 @item i
1808 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1809
1810 @item g
1811 Full group name.
1812
1813 @item G
1814 Group name.
1815
1816 @item C
1817 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1818 comment element in the group parameters.
1819
1820 @item D
1821 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1822 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1823 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1824 command.
1825
1826 @item o
1827 @samp{m} if moderated.
1828
1829 @item O
1830 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1831
1832 @item s
1833 Select method.
1834
1835 @item B
1836 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1837
1838 @item n
1839 Select from where.
1840
1841 @item z
1842 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1843 used.
1844
1845 @item P
1846 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1847
1848 @item c
1849 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1850 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1851 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1852 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1853 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1854
1855 @item m
1856 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1857 @cindex %
1858 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1859 the group lately.
1860
1861 @item p
1862 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1863
1864 @item d
1865 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1866 Timestamp}).
1867
1868 @item u
1869 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1870 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1871 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1872 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1873 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1874 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1875 specifier.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 @cindex *
1879 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1880 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1881 group, or a bogus native group.
1882
1883
1884 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1885 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1886 @cindex group mode line
1887
1888 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1889 The mode line can be changed by setting
1890 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1891 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1892
1893 @table @samp
1894 @item S
1895 The native news server.
1896 @item M
1897 The native select method.
1898 @end table
1899
1900
1901 @node Group Highlighting
1902 @subsection Group Highlighting
1903 @cindex highlighting
1904 @cindex group highlighting
1905
1906 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1907 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1908 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1909 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1910 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1911
1912 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1913 background is dark:
1914
1915 @lisp
1916 (cond (window-system
1917 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1918 (defface my-group-face-1
1919 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1920 (defface my-group-face-2
1921 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1922 "Second group face")
1923 (defface my-group-face-3
1924 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-4
1926 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1927 (defface my-group-face-5
1928 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1929
1930 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1931 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1932 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1933 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1934 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1935 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1936 @end lisp
1937
1938 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1939
1940 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1941 include:
1942
1943 @table @code
1944 @item group
1945 The group name.
1946 @item unread
1947 The number of unread articles in the group.
1948 @item method
1949 The select method.
1950 @item mailp
1951 Whether the group is a mail group.
1952 @item level
1953 The level of the group.
1954 @item score
1955 The score of the group.
1956 @item ticked
1957 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1958 @item total
1959 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1960 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1961 @item topic
1962 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1963 topic being inserted.
1964 @end table
1965
1966 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1967 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1968 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1969
1970 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1971 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1972 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1973 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1974 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1975
1976
1977 @node Group Maneuvering
1978 @section Group Maneuvering
1979 @cindex group movement
1980
1981 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1982 expected, hopefully.
1983
1984 @table @kbd
1985
1986 @item n
1987 @kindex n (Group)
1988 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1989 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1990 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1991
1992 @item p
1993 @itemx DEL
1994 @kindex DEL (Group)
1995 @kindex p (Group)
1996 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1997 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1998 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1999
2000 @item N
2001 @kindex N (Group)
2002 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2003 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2004
2005 @item P
2006 @kindex P (Group)
2007 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2008 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2009
2010 @item M-n
2011 @kindex M-n (Group)
2012 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2013 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2014 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2015
2016 @item M-p
2017 @kindex M-p (Group)
2018 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2019 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2020 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2021 @end table
2022
2023 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2024
2025 @table @kbd
2026
2027 @item j
2028 @kindex j (Group)
2029 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2030 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2031 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2032 like living groups.
2033
2034 @item ,
2035 @kindex , (Group)
2036 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2037 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2038 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2039
2040 @item .
2041 @kindex . (Group)
2042 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2043 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2044 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2045 @end table
2046
2047 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2048 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2049 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2050 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2051 is @code{t}.
2052
2053
2054 @node Selecting a Group
2055 @section Selecting a Group
2056 @cindex group selection
2057
2058 @table @kbd
2059
2060 @item SPACE
2061 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2062 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2063 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2064 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2065 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2066 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2067 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2068 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2069 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2070 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2071
2072 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2073 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2074 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2075
2076 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2077 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2078 ones.
2079
2080 @item RET
2081 @kindex RET (Group)
2082 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2083 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2084 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2085 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2086 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2087 entry.
2088
2089 @item M-RET
2090 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2091 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2092 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2093 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2094 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2095 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2096 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2097 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2098 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2099 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2100
2101 @item M-SPACE
2102 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2103 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2104 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2105 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2106 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2107
2108 @item C-M-RET
2109 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2110 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2111 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2112 doing any processing of its contents
2113 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2114 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2115 manner will have no permanent effects.
2116
2117 @end table
2118
2119 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2120 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2121 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2122 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2123 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2124 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2125 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2126 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2127 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2128 most recently will be fetched.
2129
2130 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2131 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2132 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2133 newsgroups.
2134
2135 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2136 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2137 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2138 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2139 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2140 Which article this is is controlled by the
2141 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2142 variable is:
2143
2144 @table @code
2145
2146 @item unread
2147 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2148
2149 @item first
2150 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2151
2152 @item unseen
2153 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2154
2155 @item unseen-or-unread
2156 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2157 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2158 unread article.
2159
2160 @item best
2161 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2162
2163 @end table
2164
2165 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2166 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2167
2168 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2169 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2170 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2171 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2172 selected.
2173
2174
2175 @node Subscription Commands
2176 @section Subscription Commands
2177 @cindex subscription
2178
2179 @table @kbd
2180
2181 @item S t
2182 @itemx u
2183 @kindex S t (Group)
2184 @kindex u (Group)
2185 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2186 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2187 Toggle subscription to the current group
2188 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2189
2190 @item S s
2191 @itemx U
2192 @kindex S s (Group)
2193 @kindex U (Group)
2194 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2195 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2196 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2197 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2198
2199 @item S k
2200 @itemx C-k
2201 @kindex S k (Group)
2202 @kindex C-k (Group)
2203 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2204 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2205 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2206
2207 @item S y
2208 @itemx C-y
2209 @kindex S y (Group)
2210 @kindex C-y (Group)
2211 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2212 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2213
2214 @item C-x C-t
2215 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2216 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2217 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2218 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2219 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2220
2221 @item S w
2222 @itemx C-w
2223 @kindex S w (Group)
2224 @kindex C-w (Group)
2225 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2226 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2227
2228 @item S z
2229 @kindex S z (Group)
2230 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2231 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2232
2233 @item S C-k
2234 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2235 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2236 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2237 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2238 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2239 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2240 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2241 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2242 @file{.newsrc} file.
2243
2244 @end table
2245
2246 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2247
2248
2249 @node Group Data
2250 @section Group Data
2251
2252 @table @kbd
2253
2254 @item c
2255 @kindex c (Group)
2256 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2257 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2258 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2259 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2260 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2261 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2262 the group buffer.
2263
2264 @item C
2265 @kindex C (Group)
2266 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2267 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2268 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2269
2270 @item M-c
2271 @kindex M-c (Group)
2272 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2273 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2274 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2275
2276 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2277 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2278 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2279 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2280 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2281 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2282 caution.
2283
2284 @end table
2285
2286
2287 @node Group Levels
2288 @section Group Levels
2289 @cindex group level
2290 @cindex level
2291
2292 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2293 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2294 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2295 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2296 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2297
2298 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2299
2300 @table @kbd
2301
2302 @item S l
2303 @kindex S l (Group)
2304 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2305 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2306 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2307 prompted for a level.
2308 @end table
2309
2310 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2311 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2312 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2313 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2314 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2315 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2316 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2317 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2318 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2319 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2320 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2321 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2322 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2323 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2324 reasons of efficiency.
2325
2326 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2327 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2328
2329 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2330 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2331 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2332 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2333 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2334 groups are hidden, in a way.
2335
2336 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2337 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2338 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2339 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2340 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2341 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2342
2343 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2344 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2345 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2346 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2347 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2348 list of killed groups.)
2349
2350 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2351 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2352 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2353
2354 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2355 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2356 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2357 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2358 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2359 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2360 relevant valid ranges.
2361
2362 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2363 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2364 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2365 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2366 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2367 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2368 rest.
2369
2370 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2371 one with the best level.
2372
2373 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2374 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2375 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2376 by default.
2377
2378 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2379 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2380 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2381 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2382 listed.
2383
2384 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2385 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2386 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2387 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2388
2389 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2390 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2391 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2392 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2393 to 5. The default is 6.
2394
2395
2396 @node Group Score
2397 @section Group Score
2398 @cindex group score
2399 @cindex group rank
2400 @cindex rank
2401
2402 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2403 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2404 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2405 reason?
2406
2407 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2408 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2409 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2410 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2411 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2412 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2413 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2414 least significant part.))
2415
2416 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2417 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2418 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2419 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2420 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2421 action after each summary exit, you can add
2422 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2423 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2424 slow things down somewhat.
2425
2426
2427 @node Marking Groups
2428 @section Marking Groups
2429 @cindex marking groups
2430
2431 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2432 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2433 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2434 bidding on those groups.
2435
2436 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2437 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2438 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2439
2440 @table @kbd
2441
2442 @item #
2443 @kindex # (Group)
2444 @itemx M m
2445 @kindex M m (Group)
2446 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2447 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2448
2449 @item M-#
2450 @kindex M-# (Group)
2451 @itemx M u
2452 @kindex M u (Group)
2453 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2454 Remove the mark from the current group
2455 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2456
2457 @item M U
2458 @kindex M U (Group)
2459 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2460 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2461
2462 @item M w
2463 @kindex M w (Group)
2464 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2465 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2466
2467 @item M b
2468 @kindex M b (Group)
2469 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2470 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2471
2472 @item M r
2473 @kindex M r (Group)
2474 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2475 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2476 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2477 @end table
2478
2479 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2480
2481 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2482 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2483 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2484 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2485 the command to be executed.
2486
2487
2488 @node Foreign Groups
2489 @section Foreign Groups
2490 @cindex foreign groups
2491
2492 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2493 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2494 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2495 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2496 consulted.
2497
2498 @table @kbd
2499
2500 @item G m
2501 @kindex G m (Group)
2502 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2503 @cindex making groups
2504 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2505 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2506 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2507
2508 @item G M
2509 @kindex G M (Group)
2510 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2511 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2512 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2513
2514 @item G r
2515 @kindex G r (Group)
2516 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2517 @cindex renaming groups
2518 Rename the current group to something else
2519 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2520 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2521 on some back ends.
2522
2523 @item G c
2524 @kindex G c (Group)
2525 @cindex customizing
2526 @findex gnus-group-customize
2527 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2528
2529 @item G e
2530 @kindex G e (Group)
2531 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2532 @cindex renaming groups
2533 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2534 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2535
2536 @item G p
2537 @kindex G p (Group)
2538 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2539 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2540 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2541
2542 @item G E
2543 @kindex G E (Group)
2544 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2545 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2546 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2547
2548 @item G d
2549 @kindex G d (Group)
2550 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2551 @cindex nndir
2552 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2553 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2554
2555 @item G h
2556 @kindex G h (Group)
2557 @cindex help group
2558 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2559 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2560
2561 @item G a
2562 @kindex G a (Group)
2563 @cindex (ding) archive
2564 @cindex archive group
2565 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2566 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2567 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2568 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2569 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2570 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2571 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2572
2573 @item G k
2574 @kindex G k (Group)
2575 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2576 @cindex nnkiboze
2577 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2578 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2579 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2580 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2581
2582 @item G D
2583 @kindex G D (Group)
2584 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2585 @cindex nneething
2586 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2587 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2588 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2589
2590 @item G f
2591 @kindex G f (Group)
2592 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2593 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2594 @cindex nndoc
2595 Make a group based on some file or other
2596 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2597 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2598 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2599 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2600 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2601 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2602 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2603 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2604 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2605
2606 @item G u
2607 @kindex G u (Group)
2608 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2609 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2610 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2611 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2612
2613 @item G w
2614 @kindex G w (Group)
2615 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2616 @cindex Google
2617 @cindex nnweb
2618 @cindex gmane
2619 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2620 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2621 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2622 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2623 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2624 @xref{Web Searches}.
2625
2626 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2627 to a particular group by using a match string like
2628 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2629
2630 @item G R
2631 @kindex G R (Group)
2632 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2633 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2634 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2635 @xref{RSS}.
2636
2637 @item G DEL
2638 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2639 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2640 This function will delete the current group
2641 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2642 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2643 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2644 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2645 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2646
2647 @item G V
2648 @kindex G V (Group)
2649 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2650 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2651 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2652
2653 @item G v
2654 @kindex G v (Group)
2655 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2656 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2657 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2658 @end table
2659
2660 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2661 methods.
2662
2663 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2664 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2665 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2666 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2667 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2668 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2669 newsgroups.
2670
2671
2672 @node Group Parameters
2673 @section Group Parameters
2674 @cindex group parameters
2675
2676 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2677 Here's an example group parameter list:
2678
2679 @example
2680 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2681 (auto-expire . t))
2682 @end example
2683
2684 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2685 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2686 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2687 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2688
2689 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2690 is an alist of regexps and values.
2691
2692 The following group parameters can be used:
2693
2694 @table @code
2695 @item to-address
2696 @cindex to-address
2697 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2698
2699 @example
2700 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2701 @end example
2702
2703 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2704 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2705 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2706 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2707 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2708
2709 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2710 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2711 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2712 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2713 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2714 list address instead.
2715
2716 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2717
2718 @item to-list
2719 @cindex to-list
2720 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2721
2722 @example
2723 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2724 @end example
2725
2726 It is totally ignored
2727 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2728 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2729
2730 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2731 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2732 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2733 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2734 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2735
2736 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2737 @cindex mail list groups
2738 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2739 entering summary buffer.
2740
2741 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2742
2743 @anchor{subscribed}
2744 @item subscribed
2745 @cindex subscribed
2746 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2747 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2748 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2749 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2750 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2751 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2752 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2753 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2754
2755 @lisp
2756 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2757 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2758 @end lisp
2759
2760 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2761 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2762
2763 @item visible
2764 @cindex visible
2765 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2766 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2767 of whether it has any unread articles.
2768
2769 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2770 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2771
2772 @item broken-reply-to
2773 @cindex broken-reply-to
2774 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2775 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2776 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2777 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2778 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2779 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2780
2781 @item to-group
2782 @cindex to-group
2783 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2784 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2785
2786 @item newsgroup
2787 @cindex newsgroup
2788 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2789 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2790 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2791 news group.
2792
2793 @item gcc-self
2794 @cindex gcc-self
2795 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2796 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2797 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2798 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2799 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2800 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2801 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2802
2803 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2804 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2805 doesn't accept articles.
2806
2807 @item auto-expire
2808 @cindex auto-expire
2809 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2810 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2811 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2812
2813 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2814
2815 @item total-expire
2816 @cindex total-expire
2817 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2818 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2819 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2820 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2821 expiry.
2822
2823 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2824
2825 @item expiry-wait
2826 @cindex expiry-wait
2827 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2828 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2829 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2830 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2831 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2832 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2833 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2834
2835 @item expiry-target
2836 @cindex expiry-target
2837 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2838 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2839
2840 @item score-file
2841 @cindex score file group parameter
2842 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2843 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2844 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2845
2846 @item adapt-file
2847 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2848 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2849 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2850 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2851
2852 @item admin-address
2853 @cindex admin-address
2854 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2855 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2856 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2857 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2858
2859 @item display
2860 @cindex display
2861 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2862 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2863
2864 @table @code
2865 @item all
2866 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2867
2868 @item an integer
2869 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2870 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2871
2872 @item default
2873 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2874 ticked articles.
2875
2876 @item an array
2877 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2878
2879 Here are some examples:
2880
2881 @table @code
2882 @item [unread]
2883 Display only unread articles.
2884
2885 @item [not expire]
2886 Display everything except expirable articles.
2887
2888 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2889 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2890 responded to.
2891 @end table
2892
2893 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2894 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2895 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2896 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2897 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2898
2899 @end table
2900
2901 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2902 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2903 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2904
2905 @item comment
2906 @cindex comment
2907 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2908 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2909 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2910
2911 @item charset
2912 @cindex charset
2913 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2914 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2915 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2916
2917 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2918
2919 @item ignored-charsets
2920 @cindex ignored-charset
2921 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2922 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2923 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2924
2925 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2926
2927 @item posting-style
2928 @cindex posting-style
2929 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2930 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2931 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2932 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2933 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2934
2935 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2936 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2937 like this in the group parameters:
2938
2939 @example
2940 (posting-style
2941 (name "Funky Name")
2942 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2943 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2944 @end example
2945
2946 @item post-method
2947 @cindex post-method
2948 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2949 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2950
2951 @item banner
2952 @cindex banner
2953 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2954 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2955 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2956 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2957 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2958
2959 @item sieve
2960 @cindex sieve
2961 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2962 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2963 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2964 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2965
2966 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2967 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2968 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2969 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2970
2971 @example
2972 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2973 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2974 @}
2975 @end example
2976
2977 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2978 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2979
2980 @item (agent parameters)
2981 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2982 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2983 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2984 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2985 minimize the configuration effort.
2986
2987 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2988 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2989 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2990 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2991 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2992 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2993 @code{eval}ed there.
2994
2995 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2996 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2997 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2998 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2999 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3000 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3001 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3002 @file{~/.gnus} file:
3003
3004 @lisp
3005 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3006 @end lisp
3007
3008 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3009 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3010 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3011
3012 @example
3013 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3014 @end example
3015
3016 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3017 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3018 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3019 into the group parameters for the group.
3020
3021 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3022 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3023 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3024 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3025 @code{(ding)} form.
3026
3027 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3028 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3029 following is added to a group parameter
3030
3031 @lisp
3032 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3033 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3034 @end lisp
3035
3036 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3037 expired.
3038
3039 @end table
3040
3041 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3042 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3043 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3044 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3045 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3046
3047 @vindex gnus-parameters
3048 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3049 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3050 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3051 For example:
3052
3053 @lisp
3054 (setq gnus-parameters
3055 '(("mail\\..*"
3056 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3057 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3058 (gnus-summary-line-format
3059 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3060 (gcc-self . t)
3061 (display . all))
3062
3063 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3064 (to-group . "\\1"))
3065
3066 ("mail\\.me"
3067 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3068
3069 ("list\\..*"
3070 (total-expire . t)
3071 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3072 @end lisp
3073
3074 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3075 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3076
3077 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3078 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3079 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3080 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3081 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3082 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3083 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3084 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3085 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3086 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3087 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3088 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3089
3090
3091 @node Listing Groups
3092 @section Listing Groups
3093 @cindex group listing
3094
3095 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3096
3097 @table @kbd
3098
3099 @item l
3100 @itemx A s
3101 @kindex A s (Group)
3102 @kindex l (Group)
3103 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3104 List all groups that have unread articles
3105 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3106 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3107 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3108 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3109 groups).
3110
3111 @item L
3112 @itemx A u
3113 @kindex A u (Group)
3114 @kindex L (Group)
3115 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3116 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3117 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3118 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3119 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3120 unsubscribed groups).
3121
3122 @item A l
3123 @kindex A l (Group)
3124 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3125 List all unread groups on a specific level
3126 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3127 with no unread articles.
3128
3129 @item A k
3130 @kindex A k (Group)
3131 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3132 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3133 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3134 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3135 from the server.
3136
3137 @item A z
3138 @kindex A z (Group)
3139 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3140 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3141
3142 @item A m
3143 @kindex A m (Group)
3144 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3145 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3146 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3147
3148 @item A M
3149 @kindex A M (Group)
3150 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3151 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3152
3153 @item A A
3154 @kindex A A (Group)
3155 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3156 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3157 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3158 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3159 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3160 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3161 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3162 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3163
3164 @item A a
3165 @kindex A a (Group)
3166 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3167 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3168 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3169
3170 @item A d
3171 @kindex A d (Group)
3172 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3173 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3174 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3175
3176 @item A c
3177 @kindex A c (Group)
3178 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3179 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3180
3181 @item A ?
3182 @kindex A ? (Group)
3183 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3184 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3185
3186 @item A /
3187 @kindex A / (Group)
3188 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3189 List groups limited within the current selection
3190 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3191
3192 @item A f
3193 @kindex A f (Group)
3194 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3195 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3196
3197 @item A p
3198 @kindex A p (Group)
3199 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3200 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3201
3202 @end table
3203
3204 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3205 @cindex visible group parameter
3206 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3207 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3208 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3209 get the same effect.
3210
3211 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3212 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3213 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3214 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3215 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3216
3217
3218 @node Sorting Groups
3219 @section Sorting Groups
3220 @cindex sorting groups
3221
3222 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3223 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3224 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3225 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3226 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3227 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3228 include:
3229
3230 @table @code
3231
3232 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3233 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3234 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3235
3236 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3237 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3238 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3239
3240 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3241 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3242 Sort by group level.
3243
3244 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3245 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3246 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3247
3248 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3249 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3250 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3251 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3252
3253 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3254 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3255 Sort by number of unread articles.
3256
3257 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3258 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3259 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3260
3261 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3262 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3263 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3264
3265
3266 @end table
3267
3268 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3269 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3270 the last one.
3271
3272
3273 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3274 some sorting criteria:
3275
3276 @table @kbd
3277 @item G S a
3278 @kindex G S a (Group)
3279 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3280 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3281 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3282
3283 @item G S u
3284 @kindex G S u (Group)
3285 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3286 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3287 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3288
3289 @item G S l
3290 @kindex G S l (Group)
3291 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3292 Sort the group buffer by group level
3293 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3294
3295 @item G S v
3296 @kindex G S v (Group)
3297 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3298 Sort the group buffer by group score
3299 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3300
3301 @item G S r
3302 @kindex G S r (Group)
3303 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3304 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3305 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3306
3307 @item G S m
3308 @kindex G S m (Group)
3309 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3310 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3311 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3312
3313 @item G S n
3314 @kindex G S n (Group)
3315 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3316 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3317 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3318
3319 @end table
3320
3321 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3322 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3323
3324 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3325 commands will sort in reverse order.
3326
3327 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3328
3329 @table @kbd
3330 @item G P a
3331 @kindex G P a (Group)
3332 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3333 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3334 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3335
3336 @item G P u
3337 @kindex G P u (Group)
3338 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3339 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3340 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3341
3342 @item G P l
3343 @kindex G P l (Group)
3344 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3345 Sort the groups by group level
3346 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3347
3348 @item G P v
3349 @kindex G P v (Group)
3350 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3351 Sort the groups by group score
3352 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3353
3354 @item G P r
3355 @kindex G P r (Group)
3356 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3357 Sort the groups by group rank
3358 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3359
3360 @item G P m
3361 @kindex G P m (Group)
3362 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3363 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3364 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3365
3366 @item G P n
3367 @kindex G P n (Group)
3368 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3369 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3370 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3371
3372 @item G P s
3373 @kindex G P s (Group)
3374 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3375 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3376
3377 @end table
3378
3379 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3380 move groups around.
3381
3382
3383 @node Group Maintenance
3384 @section Group Maintenance
3385 @cindex bogus groups
3386
3387 @table @kbd
3388 @item b
3389 @kindex b (Group)
3390 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3391 Find bogus groups and delete them
3392 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3393
3394 @item F
3395 @kindex F (Group)
3396 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3397 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3398 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3399 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3400 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3401 zombies.
3402
3403 @item C-c C-x
3404 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3405 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3406 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3407 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3408 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3409 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3410
3411 @item C-c C-M-x
3412 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3413 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3414 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3415 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3416
3417 @end table
3418
3419
3420 @node Browse Foreign Server
3421 @section Browse Foreign Server
3422 @cindex foreign servers
3423 @cindex browsing servers
3424
3425 @table @kbd
3426 @item B
3427 @kindex B (Group)
3428 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3429 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3430 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3431 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3432 @end table
3433
3434 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3435 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3436 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3437 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3438
3439 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3440
3441 @table @kbd
3442 @item n
3443 @kindex n (Browse)
3444 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3445 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3446
3447 @item p
3448 @kindex p (Browse)
3449 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3450 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3451
3452 @item SPACE
3453 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3454 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3455 Enter the current group and display the first article
3456 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3457
3458 @item RET
3459 @kindex RET (Browse)
3460 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3461 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3462
3463 @item u
3464 @kindex u (Browse)
3465 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3466 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3467 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3468
3469 @item l
3470 @itemx q
3471 @kindex q (Browse)
3472 @kindex l (Browse)
3473 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3474 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3475
3476 @item d
3477 @kindex d (Browse)
3478 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3479 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3480
3481 @item ?
3482 @kindex ? (Browse)
3483 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3484 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3485 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3486 @end table
3487
3488
3489 @node Exiting Gnus
3490 @section Exiting Gnus
3491 @cindex exiting Gnus
3492
3493 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3494
3495 @table @kbd
3496 @item z
3497 @kindex z (Group)
3498 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3499 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3500 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3501 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3502
3503 @item q
3504 @kindex q (Group)
3505 @findex gnus-group-exit
3506 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3507 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3508
3509 @item Q
3510 @kindex Q (Group)
3511 @findex gnus-group-quit
3512 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3513 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3514 @end table
3515
3516 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3517 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3518 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3519 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3520 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3521 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3522 exiting Gnus.
3523
3524 Note:
3525
3526 @quotation
3527 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3528 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3529 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3530 plastic chair.
3531 @end quotation
3532
3533
3534 @node Group Topics
3535 @section Group Topics
3536 @cindex topics
3537
3538 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3539 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3540 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3541 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3542 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3543 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3544
3545 @iftex
3546 @iflatex
3547 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3548 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3549 }
3550 @end iflatex
3551 @end iftex
3552
3553 Here's an example:
3554
3555 @example
3556 Gnus
3557 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3558 3: comp.emacs
3559 2: alt.religion.emacs
3560 Naughty Emacs
3561 452: alt.sex.emacs
3562 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3563 Misc
3564 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3565 13: comp.sources.unix
3566 @end example
3567
3568 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3569 @kindex t (Group)
3570 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3571 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3572 is a toggling command.)
3573
3574 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3575 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3576 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3577 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3578 Hot and bothered?
3579
3580 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3581 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3582 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3583
3584 @lisp
3585 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3586 @end lisp
3587
3588 @menu
3589 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3590 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3591 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3592 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3593 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3594 @end menu
3595
3596
3597 @node Topic Commands
3598 @subsection Topic Commands
3599 @cindex topic commands
3600
3601 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3602 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3603 definitions slightly.
3604
3605 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3606 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3607 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3608 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3609 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3610 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3611
3612 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3613 the way you like.
3614
3615 @table @kbd
3616
3617 @item T n
3618 @kindex T n (Topic)
3619 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3620 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3621 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3622
3623 @item T TAB
3624 @itemx TAB
3625 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3626 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3627 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3628 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3629 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3630 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3631
3632 @item M-TAB
3633 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3634 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3635 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3636 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3637
3638 @end table
3639
3640 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3641 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3642 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3643 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3644
3645 @table @kbd
3646
3647 @item C-k
3648 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3649 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3650 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3651 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3652
3653 @item C-y
3654 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3655 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3656 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3657 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3658 before all groups.
3659
3660 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3661 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3662 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3663 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3664 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3665
3666 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3667 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3668
3669 @end table
3670
3671 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3672 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3673 key.
3674
3675 @table @kbd
3676
3677 @item RET
3678 @kindex RET (Topic)
3679 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3680 @itemx SPACE
3681 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3682 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3683 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3684 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3685 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3686 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3687
3688 @end table
3689
3690 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3691
3692 @table @kbd
3693
3694 @item T m
3695 @kindex T m (Topic)
3696 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3697 Move the current group to some other topic
3698 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3699 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3700
3701 @item T j
3702 @kindex T j (Topic)
3703 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3704 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3705
3706 @item T c
3707 @kindex T c (Topic)
3708 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3709 Copy the current group to some other topic
3710 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3711 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3712
3713 @item T h
3714 @kindex T h (Topic)
3715 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3716 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3717 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3718
3719 @item T s
3720 @kindex T s (Topic)
3721 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3722 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3723 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3724
3725 @item T D
3726 @kindex T D (Topic)
3727 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3728 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3729 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3730 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3731 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3732 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3733 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3734 topic.
3735
3736 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3737 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3738
3739 @item T M
3740 @kindex T M (Topic)
3741 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3742 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3743 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3744
3745 @item T C
3746 @kindex T C (Topic)
3747 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3748 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3749 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3750
3751 @item T H
3752 @kindex T H (Topic)
3753 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3754 Toggle hiding empty topics
3755 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3756
3757 @item T #
3758 @kindex T # (Topic)
3759 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3760 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3761 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3762 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3763
3764 @item T M-#
3765 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3766 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3767 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3768 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3769 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3770
3771 @item C-c C-x
3772 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3773 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3774 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3775 expiry process (if any)
3776 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3777
3778 @item T r
3779 @kindex T r (Topic)
3780 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3781 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3782
3783 @item T DEL
3784 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3785 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3786 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3787
3788 @item A T
3789 @kindex A T (Topic)
3790 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3791 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3792 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3793
3794 @item T M-n
3795 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3796 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3797 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3798
3799 @item T M-p
3800 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3801 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3802 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3803
3804 @item G p
3805 @kindex G p (Topic)
3806 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3807 @cindex group parameters
3808 @cindex topic parameters
3809 @cindex parameters
3810 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3811 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3812
3813 @end table
3814
3815
3816 @node Topic Variables
3817 @subsection Topic Variables
3818 @cindex topic variables
3819
3820 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3821 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3822
3823 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3824 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3825 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3826 Valid elements are:
3827
3828 @table @samp
3829 @item i
3830 Indentation.
3831 @item n
3832 Topic name.
3833 @item v
3834 Visibility.
3835 @item l
3836 Level.
3837 @item g
3838 Number of groups in the topic.
3839 @item a
3840 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3841 @item A
3842 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3843 @end table
3844
3845 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3846 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3847 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3848 The default is 2.
3849
3850 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3851 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3852
3853 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3854 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3855 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3856
3857
3858 @node Topic Sorting
3859 @subsection Topic Sorting
3860 @cindex topic sorting
3861
3862 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3863 commands:
3864
3865
3866 @table @kbd
3867 @item T S a
3868 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3869 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3870 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3871 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3872
3873 @item T S u
3874 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3875 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3876 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3877 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3878
3879 @item T S l
3880 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3881 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3882 Sort the current topic by group level
3883 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3884
3885 @item T S v
3886 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3887 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3888 Sort the current topic by group score
3889 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3890
3891 @item T S r
3892 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3893 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3894 Sort the current topic by group rank
3895 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3896
3897 @item T S m
3898 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3899 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3900 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3901 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3902
3903 @item T S e
3904 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3905 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3906 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3907 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3908
3909 @item T S s
3910 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3911 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3912 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3913 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3914 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3915
3916 @end table
3917
3918 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3919 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3920 sorting.
3921
3922
3923 @node Topic Topology
3924 @subsection Topic Topology
3925 @cindex topic topology
3926 @cindex topology
3927
3928 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3929
3930 @example
3931 @group
3932 Gnus
3933 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3934 3: comp.emacs
3935 2: alt.religion.emacs
3936 Naughty Emacs
3937 452: alt.sex.emacs
3938 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3939 Misc
3940 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3941 13: comp.sources.unix
3942 @end group
3943 @end example
3944
3945 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3946 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3947 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3948 follows:
3949
3950 @lisp
3951 (("Gnus" visible)
3952 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3953 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3954 (("Misc" visible)))
3955 @end lisp
3956
3957 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3958 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3959 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3960 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3961 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3962 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3963
3964 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3965 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3966 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3967
3968
3969 @node Topic Parameters
3970 @subsection Topic Parameters
3971 @cindex topic parameters
3972
3973 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3974 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3975 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3976 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3977 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3978
3979 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3980 parameters:
3981
3982 @table @code
3983 @item subscribe
3984 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3985 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3986 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3987 topic.
3988
3989 @item subscribe-level
3990 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3991 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3992 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3993
3994 @end table
3995
3996 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3997 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3998 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3999 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4000
4001 @example
4002 @group
4003 Gnus
4004 Emacs
4005 3: comp.emacs
4006 2: alt.religion.emacs
4007 452: alt.sex.emacs
4008 Relief
4009 452: alt.sex.emacs
4010 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4011 Misc
4012 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4013 13: comp.sources.unix
4014 452: alt.sex.emacs
4015 @end group
4016 @end example
4017
4018 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4019 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4020 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4021 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4022 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4023 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4024
4025 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4026 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4027 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4028 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4029 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4030
4031 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4032 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4033 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4034 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4035 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4036 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4037 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4038 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4039
4040
4041 @node Misc Group Stuff
4042 @section Misc Group Stuff
4043
4044 @menu
4045 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4046 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4047 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4048 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4049 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4050 @end menu
4051
4052 @table @kbd
4053
4054 @item v
4055 @kindex v (Group)
4056 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4057 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
4058 function or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4059
4060 @lisp
4061 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4062 (lambda ()
4063 (interactive)
4064 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4065 @end lisp
4066
4067 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4068 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4069
4070 @item ^
4071 @kindex ^ (Group)
4072 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4073 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4074 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4075
4076 @item a
4077 @kindex a (Group)
4078 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4079 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4080 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4081 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4082 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4083 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4084 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4085
4086 @item m
4087 @kindex m (Group)
4088 @findex gnus-group-mail
4089 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4090 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4091 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4092 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4093
4094 @item i
4095 @kindex i (Group)
4096 @findex gnus-group-news
4097 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4098 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4099 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4100
4101 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4102 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4103 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4104 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4105 for this to work though.
4106
4107 @end table
4108
4109 Variables for the group buffer:
4110
4111 @table @code
4112
4113 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4114 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4115 is called after the group buffer has been
4116 created.
4117
4118 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4119 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4120 is called after the group buffer is
4121 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4122 unnatural way.
4123
4124 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4125 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4126 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4127 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4128
4129 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4130 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4131 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4132 whether they are empty or not.
4133
4134 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4135 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4136 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4137 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4138
4139 For example:
4140 @lisp
4141 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4142 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4143 @end lisp
4144
4145 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4146 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4147 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4148 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4149 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4150 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4151 default is @code{nil}.
4152
4153 For example:
4154 @lisp
4155 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4156 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4157 @end lisp
4158
4159 @end table
4160
4161 @node Scanning New Messages
4162 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4163 @cindex new messages
4164 @cindex scanning new news
4165
4166 @table @kbd
4167
4168 @item g
4169 @kindex g (Group)
4170 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4171 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4172 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4173 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4174 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4175 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4176 back end(s).
4177
4178 @item M-g
4179 @kindex M-g (Group)
4180 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4181 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4182 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4183 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4184 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4185 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4186 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4187
4188 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4189 @cindex activating groups
4190 @item C-c M-g
4191 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4192 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4193
4194 @item R
4195 @kindex R (Group)
4196 @cindex restarting
4197 @findex gnus-group-restart
4198 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4199 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4200 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4201
4202 @end table
4203
4204 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4205 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4206
4207 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4208 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4209 news.
4210
4211
4212 @node Group Information
4213 @subsection Group Information
4214 @cindex group information
4215 @cindex information on groups
4216
4217 @table @kbd
4218
4219
4220 @item H f
4221 @kindex H f (Group)
4222 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4223 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4224 @cindex FAQ
4225 @cindex ange-ftp
4226 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4227 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4228 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4229 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4230 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4231 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4232 used for fetching the file.
4233
4234 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4235 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4236
4237 @item H c
4238 @kindex H c (Group)
4239 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4240 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4241 @cindex charter
4242 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4243 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4244 prefix argument.
4245
4246 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4247 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4248 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4249
4250 @item H C
4251 @kindex H C (Group)
4252 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4253 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4254 @cindex control message
4255 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4256 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4257 group if given a prefix argument.
4258
4259 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4260 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4261 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4262 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4263
4264 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4265 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4266 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4267
4268 @item H d
4269 @itemx C-c C-d
4270 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4271 @kindex H d (Group)
4272 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4273 @cindex describing groups
4274 @cindex group description
4275 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4276 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4277 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4278
4279 @item M-d
4280 @kindex M-d (Group)
4281 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4282 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4283 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4284
4285 @item H v
4286 @itemx V
4287 @kindex V (Group)
4288 @kindex H v (Group)
4289 @cindex version
4290 @findex gnus-version
4291 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4292
4293 @item ?
4294 @kindex ? (Group)
4295 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4296 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4297
4298 @item C-c C-i
4299 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4300 @cindex info
4301 @cindex manual
4302 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4303 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4304 @end table
4305
4306
4307 @node Group Timestamp
4308 @subsection Group Timestamp
4309 @cindex timestamps
4310 @cindex group timestamps
4311
4312 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4313 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4314 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4315
4316 @lisp
4317 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4318 @end lisp
4319
4320 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4321
4322 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4323 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4324
4325 @lisp
4326 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4327 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4328 @end lisp
4329
4330 This will result in lines looking like:
4331
4332 @example
4333 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4334 0: custom 19961002T012713
4335 @end example
4336
4337 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4338 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4339 something like:
4340
4341 @lisp
4342 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4343 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4344 @end lisp
4345
4346 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4347 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4348 trick:
4349
4350 @lisp
4351 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4352 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4353 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4354 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4355 (if time
4356 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4357 "")))
4358 @end lisp
4359
4360
4361 @node File Commands
4362 @subsection File Commands
4363 @cindex file commands
4364
4365 @table @kbd
4366
4367 @item r
4368 @kindex r (Group)
4369 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4370 @vindex gnus-init-file
4371 @cindex reading init file
4372 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4373 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4374
4375 @item s
4376 @kindex s (Group)
4377 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4378 @cindex saving .newsrc
4379 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4380 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4381 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4382
4383 @c @item Z
4384 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4385 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4386 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4387
4388 @end table
4389
4390
4391 @node Sieve Commands
4392 @subsection Sieve Commands
4393 @cindex group sieve commands
4394
4395 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4396 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4397 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4398 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4399 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4400
4401 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4402 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4403 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4404 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4405 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4406 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4407 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4408 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4409 regenerate the Sieve script.
4410
4411 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4412 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4413 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4414 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4415 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4416 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4417 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4418 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4419 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4420 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4421
4422 @example
4423 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4424 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4425 stop;
4426 @}
4427 @end example
4428
4429 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4430
4431 @table @kbd
4432
4433 @item D g
4434 @kindex D g (Group)
4435 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4436 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4437 @cindex generating sieve script
4438 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4439 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4440
4441 @item D u
4442 @kindex D u (Group)
4443 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4444 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4445 @cindex updating sieve script
4446 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4447 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4448 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4449
4450 @end table
4451
4452
4453 @node Summary Buffer
4454 @chapter Summary Buffer
4455 @cindex summary buffer
4456
4457 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4458 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4459
4460 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4461 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4462
4463 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4464
4465 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4466 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4467 available in Emacs.
4468
4469 @kindex v (Summary)
4470 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4471 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
4472 function or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4473 @lisp
4474 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4475 @end lisp
4476
4477 @menu
4478 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4479 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4480 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4481 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4482 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4483 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4484 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4485 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4486 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4487 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4488 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4489 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4490 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4491 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4492 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4493 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4494 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4495 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4496 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4497 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4498 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4499 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4500 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4501 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4502 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4503 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4504 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4505 or reselecting the current group.
4506 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4507 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4508 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4509 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4510 @end menu
4511
4512
4513 @node Summary Buffer Format
4514 @section Summary Buffer Format
4515 @cindex summary buffer format
4516
4517 @iftex
4518 @iflatex
4519 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4520 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4521 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4522 }
4523 @end iflatex
4524 @end iftex
4525
4526 @menu
4527 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4528 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4529 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4530 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4531 @end menu
4532
4533 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4534 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4535 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4536 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4537 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4538 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4539 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4540 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4541 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4542 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4543 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4544
4545 @lisp
4546 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4547 'mail-extract-address-components)
4548 @end lisp
4549
4550 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4551 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4552 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4553 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4554
4555
4556 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4557 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4558
4559 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4560 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4561 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4562 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4563 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4564
4565 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4566 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4567 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4568 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4569 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4570 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4571
4572 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4573
4574 The following format specification characters and extended format
4575 specification(s) are understood:
4576
4577 @table @samp
4578 @item N
4579 Article number.
4580 @item S
4581 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4582 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4583 @item s
4584 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4585 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4586 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4587 @item F
4588 Full @code{From} header.
4589 @item n
4590 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4591 @item f
4592 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4593 From Newsgroups}).
4594 @item a
4595 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4596 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4597 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4598 may be more thorough.
4599 @item A
4600 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4601 the @code{a} spec.
4602 @item L
4603 Number of lines in the article.
4604 @item c
4605 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4606 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4607 @item k
4608 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4609 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4610 @item I
4611 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4612 @item B
4613 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4614 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4615
4616 @example
4617 >
4618 +->
4619 | +->
4620 | | \->
4621 | | \->
4622 | \->
4623 +->
4624 \->
4625 @end example
4626
4627 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4628 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4629 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4630 line-drawing glyphs.
4631 @table @code
4632 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4633 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4634 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4635 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4636
4637 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4638 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4639 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4640 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4641
4642 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4643 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4644 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4645 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4646
4647 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4648 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4649 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4650
4651 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4652 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4653 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4654
4655 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4656 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4657 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4658
4659 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4660 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4661 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4662
4663 @end table
4664
4665 @item T
4666 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4667 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4668 @item [
4669 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4670 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4671 @item ]
4672 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4673 for adopted articles.
4674 @item >
4675 One space for each thread level.
4676 @item <
4677 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4678 @item U
4679 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4680
4681 @item R
4682 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4683 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4684 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4685
4686 @item i
4687 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4688 @item z
4689 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4690 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4691 default level. If the difference between
4692 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4693 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4694 @item V
4695 Total thread score.
4696 @item x
4697 @code{Xref}.
4698 @item D
4699 @code{Date}.
4700 @item d
4701 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4702 @item o
4703 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4704 @item M
4705 @code{Message-ID}.
4706 @item r
4707 @code{References}.
4708 @item t
4709 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4710 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4711 @item e
4712 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4713 article has any children.
4714 @item P
4715 The line number.
4716 @item O
4717 Download mark.
4718 @item *
4719 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4720 @item &user-date;
4721 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4722 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4723 @item u
4724 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4725 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4726 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4727 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4728 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4729 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4730 @end table
4731
4732 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4733 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4734 There can only be one such area.
4735
4736 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4737 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4738 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4739 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4740 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4741 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4742
4743 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4744 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4745
4746 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4747
4748
4749 @node To From Newsgroups
4750 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4751 @cindex To
4752 @cindex Newsgroups
4753
4754 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4755 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4756 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4757 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4758 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4759
4760 @enumerate
4761 @item
4762 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4763 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4764 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4765 instance:
4766
4767 @lisp
4768 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4769 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4770 @end lisp
4771
4772 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4773 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4774
4775 @item
4776 @findex gnus-extra-header
4777 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4778 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4779 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4780
4781 @example
4782 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4783 @end example
4784
4785 @item
4786 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4787 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4788 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4789 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4790 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4791 headers are used instead.
4792
4793 @end enumerate
4794
4795 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4796 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4797 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4798 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4799 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4800 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4801 regeneration.
4802
4803 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4804 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4805 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4806 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4807
4808 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4809 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4810
4811 @lisp
4812 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4813 '(To Newsgroups))
4814 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4815 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4816 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4817 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4818 "Your Name Here")
4819 @end lisp
4820
4821 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4822 to fit your needs.)
4823
4824 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4825 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4826 support:
4827
4828 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4829 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4830 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4831
4832 @example
4833 Newsgroups:full
4834 @end example
4835
4836 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4837 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4838
4839
4840 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4841 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4842
4843 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4844 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4845 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4846 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4847
4848 Here are the elements you can play with:
4849
4850 @table @samp
4851 @item G
4852 Group name.
4853 @item p
4854 Unprefixed group name.
4855 @item A
4856 Current article number.
4857 @item z
4858 Current article score.
4859 @item V
4860 Gnus version.
4861 @item U
4862 Number of unread articles in this group.
4863 @item e
4864 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4865 summary buffer.
4866 @item Z
4867 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4868 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4869 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4870 and no unselected ones.
4871 @item g
4872 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4873 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4874 @item S
4875 Subject of the current article.
4876 @item u
4877 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4878 @item s
4879 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4880 @item d
4881 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4882 @item t
4883 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4884 @item r
4885 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4886 @item E
4887 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4888 @end table
4889
4890
4891 @node Summary Highlighting
4892 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4893
4894 @table @code
4895
4896 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4897 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4898 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4899 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4900 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4901
4902 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4903 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4904 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4905 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4906
4907 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4908 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4909 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4910 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4911
4912 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4913 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4914 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4915 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4916 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4917 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4918 to something like
4919 @lisp
4920 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4921 ((> score default) . bold))
4922 @end lisp
4923 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4924 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4925 @end table
4926
4927
4928 @node Summary Maneuvering
4929 @section Summary Maneuvering
4930 @cindex summary movement
4931
4932 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4933 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4934
4935 None of these commands select articles.
4936
4937 @table @kbd
4938 @item G M-n
4939 @itemx M-n
4940 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4941 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4942 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4943 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4944 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4945
4946 @item G M-p
4947 @itemx M-p
4948 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4949 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4950 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4951 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4952 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4953
4954 @item G g
4955 @kindex G g (Summary)
4956 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4957 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4958 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4959 @end table
4960
4961 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4962 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4963 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4964 to the group buffer.
4965
4966 Variables related to summary movement:
4967
4968 @table @code
4969
4970 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4971 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4972 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4973 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4974 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4975 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4976 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4977 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4978 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4979 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4980 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4981 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4982 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4983 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4984
4985 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4986 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4987 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4988 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4989 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4990 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4991 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4992
4993 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4994
4995 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4996 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4997 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4998 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4999 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5000
5001 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5002 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5003 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5004 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5005 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5006 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5007 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5008 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5009 threads.
5010
5011 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5012 the given number of lines from the top.
5013
5014 @end table
5015
5016
5017 @node Choosing Articles
5018 @section Choosing Articles
5019 @cindex selecting articles
5020
5021 @menu
5022 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5023 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5024 @end menu
5025
5026
5027 @node Choosing Commands
5028 @subsection Choosing Commands
5029
5030 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5031 and they all select and display an article.
5032
5033 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5034 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5035
5036 @table @kbd
5037 @item SPACE
5038 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5039 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5040 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5041 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5042
5043 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5044 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5045 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5046
5047 @item G n
5048 @itemx n
5049 @kindex n (Summary)
5050 @kindex G n (Summary)
5051 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5052 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5053 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5054
5055 @item G p
5056 @itemx p
5057 @kindex p (Summary)
5058 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5059 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5060 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5061
5062 @item G N
5063 @itemx N
5064 @kindex N (Summary)
5065 @kindex G N (Summary)
5066 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5067 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5068
5069 @item G P
5070 @itemx P
5071 @kindex P (Summary)
5072 @kindex G P (Summary)
5073 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5074 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5075
5076 @item G C-n
5077 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5078 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5079 Go to the next article with the same subject
5080 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5081
5082 @item G C-p
5083 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5084 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5085 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5086 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5087
5088 @item G f
5089 @itemx .
5090 @kindex G f (Summary)
5091 @kindex . (Summary)
5092 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5093 Go to the first unread article
5094 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5095
5096 @item G b
5097 @itemx ,
5098 @kindex G b (Summary)
5099 @kindex , (Summary)
5100 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5101 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5102 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5103 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5104
5105 @item G l
5106 @itemx l
5107 @kindex l (Summary)
5108 @kindex G l (Summary)
5109 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5110 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5111
5112 @item G o
5113 @kindex G o (Summary)
5114 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5115 @cindex history
5116 @cindex article history
5117 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5118 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5119 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5120 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5121 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5122 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5123
5124 @item G j
5125 @itemx j
5126 @kindex j (Summary)
5127 @kindex G j (Summary)
5128 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5129 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5130 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5131
5132 @end table
5133
5134
5135 @node Choosing Variables
5136 @subsection Choosing Variables
5137
5138 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5139
5140 @table @code
5141 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5142 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5143 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5144 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5145 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5146 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5147
5148 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5149 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5150 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5151 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5152 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5153 hook will do so.
5154
5155 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5156 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5157 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5158 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5159 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5160 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5161 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5162 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5163 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5164 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5165 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5166 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5167 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5168 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5169
5170 @end table
5171
5172
5173 @node Paging the Article
5174 @section Scrolling the Article
5175 @cindex article scrolling
5176
5177 @table @kbd
5178
5179 @item SPACE
5180 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5181 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5182 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5183 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5184 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5185
5186 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5187 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5188 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5189 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5190 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5191 what is considered uninteresting with
5192 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5193 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5194
5195 @item DEL
5196 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5197 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5198 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5199
5200 @item RET
5201 @kindex RET (Summary)
5202 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5203 Scroll the current article one line forward
5204 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5205
5206 @item M-RET
5207 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5208 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5209 Scroll the current article one line backward
5210 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5211
5212 @item A g
5213 @itemx g
5214 @kindex A g (Summary)
5215 @kindex g (Summary)
5216 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5217 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5218 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5219 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5220 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5221 the way it came from the server.
5222
5223 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5224 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5225 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5226
5227 @lisp
5228 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5229 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5230 (2 . big5)))
5231 @end lisp
5232
5233 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5234
5235 @item A <
5236 @itemx <
5237 @kindex < (Summary)
5238 @kindex A < (Summary)
5239 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5240 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5241 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5242
5243 @item A >
5244 @itemx >
5245 @kindex > (Summary)
5246 @kindex A > (Summary)
5247 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5248 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5249
5250 @item A s
5251 @itemx s
5252 @kindex A s (Summary)
5253 @kindex s (Summary)
5254 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5255 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5256 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5257
5258 @item h
5259 @kindex h (Summary)
5260 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5261 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5262
5263 @end table
5264
5265
5266 @node Reply Followup and Post
5267 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5268
5269 @menu
5270 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5271 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5272 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5273 * Canceling and Superseding::
5274 @end menu
5275
5276
5277 @node Summary Mail Commands
5278 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5279 @cindex mail
5280 @cindex composing mail
5281
5282 Commands for composing a mail message:
5283
5284 @table @kbd
5285
5286 @item S r
5287 @itemx r
5288 @kindex S r (Summary)
5289 @kindex r (Summary)
5290 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5291 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5292 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5293 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5294 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5295
5296 @item S R
5297 @itemx R
5298 @kindex R (Summary)
5299 @kindex S R (Summary)
5300 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5301 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5302 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5303 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5304 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5305
5306 @item S w
5307 @kindex S w (Summary)
5308 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5309 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5310 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5311 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5312 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5313 present, that's used instead.
5314
5315 @item S W
5316 @kindex S W (Summary)
5317 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5318 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5319 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5320 the process/prefix convention.
5321
5322 @item S v
5323 @kindex S v (Summary)
5324 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5325 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5326 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5327 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5328 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5329 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5330
5331 @item S V
5332 @kindex S V (Summary)
5333 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5334 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5335 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5336 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5337
5338 @item S B r
5339 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5340 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5341 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5342 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5343 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5344 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5345 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5346 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5347
5348 @item S B R
5349 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5350 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5351 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5352 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5353 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5354
5355 @item S o m
5356 @itemx C-c C-f
5357 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5358 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5359 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5360 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5361 Forward the current article to some other person
5362 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5363 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5364 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5365 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5366 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5367 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5368 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5369 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5370 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5371 section.
5372
5373 @item S m
5374 @itemx m
5375 @kindex m (Summary)
5376 @kindex S m (Summary)
5377 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5378 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5379 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5380 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5381 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5382
5383 @item S i
5384 @itemx i
5385 @kindex i (Summary)
5386 @kindex S i (Summary)
5387 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5388 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5389 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5390 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5391
5392 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5393 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5394 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5395 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5396 for this to work though.
5397
5398 @item S D b
5399 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5400 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5401 @cindex bouncing mail
5402 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5403 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5404 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5405 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5406 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5407 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5408 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5409 very well fail, though.
5410
5411 @item S D r
5412 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5413 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5414 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5415 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5416 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5417 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5418 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5419 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5420 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5421 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5422
5423 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5424 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5425 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5426 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5427 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5428
5429 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5430 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5431
5432 @item S D e
5433 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5434 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5435
5436 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5437 if it were a new message before resending.
5438
5439 @item S O m
5440 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5441 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5442 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5443 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5444 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5445
5446 @item S M-c
5447 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5448 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5449 @cindex crossposting
5450 @cindex excessive crossposting
5451 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5452 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5453
5454 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5455 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5456 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5457 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5458 command understands the process/prefix convention
5459 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5460
5461 @end table
5462
5463 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5464 Manual}, for more information.
5465
5466
5467 @node Summary Post Commands
5468 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5469 @cindex post
5470 @cindex composing news
5471
5472 Commands for posting a news article:
5473
5474 @table @kbd
5475 @item S p
5476 @itemx a
5477 @kindex a (Summary)
5478 @kindex S p (Summary)
5479 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5480 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5481 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5482 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5483 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5484
5485 @item S f
5486 @itemx f
5487 @kindex f (Summary)
5488 @kindex S f (Summary)
5489 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5490 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5491 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5492
5493 @item S F
5494 @itemx F
5495 @kindex S F (Summary)
5496 @kindex F (Summary)
5497 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5498 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5499 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5500 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5501 process/prefix convention.
5502
5503 @item S n
5504 @kindex S n (Summary)
5505 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5506 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5507 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5508
5509 @item S N
5510 @kindex S N (Summary)
5511 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5512 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5513 message through mail and include the original message
5514 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5515 the process/prefix convention.
5516
5517 @item S o p
5518 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5519 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5520 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5521 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5522 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5523 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5524 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5525 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5526 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5527 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5528 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5529 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5530 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5531
5532 @item S O p
5533 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5534 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5535 @cindex digests
5536 @cindex making digests
5537 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5538 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5539 process/prefix convention.
5540
5541 @item S u
5542 @kindex S u (Summary)
5543 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5544 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5545 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5546 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5547 @end table
5548
5549 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5550 Manual}, for more information.
5551
5552
5553 @node Summary Message Commands
5554 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5555
5556 @table @kbd
5557 @item S y
5558 @kindex S y (Summary)
5559 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5560 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5561 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5562 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5563 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5564
5565 @end table
5566
5567
5568 @node Canceling and Superseding
5569 @subsection Canceling Articles
5570 @cindex canceling articles
5571 @cindex superseding articles
5572
5573 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5574 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5575
5576 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5577
5578 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5579 @kindex C (Summary)
5580 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5581 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5582 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5583 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5584 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5585 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5586
5587 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5588 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5589 question.
5590
5591 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5592 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5593 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5594
5595 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5596 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5597 message, Message Manual}).
5598
5599 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5600 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5601 your original article.
5602
5603 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5604 @kindex S (Summary)
5605 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5606 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5607 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5608 usual way.
5609
5610 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5611 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5612 have posted almost the same article twice.
5613
5614 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5615 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5616 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5617 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5618 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5619 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5620 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5621 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5622 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5623 canceled/superseded.
5624
5625 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5626
5627 @node Delayed Articles
5628 @section Delayed Articles
5629 @cindex delayed sending
5630 @cindex send delayed
5631
5632 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5633 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5634 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5635 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5636
5637 @lisp
5638 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5639 @end lisp
5640
5641 @findex gnus-delay-article
5642 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5643 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5644 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5645 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5646
5647 @itemize @bullet
5648 @item
5649 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5650 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5651 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5652 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5653
5654 @item
5655 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5656 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5657 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5658
5659 @item
5660 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5661 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5662 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5663 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5664 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5665 that means a time tomorrow.
5666 @end itemize
5667
5668 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5669 couple of variables:
5670
5671 @table @code
5672 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5673 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5674 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5675 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5676
5677 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5678 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5679 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5680 formats described above.
5681
5682 @item gnus-delay-group
5683 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5684 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5685 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5686 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5687
5688 @item gnus-delay-header
5689 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5690 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5691 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5692 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5693 @end table
5694
5695 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5696 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5697 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5698 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5699 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5700
5701 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5702 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5703 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5704 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5705 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5706 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5707 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5708
5709 @table @code
5710 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5711 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5712 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5713 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5714 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5715 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5716 argument is ignored.
5717
5718 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5719 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5720 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5721 @end table
5722
5723
5724 @node Marking Articles
5725 @section Marking Articles
5726 @cindex article marking
5727 @cindex article ticking
5728 @cindex marks
5729
5730 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5731
5732 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5733 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5734 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5735
5736 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5737
5738 @ifinfo
5739 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5740 @end ifinfo
5741
5742 @menu
5743 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5744 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5745 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5746 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5747 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5748 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5749 @end menu
5750
5751
5752 @node Unread Articles
5753 @subsection Unread Articles
5754
5755 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5756 other.
5757
5758 @table @samp
5759 @item !
5760 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5761 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5762
5763 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5764 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5765 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5766 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5767 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5768 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5769 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5770
5771 @item ?
5772 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5773 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5774
5775 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5776 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5777 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5778 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5779 messages.
5780
5781 @item SPACE
5782 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5783 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5784
5785 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5786 @end table
5787
5788
5789 @node Read Articles
5790 @subsection Read Articles
5791 @cindex expirable mark
5792
5793 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5794
5795 @table @samp
5796
5797 @item r
5798 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5799 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5800 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5801
5802 @item R
5803 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5804 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5805
5806 @item O
5807 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5808 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5809 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5810
5811 @item K
5812 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5813 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5814
5815 @item X
5816 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5817 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5818
5819 @item Y
5820 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5821 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5822
5823 @item C
5824 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5825 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5826
5827 @item G
5828 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5829 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5830
5831 @item F
5832 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5833 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5834
5835 @item Q
5836 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5837 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5838 Threading}.
5839
5840 @item M
5841 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5842 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5843 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5844
5845 @end table
5846
5847 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5848 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5849
5850 One more special mark, though:
5851
5852 @table @samp
5853 @item E
5854 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5855 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5856
5857 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5858 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5859 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5860 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5861 any time.
5862 @end table
5863
5864
5865 @node Other Marks
5866 @subsection Other Marks
5867 @cindex process mark
5868 @cindex bookmarks
5869
5870 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5871 read or not.
5872
5873 @itemize @bullet
5874
5875 @item
5876 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5877 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5878 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5879 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5880 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5881
5882 @item
5883 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5884 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5885 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5886 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5887
5888 @item
5889 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5890 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5891 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5892
5893 @item
5894 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5895 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5896 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5897
5898 @item
5899 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5900 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5901 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5902 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5903
5904 @item
5905 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5906 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5907 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5908 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5909 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5910 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5911
5912 @item
5913 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5914 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5915 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5916 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5917
5918 @item
5919 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5920 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5921 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5922 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5923 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5924 use.)
5925
5926 @item
5927 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5928 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5929 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5930 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5931 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5932 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5933
5934 @item
5935 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5936 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5937 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5938 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5939 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5940 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5941 use.)
5942
5943 @item
5944 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5945 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5946 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5947 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5948 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5949
5950 @item
5951 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5952 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5953 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5954 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5955 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5956 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5957
5958 @end itemize
5959
5960 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5961 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5962 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5963
5964 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5965 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5966 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5967
5968
5969 @node Setting Marks
5970 @subsection Setting Marks
5971 @cindex setting marks
5972
5973 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5974
5975 @table @kbd
5976 @item M c
5977 @itemx M-u
5978 @kindex M c (Summary)
5979 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5980 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5981 @cindex mark as unread
5982 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5983 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5984 article as unread.
5985
5986 @item M t
5987 @itemx !
5988 @kindex ! (Summary)
5989 @kindex M t (Summary)
5990 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5991 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5992 @xref{Article Caching}.
5993
5994 @item M ?
5995 @itemx ?
5996 @kindex ? (Summary)
5997 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5998 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5999 Mark the current article as dormant
6000 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6001
6002 @item M d
6003 @itemx d
6004 @kindex M d (Summary)
6005 @kindex d (Summary)
6006 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6007 Mark the current article as read
6008 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6009
6010 @item D
6011 @kindex D (Summary)
6012 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6013 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6014 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6015
6016 @item M k
6017 @itemx k
6018 @kindex k (Summary)
6019 @kindex M k (Summary)
6020 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6021 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6022 and then select the next unread article
6023 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6024
6025 @item M K
6026 @itemx C-k
6027 @kindex M K (Summary)
6028 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6029 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6030 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6031 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6032
6033 @item M C
6034 @kindex M C (Summary)
6035 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6036 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6037 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6038
6039 @item M C-c
6040 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6041 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6042 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6043 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6044
6045 @item M H
6046 @kindex M H (Summary)
6047 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6048 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6049 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6050
6051 @item M h
6052 @kindex M h (Summary)
6053 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6054 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6055 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6056
6057 @item C-w
6058 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6059 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6060 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6061 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6062
6063 @item M V k
6064 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6065 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6066 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6067 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6068
6069 @item M e
6070 @itemx E
6071 @kindex M e (Summary)
6072 @kindex E (Summary)
6073 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6074 Mark the current article as expirable
6075 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6076
6077 @item M b
6078 @kindex M b (Summary)
6079 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6080 Set a bookmark in the current article
6081 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6082
6083 @item M B
6084 @kindex M B (Summary)
6085 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6086 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6087 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6088
6089 @item M V c
6090 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6091 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6092 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6093 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6094
6095 @item M V u
6096 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6097 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6098 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6099 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6100
6101 @item M V m
6102 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6103 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6104 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6105 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6106 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6107 @end table
6108
6109 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6110 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6111 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6112 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6113 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6114 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6115 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6116 The default is @code{t}.
6117
6118
6119 @node Generic Marking Commands
6120 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6121
6122 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6123 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6124 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6125 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6126 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6127 well.
6128
6129 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6130 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6131 command should do.
6132
6133 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6134 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6135 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6136 to list in this manual.
6137
6138 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6139 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6140 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6141 article, you could say something like:
6142
6143 @lisp
6144 @group
6145 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6146 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6147 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6148 @end group
6149 @end lisp
6150
6151 @noindent
6152 or
6153
6154 @lisp
6155 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6156 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6157 @end lisp
6158
6159
6160 @node Setting Process Marks
6161 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6162 @cindex setting process marks
6163
6164 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6165 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6166 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6167 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6168 commands into the cache. For more information,
6169 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6170
6171 @table @kbd
6172
6173 @item M P p
6174 @itemx #
6175 @kindex # (Summary)
6176 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6177 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6178 Mark the current article with the process mark
6179 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6180 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6181
6182 @item M P u
6183 @itemx M-#
6184 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6185 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6186 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6187 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6188
6189 @item M P U
6190 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6191 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6192 Remove the process mark from all articles
6193 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6194
6195 @item M P i
6196 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6197 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6198 Invert the list of process marked articles
6199 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6200
6201 @item M P R
6202 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6203 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6204 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6205 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6206
6207 @item M P G
6208 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6209 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6210 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6211 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6212
6213 @item M P r
6214 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6215 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6216 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6217
6218 @item M P g
6219 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6220 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6221 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6222
6223 @item M P t
6224 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6225 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6226 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6227 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6228
6229 @item M P T
6230 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6231 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6232 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6233 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6234
6235 @item M P v
6236 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6237 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6238 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6239 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6240
6241 @item M P s
6242 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6243 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6244 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6245
6246 @item M P S
6247 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6248 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6249 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6250 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6251
6252 @item M P a
6253 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6255 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6256
6257 @item M P b
6258 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6259 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6260 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6261 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6262
6263 @item M P k
6264 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6265 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6266 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6267 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6268
6269 @item M P y
6270 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6271 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6272 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6273 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6274
6275 @item M P w
6276 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6277 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6278 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6279 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6280
6281 @end table
6282
6283 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6284 set process marks based on article body contents.
6285
6286
6287 @node Limiting
6288 @section Limiting
6289 @cindex limiting
6290
6291 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6292 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6293 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6294 buffer.
6295
6296 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6297 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6298 additional articles.
6299
6300 @table @kbd
6301
6302 @item / /
6303 @itemx / s
6304 @kindex / / (Summary)
6305 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6306 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6307 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6308 matching articles.
6309
6310 @item / a
6311 @kindex / a (Summary)
6312 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6313 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6314 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6315 matching articles.
6316
6317 @item / x
6318 @kindex / x (Summary)
6319 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6320 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6321 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6322 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6323 matching articles.
6324
6325 @item / u
6326 @itemx x
6327 @kindex / u (Summary)
6328 @kindex x (Summary)
6329 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6330 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6331 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6332 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6333 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6334
6335 @item / m
6336 @kindex / m (Summary)
6337 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6338 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6339 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6340
6341 @item / t
6342 @kindex / t (Summary)
6343 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6344 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6345 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6346 articles younger than that number of days.
6347
6348 @item / n
6349 @kindex / n (Summary)
6350 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6351 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6352 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6353 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6354
6355 @item / w
6356 @kindex / w (Summary)
6357 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6358 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6359 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6360 the stack.
6361
6362 @item / .
6363 @kindex / . (Summary)
6364 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6365 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6366 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6367
6368 @item / v
6369 @kindex / v (Summary)
6370 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6371 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6372 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6373
6374 @item / p
6375 @kindex / p (Summary)
6376 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6377 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6378 group parameter predicate
6379 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6380 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6381
6382 @item / E
6383 @itemx M S
6384 @kindex M S (Summary)
6385 @kindex / E (Summary)
6386 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6387 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6388 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6389
6390 @item / D
6391 @kindex / D (Summary)
6392 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6393 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6394 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6395
6396 @item / *
6397 @kindex / * (Summary)
6398 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6399 Include all cached articles in the limit
6400 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6401
6402 @item / d
6403 @kindex / d (Summary)
6404 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6405 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6406 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6407
6408 @item / M
6409 @kindex / M (Summary)
6410 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6411 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6412
6413 @item / T
6414 @kindex / T (Summary)
6415 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6416 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6417
6418 @item / c
6419 @kindex / c (Summary)
6420 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6421 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6422 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6423
6424 @item / C
6425 @kindex / C (Summary)
6426 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6427 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6428 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6429 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6430
6431 @item / N
6432 @kindex / N (Summary)
6433 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6434 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6435 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6436
6437 @item / o
6438 @kindex / o (Summary)
6439 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6440 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6441 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6442
6443 @end table
6444
6445
6446 @node Threading
6447 @section Threading
6448 @cindex threading
6449 @cindex article threading
6450
6451 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6452 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6453 hierarchical fashion.
6454
6455 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6456 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6457 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6458 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6459 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6460 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6461 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6462
6463 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6464
6465 @table @dfn
6466 @item root
6467 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6468
6469 @item thread
6470 A tree-like article structure.
6471
6472 @item sub-thread
6473 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6474
6475 @item loose threads
6476 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6477 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6478 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6479 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6480 called loose threads.
6481
6482 @item thread gathering
6483 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6484
6485 @item sparse threads
6486 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6487 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6488
6489 @end table
6490
6491
6492 @menu
6493 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6494 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6495 @end menu
6496
6497
6498 @node Customizing Threading
6499 @subsection Customizing Threading
6500 @cindex customizing threading
6501
6502 @menu
6503 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6504 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6505 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6506 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6507 @end menu
6508
6509
6510 @node Loose Threads
6511 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6512 @cindex <
6513 @cindex >
6514 @cindex loose threads
6515
6516 @table @code
6517 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6518 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6519 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6520 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6521 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6522 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6523
6524 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6525 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6526 There are four possible values:
6527
6528 @iftex
6529 @iflatex
6530 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6531 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6532 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6533 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6534 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6535 }
6536 @end iflatex
6537 @end iftex
6538
6539 @cindex adopting articles
6540
6541 @table @code
6542
6543 @item adopt
6544 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6545 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6546 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6547 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6548
6549 @item dummy
6550 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6551 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6552 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6553 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6554 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6555 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6556 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6557 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6558 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6559 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6560
6561 @item empty
6562 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6563 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6564 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6565 Buffer Format}).)
6566
6567 @item none
6568 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6569 display them after one another.
6570
6571 @item nil
6572 Don't gather loose threads.
6573 @end table
6574
6575 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6576 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6577 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6578 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6579 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6580 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6581 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6582 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6583 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6584 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6585 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6586
6587 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6588 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6589 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6590 Matching}).
6591
6592 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6593 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6594 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6595 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6596 simplification is used.
6597
6598 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6599 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6600 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6601 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6602
6603 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6604 @lisp
6605 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6606 (concat
6607 "\\`\\[?\\("
6608 (mapconcat
6609 'identity
6610 '("looking"
6611 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6612 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6613 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6614 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6615 ;; ...
6616 )
6617 "\\|")
6618 "\\)\\s *\\("
6619 (mapconcat 'identity
6620 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6621 "\\|")
6622 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6623 @end lisp
6624
6625 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6626 subjects.
6627
6628 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6629 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6630 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6631 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6632 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6633 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6634
6635 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6636
6637 @table @code
6638 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6639 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6640 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6641
6642 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6643 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6644 Simplify fuzzily.
6645
6646 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6647 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6648 Remove excessive whitespace.
6649
6650 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6651 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6652 Remove all whitespace.
6653 @end table
6654
6655 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6656
6657
6658 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6659 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6660 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6661 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6662 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6663 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6664 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6665 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6666
6667 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6668 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6669 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6670 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6671 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6672 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6673 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6674 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6675 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6676 cholera:
6677
6678 @table @code
6679 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6680 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6681 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6682 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6683
6684 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6685 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6686 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6687 @end table
6688
6689 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6690 something like:
6691
6692 @lisp
6693 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6694 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6695 @end lisp
6696
6697 @end table
6698
6699
6700 @node Filling In Threads
6701 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6702
6703 @table @code
6704 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6705 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6706 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6707 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6708 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6709 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6710 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6711 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6712 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6713 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6714 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6715 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6716 do about that.
6717
6718 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6719 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6720 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6721
6722 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6723 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6724 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6725 newsgroups.
6726
6727 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6728 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6729 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6730 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6731 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6732 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6733 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6734 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6735 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6736 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6737 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6738 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6739 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6740 @code{nil} by default.
6741
6742 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6743 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6744 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6745 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6746 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6747 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6748 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6749
6750 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6751 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6752 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6753
6754 @end table
6755
6756
6757 @node More Threading
6758 @subsubsection More Threading
6759
6760 @table @code
6761 @item gnus-show-threads
6762 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6763 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6764 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6765 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6766 slower and more awkward.
6767
6768 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6769 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6770 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6771 generated.
6772
6773 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6774 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6775 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6776
6777 Here's an example:
6778
6779 @lisp
6780 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6781 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6782 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6783 @end lisp
6784
6785 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6786 unread, but you get my drift.)
6787
6788
6789 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6790 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6791 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6792 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6793 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6794 threads are expunged.
6795
6796 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6797 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6798 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6799 will be hidden.
6800
6801 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6802 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6803 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6804 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6805 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6806 result in a new thread.
6807
6808 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6809 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6810 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6811 The default is 4.
6812
6813 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6814 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6815 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6816 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6817 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6818 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6819 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6820 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6821 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6822 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6823 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6824
6825 @end table
6826
6827
6828 @node Low-Level Threading
6829 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6830
6831 @table @code
6832
6833 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6834 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6835 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6836
6837 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6838 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6839 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6840 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6841 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6842 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6843 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6844 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6845 meaningful. Here's one example:
6846
6847 @lisp
6848 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6849
6850 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6851 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6852 (when (string-match
6853 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6854 (mail-header-set-id
6855 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6856 header))))
6857 @end lisp
6858
6859 @end table
6860
6861
6862 @node Thread Commands
6863 @subsection Thread Commands
6864 @cindex thread commands
6865
6866 @table @kbd
6867
6868 @item T k
6869 @itemx C-M-k
6870 @kindex T k (Summary)
6871 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6872 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6873 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6874 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6875 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6876 articles instead.
6877
6878 @item T l
6879 @itemx C-M-l
6880 @kindex T l (Summary)
6881 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6882 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6883 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6884 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6885
6886 @item T i
6887 @kindex T i (Summary)
6888 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6889 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6890 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6891
6892 @item T #
6893 @kindex T # (Summary)
6894 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6895 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6896 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6897
6898 @item T M-#
6899 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6900 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6901 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6902 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6903
6904 @item T T
6905 @kindex T T (Summary)
6906 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6907 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6908
6909 @item T s
6910 @kindex T s (Summary)
6911 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6912 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6913 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6914
6915 @item T h
6916 @kindex T h (Summary)
6917 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6918 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6919
6920 @item T S
6921 @kindex T S (Summary)
6922 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6923 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6924
6925 @item T H
6926 @kindex T H (Summary)
6927 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6928 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6929
6930 @item T t
6931 @kindex T t (Summary)
6932 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6933 Re-thread the current article's thread
6934 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6935 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6936
6937 @item T ^
6938 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6939 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6940 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6941 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6942
6943 @end table
6944
6945 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6946 understand the numeric prefix.
6947
6948 @table @kbd
6949
6950 @item T n
6951 @kindex T n (Summary)
6952 @itemx C-M-f
6953 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6954 @itemx M-down
6955 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6956 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6957 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6958
6959 @item T p
6960 @kindex T p (Summary)
6961 @itemx C-M-b
6962 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6963 @itemx M-up
6964 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6965 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6966 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6967
6968 @item T d
6969 @kindex T d (Summary)
6970 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6971 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6972
6973 @item T u
6974 @kindex T u (Summary)
6975 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6976 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6977
6978 @item T o
6979 @kindex T o (Summary)
6980 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6981 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6982 @end table
6983
6984 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6985 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6986 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6987 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6988 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6989 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6990 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6991 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6992 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6993 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6994 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6995 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6996 Matching}).
6997
6998
6999 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7000 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7001
7002 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7003 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7004 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7005 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7006 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7007 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7008 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7009 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7010 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7011 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7012 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7013 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7014 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7015 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7016
7017 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7018 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7019 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7020 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7021 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7022 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7023 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7024 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7025
7026 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7027 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7028 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
7029
7030 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7031 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7032 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7033 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7034 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7035 ascending article order.
7036
7037 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7038 by number, you could do something like:
7039
7040 @lisp
7041 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7042 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7043 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7044 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7045 @end lisp
7046
7047 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7048 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7049 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7050 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7051 which the articles arrived.
7052
7053 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7054 say something like:
7055
7056 @lisp
7057 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7058 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7059 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7060 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7061 @end lisp
7062
7063 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7064 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7065 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7066 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7067 tickles your fancy.
7068
7069 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7070 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7071 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7072 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7073 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7074 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7075 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7076 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7077 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7078 variable. It is very similar to the
7079 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7080 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7081 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7082 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7083 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7084 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7085 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7086
7087 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7088 say something like:
7089
7090 @lisp
7091 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7092 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7093 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7094 @end lisp
7095
7096
7097
7098 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7099 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7100 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7101 @cindex article pre-fetch
7102 @cindex pre-fetch
7103
7104 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7105 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7106 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7107 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7108 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7109
7110 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7111 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7112
7113 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7114 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7115 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7116 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7117 connection is blocked.
7118
7119 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7120 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7121 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7122 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7123
7124 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7125 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7126 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7127 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7128 extra connection.
7129
7130 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7131 you really want to.
7132
7133 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7134 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7135 happen automatically.
7136
7137 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7138 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7139 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7140 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7141 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7142 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7143 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7144
7145 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7146 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7147 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7148 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7149 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7150 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7151 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7152 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7153 article data structure as the only parameter.
7154
7155 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7156 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7157
7158 @lisp
7159 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7160 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7161 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7162 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7163 100)))
7164
7165 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7166 @end lisp
7167
7168 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7169 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7170 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7171
7172 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7173 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7174 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7175 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7176
7177 @table @code
7178 @item read
7179 Remove articles when they are read.
7180
7181 @item exit
7182 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7183 @end table
7184
7185 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7186
7187 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7188 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7189 @c from the next group.
7190
7191
7192 @node Article Caching
7193 @section Article Caching
7194 @cindex article caching
7195 @cindex caching
7196
7197 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7198 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7199 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7200 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7201 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7202
7203 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7204
7205 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7206 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7207 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7208 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7209 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7210 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7211 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7212 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7213
7214 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7215 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7216 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7217 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7218 as dormant, and don't worry.
7219
7220 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7221
7222 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7223 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7224 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7225 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7226 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7227 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7228 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7229 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7230 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7231 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7232
7233 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7234 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7235 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7236 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7237 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7238 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7239 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7240 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7241 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7242 not then be downloaded by this command.
7243
7244 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7245 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7246 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7247 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7248 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7249 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7250
7251 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7252 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7253 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7254 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7255 variables, the group is not cached.
7256
7257 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7258 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7259 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7260 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7261 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7262 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7263 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7264 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7265 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7266 file.
7267
7268 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7269 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7270 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7271 where, isn't that cool?
7272
7273 @node Persistent Articles
7274 @section Persistent Articles
7275 @cindex persistent articles
7276
7277 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7278 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7279 useful in my opinion.
7280
7281 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7282 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7283 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7284 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7285 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7286 the expiry going on at the news server.
7287
7288 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7289 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7290 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7291
7292 @table @kbd
7293
7294 @item *
7295 @kindex * (Summary)
7296 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7297 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7298
7299 @item M-*
7300 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7301 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7302 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7303 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7304 article.
7305 @end table
7306
7307 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7308
7309 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7310 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7311 interested in persistent articles:
7312
7313 @lisp
7314 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7315 @end lisp
7316
7317
7318 @node Article Backlog
7319 @section Article Backlog
7320 @cindex backlog
7321 @cindex article backlog
7322
7323 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7324 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7325 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7326 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7327 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7328 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7329 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7330 increase memory usage some.
7331
7332 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7333 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7334 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7335 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7336 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7337 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7338 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7339
7340 The default value is 20.
7341
7342
7343 @node Saving Articles
7344 @section Saving Articles
7345 @cindex saving articles
7346
7347 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7348 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7349 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7350 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7351 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7352
7353 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7354 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7355 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7356
7357 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7358 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7359 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7360
7361 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7362 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7363 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7364 deleted before saving.
7365
7366 @table @kbd
7367
7368 @item O o
7369 @itemx o
7370 @kindex O o (Summary)
7371 @kindex o (Summary)
7372 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7373 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7374 Save the current article using the default article saver
7375 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7376
7377 @item O m
7378 @kindex O m (Summary)
7379 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7380 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7381 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7382
7383 @item O r
7384 @kindex O r (Summary)
7385 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7386 Save the current article in Rmail format
7387 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7388
7389 @item O f
7390 @kindex O f (Summary)
7391 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7392 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7393 Save the current article in plain file format
7394 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7395
7396 @item O F
7397 @kindex O F (Summary)
7398 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7399 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7400 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7401
7402 @item O b
7403 @kindex O b (Summary)
7404 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7405 Save the current article body in plain file format
7406 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7407
7408 @item O h
7409 @kindex O h (Summary)
7410 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7411 Save the current article in mh folder format
7412 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7413
7414 @item O v
7415 @kindex O v (Summary)
7416 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7417 Save the current article in a VM folder
7418 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7419
7420 @item O p
7421 @itemx |
7422 @kindex O p (Summary)
7423 @kindex | (Summary)
7424 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7425 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7426 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7427 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7428 complete headers in the piped output.
7429
7430 @item O P
7431 @kindex O P (Summary)
7432 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7433 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7434 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7435 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7436 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7437 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7438 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7439
7440 @end table
7441
7442 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7443 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7444 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7445 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7446 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7447 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7448 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7449 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7450 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7451 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7452 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7453 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7454 files.
7455
7456
7457 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7458 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7459 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7460 functions below, or you can create your own.
7461
7462 @table @code
7463
7464 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7465 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7466 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7467 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7468 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7469 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7470 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7471
7472 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7473 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7474 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7475 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7476 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7477 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7478
7479 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7480 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7481 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7482 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7483 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7484 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7485 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7486
7487 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7488 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7489 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7490 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7491 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7492 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7493
7494 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7495 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7496 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7497 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7498 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7499
7500 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7501 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7502 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7503 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7504 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7505 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7506
7507 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7508 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7509 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7510 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7511 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7512 @cindex rcvstore
7513 @cindex MH folders
7514 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7515 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7516 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7517 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7518 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7519
7520 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7521 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7522 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7523 reader to use this setting.
7524 @end table
7525
7526 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7527
7528 @table @code
7529 @item :decode
7530 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7531 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7532 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7533 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file}, and
7534 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7535
7536 @item :function
7537 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7538 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7539 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7540 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7541 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7542 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7543
7544 @item :headers
7545 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7546 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7547 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7548 headers should be saved.
7549 @end table
7550
7551 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7552 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7553 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7554 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7555 default.
7556
7557 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7558 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7559 available functions that generate names:
7560
7561 @table @code
7562
7563 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7564 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7565 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7566
7567 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7568 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7569 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7570
7571 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7572 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7573 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7574
7575 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7576 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7577 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7578
7579 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7580 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7581 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7582 @end table
7583
7584 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7585 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7586 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7587 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7588 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7589 like:
7590
7591 @lisp
7592 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7593 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7594 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7595 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7596 @end lisp
7597
7598 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7599 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7600 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7601 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7602 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7603 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7604 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7605 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7606 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7607
7608 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7609 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7610 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7611 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7612
7613 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7614 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7615 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7616 name.
7617
7618 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7619 lots of mail groups called things like
7620 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7621 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7622 following will do just that:
7623
7624 @lisp
7625 (defun my-save-name (group)
7626 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7627 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7628
7629 (setq gnus-split-methods
7630 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7631 (my-save-name)))
7632 @end lisp
7633
7634
7635 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7636 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7637 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7638 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7639 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7640 all the files in the top level directory
7641 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7642 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7643 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7644 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7645
7646 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7647 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7648 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7649 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7650 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7651 for kill files.
7652
7653 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7654 a spool, you could
7655
7656 @lisp
7657 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7658 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7659 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7660 @end lisp
7661
7662 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7663 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7664 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7665 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7666
7667
7668 @node Decoding Articles
7669 @section Decoding Articles
7670 @cindex decoding articles
7671
7672 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7673 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7674
7675 @menu
7676 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7677 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7678 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7679 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7680 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7681 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7682 @end menu
7683
7684 @cindex series
7685 @cindex article series
7686 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7687 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7688 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7689 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7690 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7691
7692 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7693 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7694 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7695
7696 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7697 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7698 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7699
7700 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7701 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7702 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7703
7704
7705 @node Uuencoded Articles
7706 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7707 @cindex uudecode
7708 @cindex uuencoded articles
7709
7710 @table @kbd
7711
7712 @item X u
7713 @kindex X u (Summary)
7714 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7715 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7716 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7717
7718 @item X U
7719 @kindex X U (Summary)
7720 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7721 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7722 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7723
7724 @item X v u
7725 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7726 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7727 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7728
7729 @item X v U
7730 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7731 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7732 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7733 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7734
7735 @end table
7736
7737 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7738 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7739 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7740 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7741 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7742
7743 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7744 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7745 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7746 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7747 @kbd{X u}.
7748
7749 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7750 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7751 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7752 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7753 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7754 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7755 off.
7756
7757
7758 @node Shell Archives
7759 @subsection Shell Archives
7760 @cindex unshar
7761 @cindex shell archives
7762 @cindex shared articles
7763
7764 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7765 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7766 some commands to deal with these:
7767
7768 @table @kbd
7769
7770 @item X s
7771 @kindex X s (Summary)
7772 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7773 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7774
7775 @item X S
7776 @kindex X S (Summary)
7777 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7778 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7779
7780 @item X v s
7781 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7782 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7783 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7784
7785 @item X v S
7786 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7787 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7788 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7789 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7790 @end table
7791
7792
7793 @node PostScript Files
7794 @subsection PostScript Files
7795 @cindex PostScript
7796
7797 @table @kbd
7798
7799 @item X p
7800 @kindex X p (Summary)
7801 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7802 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7803
7804 @item X P
7805 @kindex X P (Summary)
7806 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7807 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7808 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7809
7810 @item X v p
7811 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7812 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7813 View the current PostScript series
7814 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7815
7816 @item X v P
7817 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7818 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7819 View and save the current PostScript series
7820 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7821 @end table
7822
7823
7824 @node Other Files
7825 @subsection Other Files
7826
7827 @table @kbd
7828 @item X o
7829 @kindex X o (Summary)
7830 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7831 Save the current series
7832 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7833
7834 @item X b
7835 @kindex X b (Summary)
7836 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7837 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7838 doesn't really work yet.
7839 @end table
7840
7841
7842 @node Decoding Variables
7843 @subsection Decoding Variables
7844
7845 Adjective, not verb.
7846
7847 @menu
7848 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7849 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7850 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7851 @end menu
7852
7853
7854 @node Rule Variables
7855 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7856 @cindex rule variables
7857
7858 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7859 variables are of the form
7860
7861 @lisp
7862 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7863 '(regexp2 command2)
7864 ...)
7865 @end lisp
7866
7867 @table @code
7868
7869 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7870 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7871 @cindex sox
7872 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7873 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7874 say something like:
7875 @lisp
7876 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7877 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7878 @end lisp
7879
7880 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7881 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7882 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7883 user and default view rules.
7884
7885 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7886 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7887 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7888 archives.
7889 @end table
7890
7891
7892 @node Other Decode Variables
7893 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7897
7898 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7899 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7900 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7901 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7902 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7903
7904 @table @code
7905
7906 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7907 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7908 View the file.
7909
7910 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7911 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7912 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7913 @end table
7914
7915 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7916 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7917 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7918 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7919 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7920 time.
7921
7922 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7923 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7924 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7925
7926 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7927 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7928 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7929 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7930 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7931 kludgey.
7932
7933 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7934 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7935 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7936
7937 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7938 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7939 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7940 looking for files to display.
7941
7942 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7943 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7944 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7945 after viewing it.
7946
7947 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7948 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7949 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7950 rules.
7951
7952 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7953 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7954 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7955 unpacking commands.
7956
7957 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7958 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7959 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7960 from articles.
7961
7962 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7963 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7964 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7965 decoded articles as unread.
7966
7967 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7968 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7969 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7970 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7971
7972 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7973 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7974 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7975
7976 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7977 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7978 @cindex metamail
7979 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7980 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7981 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7982 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7983
7984 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7985 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7986 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7987 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7988 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7989 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7990 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7991 simply dropped them.
7992
7993 @end table
7994
7995
7996 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7997 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7998
7999 @table @code
8000
8001 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8002 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8003 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8004 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8005 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8006 for you when you post the article.
8007
8008 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8009 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8010 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8011 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8012
8013 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8014 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8015 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8016 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8017 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8018 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8019 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8020
8021 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8022 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8023 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8024 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8025 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8026 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8027 Default is @code{t}.
8028
8029 @end table
8030
8031
8032 @node Viewing Files
8033 @subsection Viewing Files
8034 @cindex viewing files
8035 @cindex pseudo-articles
8036
8037 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8038 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8039 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8040 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8041 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8042 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8043 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8044
8045 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8046 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8047 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8048 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8049
8050 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8051 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8052 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8053
8054 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8055 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8056 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8057 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8058 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8059
8060 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8061 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8062 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8063 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8064 a list of parameters to that command.
8065
8066 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8067 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8068 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8069
8070 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8071 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8072 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8073
8074
8075 @node Article Treatment
8076 @section Article Treatment
8077
8078 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8079 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8080 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8081 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8082 these articles easier.
8083
8084 @menu
8085 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8086 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8087 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8088 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8089 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8090 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8091 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8092 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8093 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8094 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8095 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8096 @end menu
8097
8098
8099 @node Article Highlighting
8100 @subsection Article Highlighting
8101 @cindex highlighting
8102
8103 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8104 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8105
8106 @table @kbd
8107
8108 @item W H a
8109 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8110 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8111 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8112 Do much highlighting of the current article
8113 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8114 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8115
8116 @item W H h
8117 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8118 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8119 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8120 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8121 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8122 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8123 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8124 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8125 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8126 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8127 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8128 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8129
8130 @item W H c
8131 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8132 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8133 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8134
8135 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8136
8137 @table @code
8138 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8139
8140 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8141 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8142 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8143
8144 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8145 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8146 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8147
8148 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8149 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8150 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8151 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8152 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8153 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8154
8155 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8156 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8157 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8158
8159 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8160 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8161 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8162
8163 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8164 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8165 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8166 that it's a citation.
8167
8168 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8169 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8170 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8171
8172 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8173 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8174 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8175
8176 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8177 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8178 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8179 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8180
8181 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8182 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8183 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8184 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8185 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8186 is @code{t}.
8187
8188 @end table
8189
8190
8191 @item W H s
8192 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8193 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8194 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8195 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8196 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8197 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8198 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8199 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8200 default.
8201
8202 @end table
8203
8204 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8205
8206
8207 @node Article Fontisizing
8208 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8209 @cindex emphasis
8210 @cindex article emphasis
8211
8212 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8213 @kindex W e (Summary)
8214 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8215 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8216 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8217 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8218
8219 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8220 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8221 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8222 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8223 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8224 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8225 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8226 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8227 highlighting.
8228
8229 @lisp
8230 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8231 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8232 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8233 @end lisp
8234
8235 @cindex slash
8236 @cindex asterisk
8237 @cindex underline
8238 @cindex /
8239 @cindex *
8240
8241 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8242 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8243 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8244 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8245 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8246 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8247 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8248 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8249 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8250 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8251 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8252 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8253 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8254
8255 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8256 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8257 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8258 say something like:
8259
8260 @lisp
8261 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8262 @end lisp
8263
8264 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8265
8266 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8267 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8268 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8269 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8270
8271 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8272
8273
8274 @node Article Hiding
8275 @subsection Article Hiding
8276 @cindex article hiding
8277
8278 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8279 too much cruft in most articles.
8280
8281 @table @kbd
8282
8283 @item W W a
8284 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8285 @findex gnus-article-hide
8286 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8287 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8288 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8289
8290 @item W W h
8291 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8292 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8293 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8294 Headers}.
8295
8296 @item W W b
8297 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8298 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8299 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8300 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8301
8302 @item W W s
8303 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8304 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8305 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8306 Signature}.
8307
8308 @item W W l
8309 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8310 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8311 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8312 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8313 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8314 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8315 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8316 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8317
8318 @table @code
8319
8320 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8321 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8322 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8323 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8324
8325 @end table
8326
8327 @item W W P
8328 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8329 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8330 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8331 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8332
8333 @item W W B
8334 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8335 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8336 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8337 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8338 @cindex banner
8339 @cindex OneList
8340 @cindex stripping advertisements
8341 @cindex advertisements
8342 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8343 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8344 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8345 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8346 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8347 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8348 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8349 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8350 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8351 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8352 used.
8353
8354 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8355 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8356 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8357
8358 @table @code
8359
8360 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8361 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8362 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8363 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8364 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8365 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8366 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8367 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8368 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8369 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8370 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8371
8372 @lisp
8373 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8374 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8375 @end lisp
8376
8377 @end table
8378
8379 @item W W c
8380 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8381 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8382 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8383 customizing the hiding:
8384
8385 @table @code
8386
8387 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8388 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8389 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8390 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8391 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8392 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8393 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8394 specs are valid:
8395
8396 @table @samp
8397 @item b
8398 Starting point of the hidden text.
8399 @item e
8400 Ending point of the hidden text.
8401 @item l
8402 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8403 @item n
8404 Number of lines of hidden text.
8405 @end table
8406
8407 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8408 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8409 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8410 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8411 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8412
8413 @end table
8414
8415 @item W W C-c
8416 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8417 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8418
8419 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8420 following two variables:
8421
8422 @table @code
8423 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8424 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8425 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8426 50), hide the cited text.
8427
8428 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8429 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8430 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8431 is hidden.
8432 @end table
8433
8434 @item W W C
8435 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8436 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8437 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8438 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8439 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8440 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8441
8442 @end table
8443
8444 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8445 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8446 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8447
8448 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8449 citation customization.
8450
8451 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8452 automatically.
8453
8454
8455 @node Article Washing
8456 @subsection Article Washing
8457 @cindex washing
8458 @cindex article washing
8459
8460 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8461 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8462
8463 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8464 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8465 Cleaner, perhaps.
8466
8467 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8468 articles by default.
8469
8470 @table @kbd
8471
8472 @item C-u g
8473 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8474 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8475 the server.
8476
8477 @item g
8478 Force redisplaying of the current article
8479 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8480 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8481 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8482 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8483
8484 @item W l
8485 @kindex W l (Summary)
8486 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8487 Remove page breaks from the current article
8488 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8489 delimiters.
8490
8491 @item W r
8492 @kindex W r (Summary)
8493 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8494 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8495 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8496 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8497 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8498 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8499
8500 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8501 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8502 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8503 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8504
8505 @item W m
8506 @kindex W m (Summary)
8507 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8508 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8509
8510 @item W t
8511 @item t
8512 @kindex W t (Summary)
8513 @kindex t (Summary)
8514 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8515 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8516 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8517
8518 @item W v
8519 @kindex W v (Summary)
8520 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8521 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8522 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8523
8524 @item W o
8525 @kindex W o (Summary)
8526 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8527 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8528
8529 @item W d
8530 @kindex W d (Summary)
8531 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8532 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8533 @cindex Smartquotes
8534 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8535 @cindex Latin 1
8536 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8537 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8538 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8539 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8540 interactively.
8541
8542 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8543 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8544 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8545 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8546
8547 @item W Y f
8548 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8549 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8550 @cindex Outlook Express
8551 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8552 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8553 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8554
8555 @item W Y u
8556 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8557 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8558 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8559 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8560 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8561 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8562 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8563 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8564 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8565 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8566
8567 @item W Y a
8568 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8569 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8570 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8571 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8572
8573 @item W Y c
8574 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8575 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8576 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8577 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8578
8579 @item W w
8580 @kindex W w (Summary)
8581 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8582 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8583
8584 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8585 when filling.
8586
8587 @item W Q
8588 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8589 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8590 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8591
8592 @item W C
8593 @kindex W C (Summary)
8594 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8595 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8596 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8597
8598 @item W c
8599 @kindex W c (Summary)
8600 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8601 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8602 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8603 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8604 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8605
8606 @item W q
8607 @kindex W q (Summary)
8608 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8609 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8610 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8611 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8612 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8613 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8614 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8615 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8616 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8617
8618 @item W 6
8619 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8620 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8621 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8622 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8623 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8624 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8625 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8626 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8627
8628 @item W Z
8629 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8630 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8631 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8632 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8633 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8634
8635 @item W u
8636 @kindex W u (Summary)
8637 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8638 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8639 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8640 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8641 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8642
8643 @item W h
8644 @kindex W h (Summary)
8645 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8646 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8647 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8648 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8649
8650 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8651 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8652 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8653
8654 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8655 The default is to use the function specified by
8656 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8657 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8658 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8659 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8660 can use include:
8661
8662 @table @code
8663 @item w3
8664 Use Emacs/W3.
8665
8666 @item w3m
8667 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8668
8669 @item w3m-standalone
8670 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8671
8672 @item links
8673 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8674
8675 @item lynx
8676 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8677
8678 @item html2text
8679 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8680
8681 @end table
8682
8683 @item W b
8684 @kindex W b (Summary)
8685 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8686 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8687 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8688
8689 @item W B
8690 @kindex W B (Summary)
8691 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8692 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8693 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8694
8695 @item W p
8696 @kindex W p (Summary)
8697 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8698 Verify a signed control message
8699 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8700 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8701 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8702 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8703 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8704 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8705
8706 @item W s
8707 @kindex W s (Summary)
8708 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8709 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8710 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8711 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8712
8713 @item W a
8714 @kindex W a (Summary)
8715 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8716 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8717 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8718
8719 @item W E l
8720 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8721 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8722 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8723 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8724
8725 @item W E m
8726 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8727 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8728 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8729 lines with a single empty line.
8730 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8731
8732 @item W E t
8733 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8734 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8735 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8736 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8737
8738 @item W E a
8739 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8740 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8741 Do all the three commands above
8742 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8743
8744 @item W E A
8745 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8746 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8747 Remove all blank lines
8748 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8749
8750 @item W E s
8751 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8752 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8753 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8754 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8755
8756 @item W E e
8757 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8758 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8759 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8760 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8761
8762 @end table
8763
8764 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8765
8766
8767 @node Article Header
8768 @subsection Article Header
8769
8770 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8771
8772 @table @kbd
8773
8774 @item W G u
8775 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8776 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8777 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8778
8779 @item W G n
8780 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8781 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8782 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8783 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8784
8785 @item W G f
8786 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8787 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8788 Fold all the message headers
8789 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8790
8791 @item W E w
8792 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8793 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8794 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8795 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8796
8797 @end table
8798
8799
8800 @node Article Buttons
8801 @subsection Article Buttons
8802 @cindex buttons
8803
8804 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8805 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8806 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8807 button on these references.
8808
8809 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8810 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8811 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8812 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8813 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8814
8815 @table @code
8816
8817 @item gnus-button-alist
8818 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8819 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8820
8821 @lisp
8822 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8823 @end lisp
8824
8825 @table @var
8826
8827 @item regexp
8828 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8829 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8830 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8831 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8832 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8833
8834 @item button-par
8835 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8836 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8837 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8838
8839 @item use-p
8840 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8841 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8842 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8843 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8844 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8845
8846 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8847
8848 @item function
8849 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8850
8851 @item data-par
8852 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8853 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8854
8855 @end table
8856
8857 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8858
8859 @lisp
8860 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8861 @end lisp
8862
8863 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8864 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8865 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8866 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8867 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8868
8869 @lisp
8870 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8871 @end lisp
8872
8873 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8874 @end table
8875
8876 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8877
8878 @table @code
8879 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8880 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8881
8882 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8883
8884 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8885 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8886 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8887 default values of the variables above.
8888
8889 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8890
8891 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8892 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8893 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8894 argument with a string naming the man page.
8895
8896 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8897
8898 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8899 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8900 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8901
8902 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8903 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8904 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8905 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8906 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8907 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8908 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8909 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8910 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8911 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8912 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8913 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8914
8915 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8916 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8917 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8918 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8919 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8920 string is invalid.
8921
8922 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8923 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8924 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8925 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8926
8927 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8928
8929 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8930 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8931 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8932 argument, the string naming the URL.
8933
8934 @item gnus-ctan-url
8935 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8936 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8937 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8938
8939 @c Misc stuff
8940
8941 @item gnus-article-button-face
8942 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8943 Face used on buttons.
8944
8945 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8946 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8947 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8948
8949 @end table
8950
8951 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8952
8953
8954 @node Article Button Levels
8955 @subsection Article button levels
8956 @cindex button levels
8957 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8958 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8959 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8960 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8961 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8962 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8963 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8964 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8965
8966 @lisp
8967 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8968 (setq gnus-parameters
8969 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8970 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8971 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8972 @end lisp
8973
8974 @table @code
8975
8976 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8977 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8978 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8979 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8980 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8981 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8982
8983 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8984 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8985 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8986 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8987 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8988 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8989 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8990 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8991 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8992 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8993 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8994 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8995 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8996
8997 @item gnus-button-man-level
8998 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8999 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9000 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9001
9002 @item gnus-button-message-level
9003 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9004 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9005 Related variables and functions include
9006 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9007 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9008 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9009 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9010
9011 @item gnus-button-tex-level
9012 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
9013 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
9014 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
9015 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
9016 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
9017 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
9018
9019 @end table
9020
9021
9022 @node Article Date
9023 @subsection Article Date
9024
9025 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9026 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9027 when the article was sent.
9028
9029 @table @kbd
9030
9031 @item W T u
9032 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9033 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9034 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9035 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9036
9037 @item W T i
9038 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9039 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9040 @cindex ISO 8601
9041 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9042 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9043
9044 @item W T l
9045 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9046 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9047 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9048
9049 @item W T p
9050 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9051 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9052 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9053 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9054
9055 @item W T s
9056 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9057 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9058 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9059 @findex format-time-string
9060 Display the date using a user-defined format
9061 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9062 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9063 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9064 for a list of possible format specs.
9065
9066 @item W T e
9067 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9068 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9069 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9070 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9071 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9072 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9073
9074 @example
9075 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9076 @end example
9077
9078 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9079 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9080 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9081 replace it.
9082
9083 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9084 into wonderful absurdities.
9085
9086 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9087
9088 @lisp
9089 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9090 @end lisp
9091
9092 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9093 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9094 command.
9095
9096 @item W T o
9097 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9098 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9099 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9100 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9101 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9102 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9103 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9104
9105 @end table
9106
9107 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9108 preferred format automatically.
9109
9110
9111 @node Article Display
9112 @subsection Article Display
9113 @cindex picons
9114 @cindex x-face
9115 @cindex smileys
9116
9117 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9118 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9119
9120 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9121 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9122
9123 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9124 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9125
9126 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9127 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9128
9129 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9130 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9131
9132 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9133 they'll be removed.
9134
9135 @table @kbd
9136 @item W D x
9137 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9138 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9139 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9140 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9141
9142 @item W D d
9143 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9144 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9145 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9146 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9147
9148 @item W D s
9149 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9150 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9151 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9152
9153 @item W D f
9154 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9155 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9156 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9157
9158 @item W D m
9159 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9160 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9161 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9162 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9163
9164 @item W D n
9165 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9166 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9167 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9168 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9169
9170 @item W D D
9171 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9172 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9173 Remove all images from the article buffer
9174 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9175
9176 @end table
9177
9178
9179
9180 @node Article Signature
9181 @subsection Article Signature
9182 @cindex signatures
9183 @cindex article signature
9184
9185 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9186 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9187 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9188 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9189 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9190 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9191 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9192 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9193 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9194
9195 @lisp
9196 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9197 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9198 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9199 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9200 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9201 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9202 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9203 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9204 @end lisp
9205
9206 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9207 positives.
9208
9209 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9210 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9211 signature when displaying articles.
9212
9213 @enumerate
9214 @item
9215 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9216 that integer.
9217 @item
9218 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9219 than that number.
9220 @item
9221 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9222 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9223 @item
9224 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9225 in question is not a signature.
9226 @end enumerate
9227
9228 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9229 listed above. Here's an example:
9230
9231 @lisp
9232 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9233 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9234 @end lisp
9235
9236 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9237 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9238 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9239 signature after all.
9240
9241
9242 @node Article Miscellanea
9243 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9244
9245 @table @kbd
9246 @item A t
9247 @kindex A t (Summary)
9248 @findex gnus-article-babel
9249 Translate the article from one language to another
9250 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9251
9252 @end table
9253
9254
9255 @node MIME Commands
9256 @section MIME Commands
9257 @cindex MIME decoding
9258 @cindex attachments
9259 @cindex viewing attachments
9260
9261 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9262 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9263
9264 @table @kbd
9265 @item b
9266 @itemx K v
9267 @kindex b (Summary)
9268 @kindex K v (Summary)
9269 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9270
9271 @item K o
9272 @kindex K o (Summary)
9273 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9274
9275 @item K c
9276 @kindex K c (Summary)
9277 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9278
9279 @item K e
9280 @kindex K e (Summary)
9281 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9282
9283 @item K i
9284 @kindex K i (Summary)
9285 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9286
9287 @item K |
9288 @kindex K | (Summary)
9289 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9290 @end table
9291
9292 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9293 the same manner:
9294
9295 @table @kbd
9296 @item K b
9297 @kindex K b (Summary)
9298 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9299 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9300 parts.
9301
9302 @item K m
9303 @kindex K m (Summary)
9304 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9305 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9306 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9307 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9308 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9309
9310 @item X m
9311 @kindex X m (Summary)
9312 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9313 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9314 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9315 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9316
9317 @item M-t
9318 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9319 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9320 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9321 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9322
9323 @item W M w
9324 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9325 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9326 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9327 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9328
9329 @item W M c
9330 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9331 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9332 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9333 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9334
9335 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9336 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9337 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9338 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9339 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9340 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9341
9342 @item W M v
9343 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9344 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9345 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9346 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9347
9348 @end table
9349
9350 Relevant variables:
9351
9352 @table @code
9353 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9354 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9355 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9356 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9357 @code{nil}.
9358
9359 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9360
9361 @lisp
9362 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9363 '("text/x-vcard"))
9364 @end lisp
9365
9366 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9367 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9368 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9369 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9370 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9371 default is @code{nil}.
9372
9373 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9374 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9375 @cindex uuencode
9376 @cindex yEnc
9377 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9378 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9379 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9380 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9381 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9382 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9383 for encoding in Gnus.
9384
9385 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9386 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9387 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9388 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9389 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9390 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9391 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9392 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9393
9394 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9395 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9396 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9397 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9398 displayed. This variable overrides
9399 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9400 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9401 is @code{nil}.
9402
9403 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9404 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9405 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9406
9407 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9408 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9409 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9410 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9411 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9412
9413 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9414 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9415 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9416 default value is @code{nil}.
9417
9418 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9419 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9420 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9421 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9422 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9423 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9424 save all jpegs into some directory).
9425
9426 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9427
9428 @lisp
9429 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9430 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9431 (with-temp-buffer
9432 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9433 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9434 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9435 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9436 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9437 @end lisp
9438
9439 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9440 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9441 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9442
9443 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9444 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9445 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9446
9447 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9448 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9449 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9450
9451 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9452 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9453 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9454 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9455 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9456
9457 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9458 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9459 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9460 overrides @code{nil} values of
9461 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9462 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9463
9464 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9465 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9466 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9467 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9468
9469 Ready-made functions include@*
9470 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9471 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9472 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9473 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9474 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9475 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9476 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9477 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9478 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9479 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9480 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9481 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9482
9483 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9484 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9485
9486 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9487 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9488 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9489
9490 @lisp
9491 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9492 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9493 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9494 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9495 @end lisp
9496
9497 @noindent
9498 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9499
9500 @end table
9501
9502
9503 @node Charsets
9504 @section Charsets
9505 @cindex charsets
9506
9507 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9508 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9509 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9510 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9511 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9512 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9513 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9514
9515 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9516 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9517 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9518 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9519
9520 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9521 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9522 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9523 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9524 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9525 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9526 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9527 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9528 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9529
9530 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9531 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9532 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9533 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9534 quoted-printable header encoding.
9535
9536 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9537 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9538 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9539
9540 @table @var
9541 @item test
9542 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9543 variable to query,
9544 @item header
9545 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9546 means encode all charsets),
9547 @item body-list
9548 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9549 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9550 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9551 @end table
9552
9553 @cindex Russian
9554 @cindex koi8-r
9555 @cindex koi8-u
9556 @cindex iso-8859-5
9557 @cindex coding system aliases
9558 @cindex preferred charset
9559
9560 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9561 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9562 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9563
9564 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9565
9566 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9567 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9568
9569 @lisp
9570 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9571 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9572 @end lisp
9573
9574 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9575 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9576
9577 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9578
9579 @lisp
9580 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9581 @end lisp
9582
9583 This will almost do the right thing.
9584
9585 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9586 something like
9587
9588 @lisp
9589 (codepage-setup 1251)
9590 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9591 @end lisp
9592
9593
9594 @node Article Commands
9595 @section Article Commands
9596
9597 @table @kbd
9598
9599 @item A P
9600 @cindex PostScript
9601 @cindex printing
9602 @kindex A P (Summary)
9603 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9604 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9605 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9606 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9607 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9608 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9609
9610 @end table
9611
9612
9613 @node Summary Sorting
9614 @section Summary Sorting
9615 @cindex summary sorting
9616
9617 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9618 can't really see why you'd want that.
9619
9620 @table @kbd
9621
9622 @item C-c C-s C-n
9623 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9624 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9625 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9626
9627 @item C-c C-s C-a
9628 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9629 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9630 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9631
9632 @item C-c C-s C-s
9633 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9634 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9635 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9636
9637 @item C-c C-s C-d
9638 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9639 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9640 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9641
9642 @item C-c C-s C-l
9643 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9644 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9645 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9646
9647 @item C-c C-s C-c
9648 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9649 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9650 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9651
9652 @item C-c C-s C-i
9653 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9654 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9655 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9656
9657 @item C-c C-s C-r
9658 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9659 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9660 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9661
9662 @item C-c C-s C-o
9663 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9664 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9665 Sort using the default sorting method
9666 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9667 @end table
9668
9669 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9670 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9671 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9672 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9673 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9674 Commands}).
9675
9676
9677 @node Finding the Parent
9678 @section Finding the Parent
9679 @cindex parent articles
9680 @cindex referring articles
9681
9682 @table @kbd
9683 @item ^
9684 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9685 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9686 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9687 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9688 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9689 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9690 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9691 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9692 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9693 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9694
9695 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9696 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9697 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9698 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9699 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9700 article.
9701
9702 @item A R (Summary)
9703 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9704 @kindex A R (Summary)
9705 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9706 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9707
9708 @item A T (Summary)
9709 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9710 @kindex A T (Summary)
9711 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9712 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9713 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9714 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9715 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9716 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9717 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9718
9719 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9720 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9721 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9722 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9723 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9724 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9725
9726 @item M-^ (Summary)
9727 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9728 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9729 @cindex Message-ID
9730 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9731 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9732 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9733 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9734 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9735 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9736
9737 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9738 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9739 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9740 @end table
9741
9742 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9743 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9744 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9745 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9746 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9747 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9748 necessary.
9749
9750 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9751 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9752 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9753 match.
9754
9755 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9756 then ask Google if that fails:
9757
9758 @lisp
9759 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9760 '(current
9761 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9762 @end lisp
9763
9764 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9765 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9766 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9767 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9768 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9769 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9770 not support this at all.
9771
9772
9773 @node Alternative Approaches
9774 @section Alternative Approaches
9775
9776 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9777 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9778
9779 @menu
9780 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9781 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9782 @end menu
9783
9784
9785 @node Pick and Read
9786 @subsection Pick and Read
9787 @cindex pick and read
9788
9789 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9790 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9791 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9792 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9793
9794 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9795 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9796 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9797 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9798 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9799 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9800
9801 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9802
9803 @table @kbd
9804 @item .
9805 @kindex . (Pick)
9806 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9807 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9808 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9809 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9810 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9811 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9812 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9813 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9814
9815 @item SPACE
9816 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9817 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9818 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9819 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9820
9821 @item u
9822 @kindex u (Pick)
9823 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9824 Unpick the thread or article
9825 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9826 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9827 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9828 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9829 the thread or article at that line.
9830
9831 @item RET
9832 @kindex RET (Pick)
9833 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9834 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9835 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9836 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9837 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9838 will still be visible when you are reading.
9839
9840 @end table
9841
9842 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9843 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9844 which is mapped to the same function
9845 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9846
9847 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9848
9849 @lisp
9850 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9851 @end lisp
9852
9853 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9854 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9855
9856 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9857 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9858 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9859
9860 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9861 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9862 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9863 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9864 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9865 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9866 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9867
9868
9869 @node Binary Groups
9870 @subsection Binary Groups
9871 @cindex binary groups
9872
9873 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9874 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9875 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9876 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9877 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9878 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9879 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9880
9881 @kindex g (Binary)
9882 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9883 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9884 command, when you have turned on this mode
9885 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9886
9887 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9888 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9889
9890
9891 @node Tree Display
9892 @section Tree Display
9893 @cindex trees
9894
9895 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9896 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9897 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9898 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9899 in the tree buffer.
9900
9901 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9902
9903 @table @code
9904 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9905 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9906 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9907
9908 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9909 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9910 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9911 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9912 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9913
9914 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9915 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9916 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9917 default is @code{modeline}.
9918
9919 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9920 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9921 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9922 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9923 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9924 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9925 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9926
9927 Valid specs are:
9928
9929 @table @samp
9930 @item n
9931 The name of the poster.
9932 @item f
9933 The @code{From} header.
9934 @item N
9935 The number of the article.
9936 @item [
9937 The opening bracket.
9938 @item ]
9939 The closing bracket.
9940 @item s
9941 The subject.
9942 @end table
9943
9944 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9945
9946 Variables related to the display are:
9947
9948 @table @code
9949 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9950 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9951 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9952 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9953 @example
9954 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9955 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9956 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9957 @end example
9958 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9959
9960 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9961 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9962 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9963 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9964
9965 @end table
9966
9967 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9968 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9969 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9970 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9971 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9972 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9973 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9974 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9975 other windows displayed next to it.
9976
9977 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9978 at all times:
9979
9980 @lisp
9981 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9982 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9983 @end lisp
9984
9985 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9986 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9987 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9988 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9989 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9990 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9991 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9992
9993 @end table
9994
9995 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9996
9997 @example
9998 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9999 | \[Jan]
10000 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10001 | \(***)-[Eri]
10002 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10003 \[Bjo]
10004 \[Gun]
10005 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10006 @end example
10007
10008 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10009
10010 @example
10011 @group
10012 @{***@}
10013 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10014 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10015 |--\-----\-----\ |
10016 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10017 | | |--\
10018 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10019 |
10020 [Paa]
10021 @end group
10022 @end example
10023
10024 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10025 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10026 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10027
10028 @lisp
10029 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10030 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10031 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10032 (gnus-add-configuration
10033 '(article
10034 (vertical 1.0
10035 (horizontal 0.25
10036 (summary 0.75 point)
10037 (tree 1.0))
10038 (article 1.0))))
10039 @end lisp
10040
10041 @xref{Window Layout}.
10042
10043
10044 @node Mail Group Commands
10045 @section Mail Group Commands
10046 @cindex mail group commands
10047
10048 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10049 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10050
10051 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10052 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10053
10054 @table @kbd
10055
10056 @item B e
10057 @kindex B e (Summary)
10058 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10059 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10060 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10061 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10062 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10063
10064 @item B C-M-e
10065 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10066 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10067 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10068 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10069 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10070 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10071
10072 @item B DEL
10073 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10074 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10075 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10076 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10077 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10078 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10079
10080 @item B m
10081 @kindex B m (Summary)
10082 @cindex move mail
10083 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10084 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10085 Move the article from one mail group to another
10086 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10087 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10088
10089 @item B c
10090 @kindex B c (Summary)
10091 @cindex copy mail
10092 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10093 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10094 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10095 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10096 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10097
10098 @item B B
10099 @kindex B B (Summary)
10100 @cindex crosspost mail
10101 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10102 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10103 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10104 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10105 be properly updated.
10106
10107 @item B i
10108 @kindex B i (Summary)
10109 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10110 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10111 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10112 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10113
10114 @item B I
10115 @kindex B I (Summary)
10116 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10117 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10118 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10119 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10120
10121 @item B r
10122 @kindex B r (Summary)
10123 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10124 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10125 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10126 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10127 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10128 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10129 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10130 (which is the default).
10131
10132 @item B w
10133 @itemx e
10134 @kindex B w (Summary)
10135 @kindex e (Summary)
10136 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10137 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10138 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10139 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10140 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10141 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10142 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10143
10144 @item B q
10145 @kindex B q (Summary)
10146 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10147 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10148 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10149 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10150
10151 @item B t
10152 @kindex B t (Summary)
10153 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10154 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10155 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10156
10157 @item B p
10158 @kindex B p (Summary)
10159 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10160 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10161 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10162 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10163 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10164 article from your news server (or rather, from
10165 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10166 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10167 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10168 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10169 just not have arrived yet.
10170
10171 @item K E
10172 @kindex K E (Summary)
10173 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10174 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10175 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10176 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10177 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10178
10179 @end table
10180
10181 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10182 @cindex moving articles
10183 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10184 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10185 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10186 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10187 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10188 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10189 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10190
10191 @lisp
10192 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10193 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10194 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10195 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10196 @end lisp
10197
10198
10199 @node Various Summary Stuff
10200 @section Various Summary Stuff
10201
10202 @menu
10203 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10204 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10205 * Summary Generation Commands::
10206 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10207 @end menu
10208
10209 @table @code
10210 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10211 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10212 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10213 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10214 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10215 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10216
10217 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10218 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10219 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10220 current article.
10221
10222 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10223 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10224 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10225
10226 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10227 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10228 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10229 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10230 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10231 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10232 have been set.
10233
10234 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10235 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10236 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10237 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10238 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10239
10240 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10241 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10242 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10243 generated.
10244
10245 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10246 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10247 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10248 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10249 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10250 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10251 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10252 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10253 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10254 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10255
10256 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10257 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10258 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10259 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10260 list of articles to be selected.
10261
10262 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10263 the list in one particular group:
10264
10265 @lisp
10266 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10267 (if (string= group "some.group")
10268 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10269 articles))
10270 @end lisp
10271
10272 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10273 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10274 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10275 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10276 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10277 buffer is active.
10278
10279 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10280 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10281 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10282 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10283 variable will be used instead.
10284
10285 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10286 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10287 buffers. For example:
10288
10289 @lisp
10290 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10291 '(message-use-followup-to
10292 (gnus-visible-headers .
10293 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10294 @end lisp
10295
10296 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10297 @end table
10298
10299
10300 @node Summary Group Information
10301 @subsection Summary Group Information
10302
10303 @table @kbd
10304
10305 @item H f
10306 @kindex H f (Summary)
10307 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10308 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10309 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10310 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10311 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10312 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10313 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10314 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10315 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10316
10317 @item H d
10318 @kindex H d (Summary)
10319 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10320 Give a brief description of the current group
10321 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10322 rereading the description from the server.
10323
10324 @item H h
10325 @kindex H h (Summary)
10326 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10327 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10328 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10329
10330 @item H i
10331 @kindex H i (Summary)
10332 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10333 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10334 @end table
10335
10336
10337 @node Searching for Articles
10338 @subsection Searching for Articles
10339
10340 @table @kbd
10341
10342 @item M-s
10343 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10344 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10345 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10346 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10347
10348 @item M-r
10349 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10350 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10351 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10352 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10353
10354 @item &
10355 @kindex & (Summary)
10356 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10357 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10358 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10359 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10360 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10361 search backward instead.
10362
10363 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10364 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10365
10366 @item M-&
10367 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10368 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10369 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10370 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10371 @end table
10372
10373 @node Summary Generation Commands
10374 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10375
10376 @table @kbd
10377
10378 @item Y g
10379 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10380 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10381 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10382
10383 @item Y c
10384 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10385 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10386 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10387 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10388
10389 @item Y d
10390 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10391 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10392 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10393 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10394
10395 @end table
10396
10397
10398 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10399 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10400
10401 @table @kbd
10402
10403 @item A D
10404 @itemx C-d
10405 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10406 @kindex A D (Summary)
10407 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10408 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10409 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10410 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10411 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10412 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10413 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10414 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10415 fashion.
10416
10417 @item C-M-d
10418 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10419 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10420 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10421 several documents into one biiig group
10422 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10423 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10424 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10425 command understands the process/prefix convention
10426 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10427
10428 @item C-t
10429 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10430 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10431 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10432 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10433 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10434 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10435
10436 @item =
10437 @kindex = (Summary)
10438 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10439 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10440 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10441
10442 @item C-M-e
10443 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10444 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10445 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10446 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10447
10448 @item C-M-a
10449 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10450 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10451 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10452 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10453
10454 @end table
10455
10456
10457 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10458 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10459 @cindex summary exit
10460 @cindex exiting groups
10461
10462 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10463 group and return you to the group buffer.
10464
10465 @table @kbd
10466
10467 @item Z Z
10468 @itemx Z Q
10469 @itemx q
10470 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10471 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10472 @kindex q (Summary)
10473 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10474 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10475 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10476 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10477 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10478 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10479 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10480 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10481 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10482 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10483 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10484 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10485
10486 @item Z E
10487 @itemx Q
10488 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10489 @kindex Q (Summary)
10490 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10491 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10492 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10493
10494 @item Z c
10495 @itemx c
10496 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10497 @kindex c (Summary)
10498 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10499 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10500 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10501 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10502
10503 @item Z C
10504 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10505 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10506 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10507 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10508
10509 @item Z n
10510 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10511 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10512 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10513 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10514
10515 @item Z R
10516 @itemx C-x C-s
10517 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10518 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10519 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10520 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10521 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10522 all articles, both read and unread.
10523
10524 @item Z G
10525 @itemx M-g
10526 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10527 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10528 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10529 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10530 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10531 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10532 articles, both read and unread.
10533
10534 @item Z N
10535 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10536 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10537 Exit the group and go to the next group
10538 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10539
10540 @item Z P
10541 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10542 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10543 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10544 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10545
10546 @item Z s
10547 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10548 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10549 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10550 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10551 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10552 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10553 @end table
10554
10555 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10556 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10557 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10558 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10559
10560 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10561 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10562 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10563 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10564 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10565 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10566 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10567 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10568 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10569 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10570 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10571 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10572
10573 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10574
10575 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10576 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10577 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10578 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10579 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10580 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10581 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10582 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10583 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10584
10585
10586 @node Crosspost Handling
10587 @section Crosspost Handling
10588
10589 @cindex velveeta
10590 @cindex spamming
10591 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10592 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10593 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10594 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10595 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10596 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10597 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10598
10599 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10600 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10601 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10602 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10603 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10604
10605 @cindex cross-posting
10606 @cindex Xref
10607 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10608 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10609 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10610 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10611 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10612 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10613 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10614 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10615 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10616 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10617 the cross reference mechanism.
10618
10619 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10620 @cindex overview.fmt
10621 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10622 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10623 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10624 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10625 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10626 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10627 overview files.
10628
10629 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10630 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10631 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10632 considerably.
10633
10634 C'est la vie.
10635
10636 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10637
10638
10639 @node Duplicate Suppression
10640 @section Duplicate Suppression
10641
10642 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10643 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10644 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10645 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10646 reasons.
10647
10648 @enumerate
10649 @item
10650 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10651 is evil and not very common.
10652
10653 @item
10654 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10655 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10656
10657 @item
10658 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10659 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10660
10661 @item
10662 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10663 @end enumerate
10664
10665 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10666 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10667
10668 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10669 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10670 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10671 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10672 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10673 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10674 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10675 once.
10676
10677 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10678 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10679 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10680 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10681 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10682 saw the article in.
10683
10684 @table @code
10685 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10686 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10687 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10688
10689 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10690 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10691 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10692 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10693 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10694 session are suppressed.
10695
10696 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10697 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10698 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10699 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10700
10701 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10702 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10703 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10704 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10705 @end table
10706
10707 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10708 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10709 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10710 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10711 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10712 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10713 to you to figure out, I think.
10714
10715 @node Security
10716 @section Security
10717
10718 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10719 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10720 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10721 things to work:
10722
10723 @enumerate
10724 @item
10725 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10726 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10727 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10728 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10729
10730 @item
10731 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10732 or newer is recommended.
10733
10734 @end enumerate
10735
10736 The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
10737 include:
10738
10739 @table @code
10740 @item mm-verify-option
10741 @vindex mm-verify-option
10742 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10743 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10744 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10745
10746 @item mm-decrypt-option
10747 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10748 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10749 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10750 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10751
10752 @item mml1991-use
10753 @vindex mml1991-use
10754 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10755 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10756 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10757 deprecated.
10758
10759 @item mml2015-use
10760 @vindex mml2015-use
10761 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10762 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10763 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10764 deprecated.
10765
10766 @end table
10767
10768 By default the buttons that display security information are not
10769 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
10770 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
10771 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
10772 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
10773 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
10774 how to customize these variables to always display security
10775 information.
10776
10777 @cindex snarfing keys
10778 @cindex importing PGP keys
10779 @cindex PGP key ring import
10780 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10781 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10782 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10783 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10784 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10785 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10786 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10787 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10788 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10789
10790 @example
10791 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10792 @end example
10793 @noindent
10794 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10795 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10796
10797 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
10798 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
10799 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10800
10801 @node Mailing List
10802 @section Mailing List
10803 @cindex mailing list
10804 @cindex RFC 2396
10805
10806 @kindex A M (summary)
10807 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10808 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10809 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10810 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10811 summary buffer.
10812
10813 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10814
10815 @table @kbd
10816
10817 @item C-c C-n h
10818 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10819 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10820 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10821
10822 @item C-c C-n s
10823 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10824 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10825 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10826
10827 @item C-c C-n u
10828 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10829 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10830 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10831 field exists.
10832
10833 @item C-c C-n p
10834 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10835 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10836 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10837
10838 @item C-c C-n o
10839 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10840 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10841 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10842
10843 @item C-c C-n a
10844 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10845 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10846 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10847
10848 @end table
10849
10850
10851 @node Article Buffer
10852 @chapter Article Buffer
10853 @cindex article buffer
10854
10855 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10856 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10857 tell Gnus otherwise.
10858
10859 @menu
10860 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10861 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10862 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10863 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10864 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10865 @end menu
10866
10867
10868 @node Hiding Headers
10869 @section Hiding Headers
10870 @cindex hiding headers
10871 @cindex deleting headers
10872
10873 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10874 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10875
10876 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10877 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10878 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10879 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10880 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10881 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10882 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10883 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10884 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10885
10886 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10887
10888 @table @code
10889
10890 @item gnus-visible-headers
10891 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10892 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10893 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10894 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10895
10896 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10897 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10898
10899 @lisp
10900 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10901 @end lisp
10902
10903 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10904 remain visible.
10905
10906 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10907 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10908 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10909 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10910 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10911 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10912
10913 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10914 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10915
10916 @lisp
10917 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10918 @end lisp
10919
10920 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10921 be removed.
10922
10923 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10924 variable will have no effect.
10925
10926 @end table
10927
10928 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10929 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10930 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10931 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10932 the headers are to be displayed.
10933
10934 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10935 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10936
10937 @lisp
10938 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10939 @end lisp
10940
10941 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10942 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10943
10944 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10945 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10946 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10947 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10948 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10949 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10950 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10951 from sight.
10952
10953 These conditions are:
10954 @table @code
10955 @item empty
10956 Remove all empty headers.
10957 @item followup-to
10958 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10959 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10960 @item reply-to
10961 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10962 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10963 parameter is set.
10964 @item newsgroups
10965 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10966 name.
10967 @item to-address
10968 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10969 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10970 @item to-list
10971 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10972 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10973 @item cc-list
10974 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10975 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10976 @item date
10977 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10978 old.
10979 @item long-to
10980 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10981 @item many-to
10982 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10983 @end table
10984
10985 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10986
10987 @lisp
10988 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10989 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10990 @end lisp
10991
10992 This is also the default value for this variable.
10993
10994
10995 @node Using MIME
10996 @section Using MIME
10997 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10998
10999 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11000 while people stand around yawning.
11001
11002 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11003 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11004
11005 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11006 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11007 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11008
11009 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11010 @findex gnus-display-mime
11011 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11012 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11013 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11014 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11015
11016 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11017 @acronym{MIME} button:
11018
11019 @table @kbd
11020 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11021 @item RET (Article)
11022 @kindex RET (Article)
11023 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11024 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11025 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11026 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11027 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11028 object is displayed inline.
11029
11030 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11031 @item M-RET (Article)
11032 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11033 @itemx v (Article)
11034 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11035 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11036
11037 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11038 @item t (Article)
11039 @kindex t (Article)
11040 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11041 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11042
11043 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11044 @item C (Article)
11045 @kindex C (Article)
11046 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11047 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11048
11049 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11050 @item o (Article)
11051 @kindex o (Article)
11052 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11053 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11054
11055 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11056 @item C-o (Article)
11057 @kindex C-o (Article)
11058 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11059 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11060 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11061 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11062 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11063 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11064
11065 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11066 @item d (Article)
11067 @kindex d (Article)
11068 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11069 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11070 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11071
11072 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11073 @item c (Article)
11074 @kindex c (Article)
11075 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11076 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11077 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11078 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11079 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11080
11081 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11082 @item p (Article)
11083 @kindex p (Article)
11084 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11085 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11086 @file{.mailcap} file.
11087
11088 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11089 @item i (Article)
11090 @kindex i (Article)
11091 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11092 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11093 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11094 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11095 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11096 Article}).
11097
11098 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11099 @item E (Article)
11100 @kindex E (Article)
11101 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11102 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11103 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11104
11105 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11106 @item e (Article)
11107 @kindex e (Article)
11108 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11109 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11110
11111 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11112 @item | (Article)
11113 @kindex | (Article)
11114 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11115
11116 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11117 @item . (Article)
11118 @kindex . (Article)
11119 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11120 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11121
11122 @end table
11123
11124 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11125 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11126 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11127
11128 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11129 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11130 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11131 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11132 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11133 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11134 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11135 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11136 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11137
11138 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11139
11140 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11141
11142
11143 @node Customizing Articles
11144 @section Customizing Articles
11145 @cindex article customization
11146
11147 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11148 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11149 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11150 called automatically when you select the articles.
11151
11152 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11153 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11154 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11155 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11156
11157 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11158 for sensible values.
11159
11160 @enumerate
11161 @item
11162 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11163
11164 @item
11165 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11166
11167 @item
11168 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11169
11170 @item
11171 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11172
11173 @item
11174 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11175 than this number.
11176
11177 @item
11178 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11179 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11180 regexps in the list.
11181
11182 @item
11183 A list where the first element is not a string:
11184
11185 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11186 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11187 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11188
11189 @lisp
11190 (or last
11191 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11192 @end lisp
11193
11194 @end enumerate
11195
11196 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11197 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11198 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11199 considered to contain just a single part.
11200
11201 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11202 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11203 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11204 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11205 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11206 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11207 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11208
11209 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11210 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11211 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11212 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11213
11214 @table @code
11215 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11216 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11217
11218 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11219
11220 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11221 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11222 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11223 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11224 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11225 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11226 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11227 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11228 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11229 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11230
11231 @xref{Article Washing}.
11232
11233 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11234 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11235 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11236 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11237 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11238 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11239 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11240
11241 @xref{Article Date}.
11242
11243 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11244 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11245 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11246
11247 @xref{Picons}.
11248
11249 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11250
11251 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11252
11253 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11254 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11255 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11256
11257 @xref{Smileys}.
11258
11259 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11260
11261 @xref{X-Face}.
11262
11263 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11264
11265 @xref{Face}.
11266
11267 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11268 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11269 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11270 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11271 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11272 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11273 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11274 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11275 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11276 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11277
11278 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11279
11280 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11281 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11282 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11283
11284 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11285
11286 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11287 @item gnus-treat-translate
11288 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11289
11290 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11291 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11292 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11293 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11294
11295 @xref{Article Header}.
11296
11297
11298 @end table
11299
11300 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11301 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11302 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11303 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11304 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11305 everything.
11306
11307
11308 @node Article Keymap
11309 @section Article Keymap
11310
11311 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11312 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11313 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11314 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11315 buffer.
11316
11317 @kindex v (Article)
11318 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
11319 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
11320 function or better use it as a prefix key.
11321
11322 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11323
11324 @table @kbd
11325
11326 @item SPACE
11327 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11328 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11329 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11330 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11331
11332 @item DEL
11333 @kindex DEL (Article)
11334 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11335 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11336 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11337
11338 @item C-c ^
11339 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11340 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11341 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11342 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11343 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11344
11345 @item C-c C-m
11346 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11347 @findex gnus-article-mail
11348 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11349 given a prefix, include the mail.
11350
11351 @item s
11352 @kindex s (Article)
11353 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11354 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11355 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11356
11357 @item ?
11358 @kindex ? (Article)
11359 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11360 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11361 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11362
11363 @item TAB
11364 @kindex TAB (Article)
11365 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11366 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11367 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11368
11369 @item M-TAB
11370 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11371 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11372 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11373
11374 @item R
11375 @kindex R (Article)
11376 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11377 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11378 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11379 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11380 region.
11381
11382 @item F
11383 @kindex F (Article)
11384 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11385 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11386 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11387 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11388 region.
11389
11390
11391 @end table
11392
11393
11394 @node Misc Article
11395 @section Misc Article
11396
11397 @table @code
11398
11399 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11400 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11401 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11402 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11403 article buffer.
11404
11405 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11406 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11407 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11408 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11409 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11410
11411 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11412 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11413 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11414 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11415 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11416 the contents of the article buffer.
11417
11418 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11419 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11420 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11421
11422 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11423 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11424 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11425 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11426
11427 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11428 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11429 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11430 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11431
11432 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11433 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11434 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11435 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11436 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11437 with two extensions:
11438
11439 @table @samp
11440
11441 @item w
11442 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11443 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11444 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11445
11446 @table @samp
11447
11448 @item c
11449 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11450
11451 @item h
11452 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11453
11454 @item p
11455 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11456 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11457 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11458
11459 @item s
11460 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11461
11462 @item o
11463 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11464
11465 @item e
11466 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11467
11468 @end table
11469
11470 @item m
11471 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11472
11473 @end table
11474
11475 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11476
11477 @item gnus-break-pages
11478 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11479 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11480 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11481 paging will not be done.
11482
11483 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11484 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11485 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11486 (formfeed).
11487
11488 @cindex IDNA
11489 @cindex internationalized domain names
11490 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11491 @item gnus-use-idna
11492 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11493 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11494 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11495 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11496 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11497
11498 @end table
11499
11500
11501 @node Composing Messages
11502 @chapter Composing Messages
11503 @cindex composing messages
11504 @cindex messages
11505 @cindex mail
11506 @cindex sending mail
11507 @cindex reply
11508 @cindex followup
11509 @cindex post
11510 @cindex using gpg
11511 @cindex using s/mime
11512 @cindex using smime
11513
11514 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11515 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11516 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11517 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11518 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11519 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11520
11521 @menu
11522 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11523 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11524 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11525 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11526 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11527 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11528 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11529 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11530 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11531 @end menu
11532
11533 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11534 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11535
11536
11537 @node Mail
11538 @section Mail
11539
11540 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11541
11542 @table @code
11543 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11544 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11545 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11546 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11547 @code{nil} include all headers.
11548
11549 @item gnus-add-to-list
11550 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11551 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11552 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11553
11554 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11555 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11556 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11557 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11558 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11559 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11560 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11561 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11562
11563 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11564 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11565
11566 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11567 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11568 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11569 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11570 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11571
11572 @end table
11573
11574
11575 @node Posting Server
11576 @section Posting Server
11577
11578 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11579 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11580
11581 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11582
11583 It can be quite complicated.
11584
11585 @vindex gnus-post-method
11586 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11587 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11588 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11589 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11590 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11591 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11592 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11593 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11594 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11595
11596 @lisp
11597 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11598 @end lisp
11599
11600 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11601 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11602 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11603 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11604
11605 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11606 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11607
11608 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11609 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11610 for posting.
11611
11612 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11613 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11614
11615 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11616 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11617 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11618 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11619 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11620 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11621 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11622 package correctly. An example:
11623
11624 @lisp
11625 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11626 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11627 @end lisp
11628
11629 To the thing similar to this, there is
11630 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11631 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11632 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11633
11634 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11635 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11636 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11637
11638 @node POP before SMTP
11639 @section POP before SMTP
11640 @cindex pop before smtp
11641 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11642 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11643
11644 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11645 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11646 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11647 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11648 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11649
11650 @lisp
11651 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11652 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11653 @end lisp
11654
11655 @noindent
11656 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11657 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11658 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11659 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11660 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11661 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11662 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11663 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11664
11665 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11666 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11667 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11668 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11669 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11670 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11671
11672 @lisp
11673 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11674 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11675 :password "secret"))
11676 @end lisp
11677
11678 @noindent
11679 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11680 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11681
11682 @lisp
11683 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11684 (lambda ()
11685 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11686 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11687 :password "secret")))
11688 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11689 @end lisp
11690
11691 @node Mail and Post
11692 @section Mail and Post
11693
11694 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11695 posting:
11696
11697 @table @code
11698 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11699 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11700 @cindex mailing lists
11701
11702 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11703 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11704 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11705 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11706 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11707 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11708 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11709 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11710 still a pain, though.
11711
11712 @item gnus-user-agent
11713 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11714 @cindex User-Agent
11715
11716 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11717 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11718 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11719 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11720 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11721 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11722 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11723
11724 @end table
11725
11726 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11727 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11728 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11729
11730 @cindex ispell
11731 @findex ispell-message
11732 @lisp
11733 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11734 @end lisp
11735
11736 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11737 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11738
11739 @lisp
11740 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11741 (lambda ()
11742 (cond
11743 ((string-match
11744 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11745 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11746 (t
11747 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11748 @end lisp
11749
11750 Modify to suit your needs.
11751
11752
11753 @node Archived Messages
11754 @section Archived Messages
11755 @cindex archived messages
11756 @cindex sent messages
11757
11758 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11759 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11760 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11761 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11762 is the default.
11763
11764 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11765 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11766 Group Commands}).
11767
11768 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11769 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11770 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11771
11772 @lisp
11773 (nnfolder "archive"
11774 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11775 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11776 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11777 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11778 @end lisp
11779
11780 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11781 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11782 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11783 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11784
11785 @lisp
11786 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11787 '(nnfolder "archive"
11788 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11789 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11790 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11791 @end lisp
11792
11793 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11794 @cindex Gcc
11795 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11796 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11797 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11798
11799 This variable can be used to do the following:
11800
11801 @table @asis
11802 @item a string
11803 Messages will be saved in that group.
11804
11805 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11806 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11807 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11808 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11809 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11810 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11811 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11812 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11813 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11814
11815 @item a list of strings
11816 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11817
11818 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11819 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11820
11821 @item @code{nil}
11822 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11823 @end table
11824
11825 Let's illustrate:
11826
11827 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11828 @lisp
11829 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11830 @end lisp
11831
11832 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11833 @lisp
11834 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11835 @end lisp
11836
11837 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11838 @lisp
11839 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11840 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11841 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11842 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11843 @end lisp
11844
11845 More complex stuff:
11846 @lisp
11847 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11848 '((if (message-news-p)
11849 "misc-news"
11850 "misc-mail")))
11851 @end lisp
11852
11853 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11854 messages in one file per month:
11855
11856 @lisp
11857 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11858 '((if (message-news-p)
11859 "misc-news"
11860 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11861 @end lisp
11862
11863 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11864 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11865
11866 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11867 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11868 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11869 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11870 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11871 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11872 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11873 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11874 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11875 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11876
11877 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11878 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11879 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11880 this will disable archiving.
11881
11882 @table @code
11883 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11884 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11885 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11886 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11887 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11888 group names.
11889
11890 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11891 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11892 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11893 of names).
11894
11895 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11896 but the latter is the preferred method.
11897
11898 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11899 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11900 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11901
11902 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11903 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11904 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11905 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11906 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11907 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11908 changed in the future.
11909
11910 @end table
11911
11912
11913 @node Posting Styles
11914 @section Posting Styles
11915 @cindex posting styles
11916 @cindex styles
11917
11918 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11919
11920 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11921 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11922 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11923 on?
11924
11925 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11926 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11927 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11928 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11929 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11930 variable:
11931
11932 @lisp
11933 ((".*"
11934 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11935 (organization "What me?"))
11936 ("^comp"
11937 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11938 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11939 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11940 @end lisp
11941
11942 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11943 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11944 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11945 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11946 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11947 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11948 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11949 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11950
11951 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11952 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11953 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11954 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11955 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11956 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11957 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11958 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11959 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11960 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11961 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11962 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11963 said to @dfn{match}.
11964
11965 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11966 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11967 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11968 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11969 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11970 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11971 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11972 name can be one of:
11973
11974 @itemize @bullet
11975 @item @code{signature}
11976 @item @code{signature-file}
11977 @item @code{x-face-file}
11978 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11979 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11980 @item @code{body}
11981 @end itemize
11982
11983 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11984 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11985 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11986 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11987 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11988
11989 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11990 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11991 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11992 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11993 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11994 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11995 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11996 references chars lines xref extra.
11997
11998 @vindex message-reply-headers
11999
12000 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12001 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12002 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12003
12004 @findex message-mail-p
12005 @findex message-news-p
12006
12007 So here's a new example:
12008
12009 @lisp
12010 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12011 '((".*"
12012 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12013 (name "User Name")
12014 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12015 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12016 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12017 ("^rec.humor"
12018 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12019 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12020 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12021 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12022 (signature my-news-signature))
12023 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12024 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12025 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12026 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12027 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12028 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12029 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12030 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12031 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12032 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12033 ("nnml:.*"
12034 (From (save-excursion
12035 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
12036 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12037 ("^nn.+:"
12038 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12039 @end lisp
12040
12041 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12042 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12043 if you fill many roles.
12044 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12045 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12046
12047 @node Drafts
12048 @section Drafts
12049 @cindex drafts
12050
12051 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12052 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12053 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12054 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12055 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12056
12057 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12058 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12059 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12060 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12061 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12062 group.)
12063
12064 @cindex nndraft
12065 @vindex nndraft-directory
12066 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12067 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12068 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12069 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12070 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12071 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12072
12073 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12074 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12075 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12076 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12077 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12078 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12079 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12080 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12081 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12082
12083 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12084 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12085 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12086 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12087 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12088 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12089 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12090 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12091 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12092 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12093 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12094 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12095 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12096 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12097 @c
12098 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12099 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12100 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12101
12102 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12103 @kindex D e (Draft)
12104 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12105 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12106 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12107
12108 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12109 Articles}).
12110
12111 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12112 @kindex D s (Draft)
12113 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12114 @kindex D S (Draft)
12115 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12116 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12117 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12118 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12119 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12120 in the buffer.
12121
12122 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12123 @kindex D t (Draft)
12124 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12125 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12126 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12127
12128
12129 @node Rejected Articles
12130 @section Rejected Articles
12131 @cindex rejected articles
12132
12133 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12134 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12135 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12136 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12137
12138 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12139 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12140 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12141 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12142 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12143
12144 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12145 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12146 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12147
12148 @node Signing and encrypting
12149 @section Signing and encrypting
12150 @cindex using gpg
12151 @cindex using s/mime
12152 @cindex using smime
12153
12154 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12155 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12156 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12157 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12158
12159 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12160 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12161 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12162 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12163 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12164 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12165 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12166 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12167 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12168 automatically encrypted messages.
12169
12170 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12171 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12172 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12173
12174 @table @kbd
12175
12176 @item C-c C-m s s
12177 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12178 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12179
12180 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12181
12182 @item C-c C-m s o
12183 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12184 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12185
12186 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12187
12188 @item C-c C-m s p
12189 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12190 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12191
12192 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12193
12194 @item C-c C-m c s
12195 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12196 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12197
12198 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12199
12200 @item C-c C-m c o
12201 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12202 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12203
12204 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12205
12206 @item C-c C-m c p
12207 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12208 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12209
12210 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12211
12212 @item C-c C-m C-n
12213 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12214 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12215 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12216
12217 @end table
12218
12219 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12220
12221 @node Select Methods
12222 @chapter Select Methods
12223 @cindex foreign groups
12224 @cindex select methods
12225
12226 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12227 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12228 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12229 personal mail group.
12230
12231 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12232 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12233 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12234 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12235 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12236 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12237
12238 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12239 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12240
12241 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12242 group as.
12243
12244 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12245 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12246 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12247 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12248 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12249
12250 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12251
12252 @menu
12253 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12254 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12255 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12256 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12257 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12258 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12259 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12260 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12261 @end menu
12262
12263
12264 @node Server Buffer
12265 @section Server Buffer
12266
12267 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12268 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12269 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12270 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12271 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12272 back end represents a virtual server.
12273
12274 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12275 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12276 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12277 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12278
12279 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12280 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12281 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12282 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12283 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12284 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12285 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12286
12287 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12288 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12289
12290 @menu
12291 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12292 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12293 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12294 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12295 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12296 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12297 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12298 @end menu
12299
12300 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12301 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12302
12303
12304 @node Server Buffer Format
12305 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12306 @cindex server buffer format
12307
12308 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12309 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12310 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12311 variable, with some simple extensions:
12312
12313 @table @samp
12314
12315 @item h
12316 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12317
12318 @item n
12319 The name of this server.
12320
12321 @item w
12322 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12323
12324 @item s
12325 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12326
12327 @item a
12328 Whether this server is agentized.
12329 @end table
12330
12331 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12332 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12333 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12334 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12335
12336 @table @samp
12337 @item S
12338 Server name.
12339
12340 @item M
12341 Server method.
12342 @end table
12343
12344 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12345
12346
12347 @node Server Commands
12348 @subsection Server Commands
12349 @cindex server commands
12350
12351 @table @kbd
12352
12353 @item v
12354 @kindex v (Server)
12355 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
12356 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
12357 function or better use it as a prefix key.
12358
12359 @item a
12360 @kindex a (Server)
12361 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12362 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12363
12364 @item e
12365 @kindex e (Server)
12366 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12367 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12368
12369 @item SPACE
12370 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12371 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12372 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12373
12374 @item q
12375 @kindex q (Server)
12376 @findex gnus-server-exit
12377 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12378
12379 @item k
12380 @kindex k (Server)
12381 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12382 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12383
12384 @item y
12385 @kindex y (Server)
12386 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12387 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12388
12389 @item c
12390 @kindex c (Server)
12391 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12392 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12393
12394 @item l
12395 @kindex l (Server)
12396 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12397 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12398
12399 @item s
12400 @kindex s (Server)
12401 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12402 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12403 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12404 servers.
12405
12406 @item g
12407 @kindex g (Server)
12408 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12409 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12410 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12411 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12412
12413 @end table
12414
12415
12416 @node Example Methods
12417 @subsection Example Methods
12418
12419 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12420
12421 @lisp
12422 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12423 @end lisp
12424
12425 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12426
12427 @lisp
12428 (nnspool "")
12429 @end lisp
12430
12431 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12432 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12433 will.
12434
12435 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12436 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12437
12438 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12439 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12440 look like then:
12441
12442 @lisp
12443 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12444 @end lisp
12445
12446 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12447 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12448
12449 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12450 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12451 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12452 your private mail:
12453
12454 @lisp
12455 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12456 @end lisp
12457
12458 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12459 that.)
12460
12461 Here's the method for a public spool:
12462
12463 @lisp
12464 (nnmh "public"
12465 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12466 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12467 @end lisp
12468
12469 @cindex proxy
12470 @cindex firewall
12471
12472 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12473 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12474 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12475 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12476 should probably look something like this:
12477
12478 @lisp
12479 (nntp "firewall"
12480 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12481 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12482 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12483 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12484 @end lisp
12485
12486 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12487 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12488 configuration to the example above:
12489
12490 @lisp
12491 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12492 @end lisp
12493
12494 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12495
12496 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12497 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12498 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12499
12500 @lisp
12501 (nntp "outside"
12502 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12503 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12504 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12505 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12506 @end lisp
12507
12508 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12509 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12510 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12511 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12512
12513
12514 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12515 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12516
12517 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12518 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12519
12520 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12521 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12522 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12523
12524 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12525
12526 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12527 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12528 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12529 will contain the following:
12530
12531 @lisp
12532 (nnml "cache")
12533 @end lisp
12534
12535 Change that to:
12536
12537 @lisp
12538 (nnml "cache"
12539 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12540 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12541 @end lisp
12542
12543 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12544 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12545 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12546
12547
12548 @node Server Variables
12549 @subsection Server Variables
12550 @cindex server variables
12551 @cindex server parameters
12552
12553 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12554 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12555 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12556 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12557 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12558
12559 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12560 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12561 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12562 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12563 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12564 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12565 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12566 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12567 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12568
12569 @lisp
12570 (nnml "public"
12571 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12572 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12573 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12574 @end lisp
12575
12576 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12577
12578 @node Servers and Methods
12579 @subsection Servers and Methods
12580
12581 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12582 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12583 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12584 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12585 over.
12586
12587
12588 @node Unavailable Servers
12589 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12590
12591 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12592 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12593 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12594 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12595 actually the case or not.
12596
12597 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12598 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12599 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12600 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12601 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12602 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12603 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12604 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12605
12606 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12607 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12608
12609 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12610 with the following commands:
12611
12612 @table @kbd
12613
12614 @item O
12615 @kindex O (Server)
12616 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12617 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12618 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12619
12620 @item C
12621 @kindex C (Server)
12622 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12623 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12624 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12625
12626 @item D
12627 @kindex D (Server)
12628 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12629 Mark the current server as unreachable
12630 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12631
12632 @item M-o
12633 @kindex M-o (Server)
12634 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12635 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12636 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12637
12638 @item M-c
12639 @kindex M-c (Server)
12640 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12641 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12642 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12643
12644 @item R
12645 @kindex R (Server)
12646 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12647 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12648 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12649
12650 @item L
12651 @kindex L (Server)
12652 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12653 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12654
12655 @end table
12656
12657
12658 @node Getting News
12659 @section Getting News
12660 @cindex reading news
12661 @cindex news back ends
12662
12663 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12664 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12665 or it can read from a local spool.
12666
12667 @menu
12668 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12669 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12670 @end menu
12671
12672
12673 @node NNTP
12674 @subsection NNTP
12675 @cindex nntp
12676
12677 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12678 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12679 server as the, uhm, address.
12680
12681 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12682 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12683 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12684 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12685
12686 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12687 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12688 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12689
12690 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12691 server:
12692
12693 @table @code
12694
12695 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12696 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12697 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12698 @cindex authinfo
12699 @cindex authentication
12700 @cindex nntp authentication
12701 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12702 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12703 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12704 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12705 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12706 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12707 present in this hook.
12708
12709 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12710 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12711 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12712 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12713 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12714 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12715 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12716 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12717 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12718 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12719 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12720 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12721
12722 @enumerate
12723 @item
12724 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12725
12726 @item
12727 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12728
12729 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12730 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12731 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12732 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12733 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12734 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12735 @samp{force} is explained below.
12736
12737 @end enumerate
12738
12739 Here's an example file:
12740
12741 @example
12742 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12743 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12744 @end example
12745
12746 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12747 have to be first, for instance.
12748
12749 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12750 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12751 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12752 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12753 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12754 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12755 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12756
12757 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12758 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12759
12760 @example
12761 default force yes
12762 @end example
12763
12764 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12765 previously mentioned.
12766
12767 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12768
12769 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12770 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12771 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12772 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12773 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12774
12775 @lisp
12776 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12777 '(("innd" (ding))))
12778 @end lisp
12779
12780 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12781
12782 The default value is
12783
12784 @lisp
12785 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12786 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12787 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12788 @end lisp
12789
12790 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12791 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12792
12793 @item nntp-maximum-request
12794 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12795 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12796 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12797 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12798 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12799 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12800 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12801
12802 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12803 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12804 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12805 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12806 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12807 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12808 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12809 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12810 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12811 no timeouts are done.
12812
12813 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12814 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12815 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12816 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12817 can be used.
12818
12819 @item nntp-xover-commands
12820 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12821 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12822 @cindex XOVER
12823 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12824 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12825 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12826
12827 @item nntp-nov-gap
12828 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12829 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12830 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12831 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12832 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12833 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12834 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12835 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12836 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12837 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12838 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12839
12840 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12841 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12842 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12843
12844 @item nntp-record-commands
12845 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12846 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12847 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12848 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12849 that doesn't seem to work.
12850
12851 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12852 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12853 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12854 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12855 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12856 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12857 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
12858 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12859
12860 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12861 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12862 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12863 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12864 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12865 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12866 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12867
12868 @lisp
12869 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12870 @end lisp
12871
12872 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12873 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12874
12875 @end table
12876
12877 @menu
12878 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12879 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12880 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12881 @end menu
12882
12883
12884 @node Direct Functions
12885 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12886 @cindex direct connection functions
12887
12888 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12889 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12890 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12891 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12892
12893 @table @code
12894 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12895 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12896 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12897 remote system.
12898
12899 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12900 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12901 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12902 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12903 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12904
12905 @lisp
12906 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12907 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12908 ;;
12909 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12910 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12911 (nntp-port-number )
12912 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12913 @end lisp
12914
12915 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12916 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12917 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12918 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12919 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12920 then define a server as follows:
12921
12922 @lisp
12923 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12924 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12925 ;;
12926 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12927 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12928 (nntp-port-number 563)
12929 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12930 @end lisp
12931
12932 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12933 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12934 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12935 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12936 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12937 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12938 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12939 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12940
12941 @lisp
12942 (nntp "socksified"
12943 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12944 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12945 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12946 @end lisp
12947
12948 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12949 session, which is not a good idea.
12950 @end table
12951
12952
12953 @node Indirect Functions
12954 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12955 @cindex indirect connection functions
12956
12957 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12958 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12959 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12960 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12961 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12962 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12963
12964 @table @code
12965 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12966 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12967 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12968 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12969 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12970
12971 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12972
12973 @table @code
12974 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12975 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12976 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12977 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12978
12979 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12980 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12981 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12982 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12983 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12984 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12985 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12986 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12987 host.
12988 @end table
12989
12990 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12991 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12992 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12993 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12994
12995 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12996
12997 @table @code
12998 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12999 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13000 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13001 @samp{telnet}.
13002
13003 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13004 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13005 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13006 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13007
13008 @item nntp-via-user-password
13009 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13010 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13011
13012 @item nntp-via-envuser
13013 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13014 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13015 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13016 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13017
13018 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13019 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13020 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13021 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13022
13023 @end table
13024
13025 @end table
13026
13027
13028 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13029 functions:
13030
13031 @table @code
13032
13033 @item nntp-via-user-name
13034 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13035 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13036
13037 @item nntp-via-address
13038 @vindex nntp-via-address
13039 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13040
13041 @end table
13042
13043
13044 @node Common Variables
13045 @subsubsection Common Variables
13046
13047 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13048 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13049 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13050 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13051 variables individually).
13052
13053 @table @code
13054
13055 @item nntp-pre-command
13056 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13057 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13058 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
13059 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
13060 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
13061
13062 @item nntp-address
13063 @vindex nntp-address
13064 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13065
13066 @item nntp-port-number
13067 @vindex nntp-port-number
13068 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13069 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
13070 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
13071 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
13072 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
13073 not work with named ports.
13074
13075 @item nntp-end-of-line
13076 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
13077 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
13078 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
13079 using a non native connection function.
13080
13081 @item nntp-telnet-command
13082 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13083 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13084 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
13085 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13086 @samp{telnet}.
13087
13088 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13089 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13090 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13091 is @samp{("-8")}.
13092
13093 @end table
13094
13095
13096 @node News Spool
13097 @subsection News Spool
13098 @cindex nnspool
13099 @cindex news spool
13100
13101 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13102 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13103 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13104 instance.
13105
13106 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13107 anything else) as the address.
13108
13109 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13110 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13111 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13112 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13113
13114 @table @code
13115
13116 @item nnspool-inews-program
13117 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13118 Program used to post an article.
13119
13120 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13121 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13122 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13123
13124 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13125 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13126 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13127 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13128
13129 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13130 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13131 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13132 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13133
13134 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13135 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13136 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13137
13138 @item nnspool-active-file
13139 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13140 The name of the active file.
13141
13142 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13143 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13144 The name of the group descriptions file.
13145
13146 @item nnspool-history-file
13147 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13148 The name of the news history file.
13149
13150 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13151 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13152 The name of the active date file.
13153
13154 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13155 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13156 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13157 that it finds.
13158
13159 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13160 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13161 @cindex sed
13162 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13163 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13164 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13165 there.
13166
13167 @end table
13168
13169
13170 @node Getting Mail
13171 @section Getting Mail
13172 @cindex reading mail
13173 @cindex mail
13174
13175 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13176 course.
13177
13178 @menu
13179 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13180 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13181 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13182 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13183 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13184 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13185 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13186 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13187 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13188 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13189 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13190 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13191 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13192 @end menu
13193
13194
13195 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13196 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13197
13198 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13199 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13200 of a culture shock.
13201
13202 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13203 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13204
13205 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13206 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13207 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13208 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13209
13210 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13211
13212 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13213 deleted? How awful!
13214
13215 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13216 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13217 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13218 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13219 Mail}.
13220
13221 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13222 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13223 they want to treat a message.
13224
13225 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13226 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13227 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13228 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13229 archived somewhere else.
13230
13231 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13232 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13233 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13234 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13235 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13236
13237 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13238 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13239 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13240
13241 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13242 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13243 differently.
13244
13245 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13246 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13247 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13248 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13249 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13250
13251 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13252 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13253 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13254 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13255 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13256 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13257 You Do.)
13258
13259
13260 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13261 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13262
13263 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13264 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13265 and things will happen automatically.
13266
13267 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13268 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13269
13270 @lisp
13271 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13272 @end lisp
13273
13274 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13275 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13276 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13277 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13278 like any other group.
13279
13280 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13281
13282 @lisp
13283 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13284 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13285 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13286 ("other" "")))
13287 @end lisp
13288
13289 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13290 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13291 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13292 last group.
13293
13294 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13295 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13296 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13297
13298
13299 @node Splitting Mail
13300 @subsection Splitting Mail
13301 @cindex splitting mail
13302 @cindex mail splitting
13303 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13304
13305 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13306 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13307 to be split into groups.
13308
13309 @lisp
13310 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13311 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13312 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13313 ("mail.other" "")))
13314 @end lisp
13315
13316 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13317 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13318 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13319 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13320 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13321 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13322 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13323
13324 @lisp
13325 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13326 @end lisp
13327
13328 @noindent
13329 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13330 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13331
13332 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13333 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13334 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13335 mail belongs in that group.
13336
13337 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13338 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13339 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13340 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13341 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13342 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13343 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13344 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13345 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13346 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13347
13348 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13349 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13350 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13351 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13352 thinks should carry this mail message.
13353
13354 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13355 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13356 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13357 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13358
13359 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13360 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13361 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13362 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13363 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13364
13365 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13366 @cindex crosspost
13367 @cindex links
13368 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13369 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13370 links. If that's the case for you, set
13371 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13372 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13373
13374 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13375 @findex nnmail-split-history
13376 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13377 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13378 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13379 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13380 Group Commands}).
13381
13382 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13383 Header lines longer than the value of
13384 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13385 function.
13386
13387 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13388 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13389 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13390 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13391 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13392 charset for decoding. The behavior can be turned off completely by
13393 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13394 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13395
13396 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13397 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13398 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13399 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13400 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13401 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13402 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13403 other kinds of entries.)
13404
13405 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13406 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13407 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13408 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13409 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13410 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13411 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13412 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13413 month's rent money.
13414
13415
13416 @node Mail Sources
13417 @subsection Mail Sources
13418
13419 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13420 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13421 maildir, for instance.
13422
13423 @menu
13424 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13425 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13426 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13427 @end menu
13428
13429
13430 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13431 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13432 @cindex POP
13433 @cindex mail server
13434 @cindex procmail
13435 @cindex mail spool
13436 @cindex mail source
13437
13438 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13439 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13440
13441 Here's an example:
13442
13443 @lisp
13444 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13445 @end lisp
13446
13447 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13448 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13449 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13450 default values.
13451
13452 The following mail source types are available:
13453
13454 @table @code
13455 @item file
13456 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13457
13458 Keywords:
13459
13460 @table @code
13461 @item :path
13462 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13463 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13464 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13465
13466 @item :prescript
13467 @itemx :postscript
13468 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13469 @end table
13470
13471 An example file mail source:
13472
13473 @lisp
13474 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13475 @end lisp
13476
13477 Or using the default file name:
13478
13479 @lisp
13480 (file)
13481 @end lisp
13482
13483 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13484 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13485 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13486 mail spool while moving the mail.
13487
13488 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13489
13490 @lisp
13491 (setq mail-sources
13492 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13493 @end lisp
13494
13495 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13496
13497 @example
13498 #!/bin/sh
13499 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13500 # flu@@iki.fi
13501
13502 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13503 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13504 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13505 @end example
13506
13507 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13508
13509
13510 @item directory
13511 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13512 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13513 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13514 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13515 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13516 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13517 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13518 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13519 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13520 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13521
13522 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13523 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13524 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13525 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13526
13527 Keywords:
13528
13529 @table @code
13530 @item :path
13531 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13532 value.
13533
13534 @item :suffix
13535 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13536 @samp{.spool}.
13537
13538 @item :predicate
13539 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13540 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13541 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13542 predicate are considered.
13543
13544 @item :prescript
13545 @itemx :postscript
13546 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13547
13548 @end table
13549
13550 An example directory mail source:
13551
13552 @lisp
13553 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13554 :suffix ".prcml")
13555 @end lisp
13556
13557 @item pop
13558 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13559
13560 Keywords:
13561
13562 @table @code
13563 @item :server
13564 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13565 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13566
13567 @item :port
13568 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13569 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13570 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13571 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13572 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13573
13574 @item :user
13575 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13576 name.
13577
13578 @item :password
13579 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13580 the user is prompted.
13581
13582 @item :program
13583 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13584 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13585
13586 @example
13587 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13588 @end example
13589
13590 The valid format specifier characters are:
13591
13592 @table @samp
13593 @item t
13594 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13595 included in this string.
13596
13597 @item s
13598 The name of the server.
13599
13600 @item P
13601 The port number of the server.
13602
13603 @item u
13604 The user name to use.
13605
13606 @item p
13607 The password to use.
13608 @end table
13609
13610 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13611 corresponding keywords.
13612
13613 @item :prescript
13614 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13615 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13616
13617 @item :postscript
13618 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13619 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13620
13621 @item :function
13622 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13623 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13624 mail should be moved to.
13625
13626 @item :authentication
13627 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13628 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13629 @code{password}.
13630
13631 @end table
13632
13633 @vindex pop3-movemail
13634 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13635 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13636 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
13637 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
13638 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
13639 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
13640 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
13641 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
13642 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13643
13644 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13645 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
13646 name, and default fetcher:
13647
13648 @lisp
13649 (pop)
13650 @end lisp
13651
13652 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13653
13654 @lisp
13655 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13656 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13657 @end lisp
13658
13659 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13660
13661 @lisp
13662 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13663 @end lisp
13664
13665 @item maildir
13666 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13667 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13668 contains exactly one mail.
13669
13670 Keywords:
13671
13672 @table @code
13673 @item :path
13674 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13675 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13676 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13677 @item :subdirs
13678 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13679 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13680
13681 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13682 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13683 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13684 @c below.
13685
13686 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13687 from locking problems).
13688
13689 @end table
13690
13691 Two example maildir mail sources:
13692
13693 @lisp
13694 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13695 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13696 @end lisp
13697
13698 @lisp
13699 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13700 :subdirs ("new"))
13701 @end lisp
13702
13703 @item imap
13704 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13705 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13706 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13707 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13708 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13709
13710 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13711 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13712
13713 Keywords:
13714
13715 @table @code
13716 @item :server
13717 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13718 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13719
13720 @item :port
13721 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13722 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13723
13724 @item :user
13725 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13726 name.
13727
13728 @item :password
13729 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13730 prompted.
13731
13732 @item :stream
13733 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13734 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13735 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13736 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13737
13738 @item :authentication
13739 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13740 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13741 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13742 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13743
13744 @item :program
13745 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13746 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13747 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13748
13749 @example
13750 ssh %s imapd
13751 @end example
13752
13753 The valid format specifier characters are:
13754
13755 @table @samp
13756 @item s
13757 The name of the server.
13758
13759 @item l
13760 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13761
13762 @item p
13763 The port number of the server.
13764 @end table
13765
13766 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13767 corresponding keywords.
13768
13769 @item :mailbox
13770 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13771 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13772
13773 @item :predicate
13774 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13775 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13776 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13777 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13778 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13779 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13780
13781 @item :fetchflag
13782 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13783 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13784 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13785 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13786
13787 @item :dontexpunge
13788 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13789 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13790
13791 @end table
13792
13793 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13794
13795 @lisp
13796 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13797 :stream kerberos4
13798 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13799 @end lisp
13800
13801 @item webmail
13802 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13803 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13804 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13805
13806 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13807 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13808
13809 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13810
13811 Keywords:
13812
13813 @table @code
13814 @item :subtype
13815 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13816 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13817
13818 @item :user
13819 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13820 name.
13821
13822 @item :password
13823 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13824 prompted.
13825
13826 @item :dontexpunge
13827 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13828 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13829
13830 @end table
13831
13832 An example webmail source:
13833
13834 @lisp
13835 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13836 :user "user-name"
13837 :password "secret")
13838 @end lisp
13839 @end table
13840
13841 @table @dfn
13842 @item Common Keywords
13843 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13844
13845 Keywords:
13846
13847 @table @code
13848 @item :plugged
13849 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13850 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13851 example:
13852
13853 @lisp
13854 (setq mail-sources
13855 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13856 :suffix ""
13857 :plugged t)))
13858 @end lisp
13859
13860 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13861 useful when you use local mail and news.
13862
13863 @end table
13864 @end table
13865
13866 @subsubsection Function Interface
13867
13868 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13869 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13870 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13871 consider the following mail-source setting:
13872
13873 @lisp
13874 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13875 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13876 @end lisp
13877
13878 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13879 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13880 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13881 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13882 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13883
13884 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13885
13886
13887 @node Mail Source Customization
13888 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13889
13890 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13891 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13892 variables.
13893
13894 @table @code
13895 @item mail-source-crash-box
13896 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13897 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13898 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13899
13900 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13901 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13902 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13903 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13904 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13905 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13906 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13907 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13908
13909 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13910 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13911 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13912 files. This variable only applies when
13913 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13914
13915 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13916 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13917 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13918
13919 @item mail-source-directory
13920 @vindex mail-source-directory
13921 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13922 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13923 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13924 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13925
13926 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13927 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13928 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13929 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13930 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13931 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
13932 number.
13933
13934 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13935 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13936 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13937
13938 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13939 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13940 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13941 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13942
13943 @end table
13944
13945
13946 @node Fetching Mail
13947 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13948
13949 @vindex mail-sources
13950 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13951 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13952 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13953 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13954
13955 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13956 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13957 themselves.
13958
13959 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13960 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13961
13962 @lisp
13963 (setq mail-sources
13964 '((file)
13965 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13966 :password "secret")))
13967 @end lisp
13968
13969 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13970
13971 @lisp
13972 (setq mail-sources
13973 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13974 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13975 :user "user-name"
13976 :port "pop3"
13977 :password "secret")))
13978 @end lisp
13979
13980
13981 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13982 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13983 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13984 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13985 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13986 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13987
13988
13989
13990 @node Mail Back End Variables
13991 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13992
13993 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13994 mail back ends.
13995
13996 @table @code
13997 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13998 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13999 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
14000 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
14001
14002 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
14003 @item nnmail-split-hook
14004 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
14005 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
14006 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
14007 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
14008 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
14009 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
14010 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
14011 in the buffer will show up in any files.
14012 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
14013 to this hook.
14014
14015 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14016 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14017 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14018 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14019 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
14020 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
14021 starting to handle the new mail) and
14022 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
14023 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
14024 default file modes the new mail files get:
14025
14026 @lisp
14027 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14028 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
14029
14030 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14031 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
14032 @end lisp
14033
14034 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
14035 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
14036 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
14037 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
14038 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
14039 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
14040 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
14041
14042 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
14043 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
14044 @findex delete-file
14045 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
14046
14047 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14048 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14049 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
14050 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
14051 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
14052
14053 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14054 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14055 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
14056 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
14057 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
14058
14059 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
14060 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
14061 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
14062
14063 @end table
14064
14065
14066 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
14067 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
14068 @cindex mail splitting
14069 @cindex fancy mail splitting
14070
14071 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
14072 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
14073 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
14074 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
14075 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
14076 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
14077
14078 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
14079
14080 @lisp
14081 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
14082 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
14083 ;; @r{from real errors.}
14084 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
14085 "mail.misc"))
14086 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
14087 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
14088 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
14089 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
14090 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
14091 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
14092 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
14093 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
14094 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
14095 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14096 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14097 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14098 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14099 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14100 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14101 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14102 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14103 "misc.misc")
14104 @end lisp
14105
14106 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14107 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14108 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14109
14110 @table @code
14111
14112 @item group
14113 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14114 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14115
14116 @c Don't fold this line.
14117 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14118 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14119 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14120 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14121 @var{split}.
14122
14123 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14124 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14125 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14126 @var{split} is processed.
14127
14128 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14129 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14130 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14131 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14132
14133 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14134 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14135 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14136 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14137 stored in one or more groups.
14138
14139 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14140 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14141 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14142
14143 @item junk
14144 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14145 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14146
14147 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14148 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14149 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14150 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14151
14152 @cindex body split
14153 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14154 body of the messages:
14155
14156 @lisp
14157 (defun split-on-body ()
14158 (save-excursion
14159 (save-restriction
14160 (widen)
14161 (goto-char (point-min))
14162 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14163 "string.group"))))
14164 @end lisp
14165
14166 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14167 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14168 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14169 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14170 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14171 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14172 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14173
14174 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14175 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14176 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14177 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14178 should return a split.
14179
14180 @item nil
14181 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14182
14183 @end table
14184
14185 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14186
14187 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14188 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14189 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14190 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14191 for example,
14192
14193 @example
14194 (any "joe" "joemail")
14195 @end example
14196
14197 @noindent
14198 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14199 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14200 of the following three ways:
14201
14202 @enumerate
14203 @item
14204 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14205 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14206 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14207 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14208 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14209 @code{nil}.
14210
14211 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14212
14213 @item
14214 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14215 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14216 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14217 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14218 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14219
14220 @item
14221 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14222 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14223 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14224 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14225 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14226 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14227 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14228 @end enumerate
14229
14230 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14231 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14232 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14233 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14234 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14235 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14236 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14237
14238 @table @code
14239 @item from
14240 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14241 @item to
14242 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14243 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14244 @item any
14245 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14246 @end table
14247
14248 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14249 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14250 when all this splitting is performed.
14251
14252 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14253 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14254 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14255
14256 @example
14257 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14258 @end example
14259
14260 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14261 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14262
14263 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14264 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14265 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14266 groupings 1 through 9.
14267
14268 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14269 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14270 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14271 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14272 groups when users send to an address using different case
14273 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14274 is @code{t}.
14275
14276 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14277 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14278 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14279 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14280 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14281 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14282 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14283 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14284 it once per thread.
14285
14286 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14287 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14288 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14289 using the colon feature, like so:
14290 @lisp
14291 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14292 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14293 nnmail-split-fancy
14294 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14295 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14296 ))
14297 @end lisp
14298
14299 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14300 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14301 in the file specified by the variable
14302 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14303 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14304 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14305 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14306 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14307 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14308 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14309 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14310 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14311 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14312 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14313 300 kBytes in size.)
14314 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14315 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14316 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14317 messages goes into the new group.
14318
14319 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14320 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14321 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14322 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14323 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14324 ``outgoing'' group.
14325
14326
14327 @node Group Mail Splitting
14328 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14329 @cindex mail splitting
14330 @cindex group mail splitting
14331
14332 @findex gnus-group-split
14333 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14334 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14335 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14336 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14337 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14338 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14339 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14340 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14341
14342 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14343 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14344 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14345 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14346
14347 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14348 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14349 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14350 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14351 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14352 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14353 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14354
14355 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14356 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14357 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14358 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14359 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14360 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14361 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14362
14363 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14364 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14365 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14366 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14367 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14368 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14369 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14370 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14371 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14372 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14373 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14374 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14375 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14376
14377 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14378 been defined:
14379
14380 @example
14381 nnml:mail.bar:
14382 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14383 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14384 nnml:mail.foo:
14385 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14386 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14387 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14388 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14389 nnml:mail.others:
14390 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14391 @end example
14392
14393 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14394 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14395 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14396
14397 @lisp
14398 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14399 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14400 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14401 "mail.others")
14402 @end lisp
14403
14404 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14405 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14406 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14407 splits like this:
14408
14409 @lisp
14410 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14411 @end lisp
14412
14413 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14414 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14415 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14416 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14417 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14418 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14419 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14420 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14421 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14422
14423 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14424 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14425 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14426 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14427 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14428 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14429 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14430 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14431 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14432
14433 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14434 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14435 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14436 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14437 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14438 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14439
14440 @lisp
14441 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14442 @end lisp
14443
14444 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14445 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14446 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14447 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14448 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14449 value.
14450
14451 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14452 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14453 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14454 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14455
14456 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14457 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14458 @cindex incorporating old mail
14459 @cindex import old mail
14460
14461 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14462 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14463 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14464 your mail groups.
14465
14466 Doing so can be quite easy.
14467
14468 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14469 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14470 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14471 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14472 your @code{nnml} groups.
14473
14474 Here's how:
14475
14476 @enumerate
14477 @item
14478 Go to the group buffer.
14479
14480 @item
14481 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14482 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14483
14484 @item
14485 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14486
14487 @item
14488 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14489 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14490
14491 @item
14492 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14493 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14494 @end enumerate
14495
14496 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14497 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14498 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14499 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14500 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14501
14502 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14503 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14504 using the new mail back end.
14505
14506
14507 @node Expiring Mail
14508 @subsection Expiring Mail
14509 @cindex article expiry
14510
14511 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14512 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14513 different approach to mail reading.
14514
14515 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14516 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14517 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14518 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14519 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14520 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14521 course.
14522
14523 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14524 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14525 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14526 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14527 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14528 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14529 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14530 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14531 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14532
14533 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14534 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14535 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14536 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14537 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14538 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14539 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14540 expirable.
14541
14542 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14543 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14544 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14545 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14546 into its own group.)
14547
14548 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14549 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14550 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14551 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14552 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14553 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14554 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14555 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14556 scoring.
14557
14558 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14559 Groups that match the regular expression
14560 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14561 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14562 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14563
14564 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14565 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14566 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14567 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14568 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14569
14570 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14571 @lisp
14572 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14573 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14574 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14575 @end lisp
14576
14577 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14578 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14579 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14580 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14581 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14582
14583 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14584 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14585
14586 @lisp
14587 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14588 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14589 @end lisp
14590
14591 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14592 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14593
14594 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14595 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14596 don't really mix very well.
14597
14598 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14599 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14600 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14601 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14602 days.
14603
14604 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14605 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14606 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14607 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14608 everywhere else:
14609
14610 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14611 @lisp
14612 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14613 (lambda (group)
14614 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14615 31)
14616 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14617 1)
14618 ((string= group "important")
14619 'never)
14620 (t
14621 6))))
14622 @end lisp
14623
14624 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14625 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14626
14627 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14628 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14629 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14630 @code{never}.
14631
14632 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14633 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14634
14635 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14636 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14637 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14638 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14639 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14640 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14641 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14642 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14643 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14644 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14645 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14646 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14647 name or @code{delete}.
14648
14649 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14650 @lisp
14651 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14652 @end lisp
14653
14654 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14655 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14656 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14657 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14658 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14659
14660 @lisp
14661 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14662 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14663 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14664 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14665 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14666 @end lisp
14667
14668 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14669 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14670 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14671 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14672 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14673 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14674
14675 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14676 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14677 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14678 easier for procmail users.
14679
14680 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14681 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14682 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14683 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14684 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14685 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14686 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14687 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14688 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14689 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14690 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14691 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14692 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14693 with! So there!
14694
14695 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14696
14697 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14698 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14699 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14700 auto-expire turned on.
14701
14702
14703 @node Washing Mail
14704 @subsection Washing Mail
14705 @cindex mail washing
14706 @cindex list server brain damage
14707 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14708
14709 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14710 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14711 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14712 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14713 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14714 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14715
14716 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14717 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14718 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14719 laugh.
14720
14721 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14722 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14723 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14724 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14725
14726 @table @code
14727 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14728 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14729 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14730 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14731 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14732
14733 @table @code
14734 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14735 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14736 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14737 Emacs running on MS machines.
14738
14739 @end table
14740
14741 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14742 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14743 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14744 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14745
14746 @table @code
14747 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14748 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14749 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14750 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14751
14752 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14753 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14754 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14755 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14756 into a feature by documenting it.)
14757
14758 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14759 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14760 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14761 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14762 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14763 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14764 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14765 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14766
14767 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14768 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14769
14770 @lisp
14771 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14772 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14773 @end lisp
14774
14775 This can also be done non-destructively with
14776 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14777
14778 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14779 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14780 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14781
14782 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14783 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14784 @cindex Eudora
14785 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14786 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14787 @code{References} headers.
14788
14789 @end table
14790
14791 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14792 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14793 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14794 include:
14795
14796 @table @code
14797 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14798 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14799 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14800
14801 @end table
14802 @end table
14803
14804
14805 @node Duplicates
14806 @subsection Duplicates
14807
14808 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14809 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14810 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14811 @cindex duplicate mails
14812 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14813 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14814 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14815 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14816 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14817 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14818 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14819 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14820 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14821 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14822 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14823 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14824 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14825
14826 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14827 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14828 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14829 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14830
14831 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14832 @code{nil}.
14833
14834 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14835 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14836 methods:
14837
14838 @lisp
14839 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14840 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14841 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14842 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14843 (any mail "mail.misc")
14844 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14845 [...] ))
14846 @end lisp
14847 @noindent
14848 Or something like:
14849 @lisp
14850 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14851 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14852 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14853 [...]))
14854 @end lisp
14855
14856 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14857 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14858 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14859 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14860 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14861
14862
14863 @node Not Reading Mail
14864 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14865
14866 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14867 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14868 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14869
14870 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14871 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14872 mail, which should help.
14873
14874 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14875 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14876 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14877 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14878 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14879 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14880 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14881 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14882 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14883 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14884 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14885
14886 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14887 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14888 incoming mail.
14889
14890
14891 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14892 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14893
14894 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14895 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14896 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14897
14898 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14899 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14900 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14901 Spool}).
14902
14903 @menu
14904 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14905 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14906 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14907 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14908 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14909 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14910 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14911 @end menu
14912
14913
14914 @node Unix Mail Box
14915 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14916 @cindex nnmbox
14917 @cindex unix mail box
14918
14919 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14920 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14921 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14922 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14923 which group it belongs in.
14924
14925 Virtual server settings:
14926
14927 @table @code
14928 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14929 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14930 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14931 @file{~/mbox}.
14932
14933 @item nnmbox-active-file
14934 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14935 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14936 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14937
14938 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14939 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14940 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14941 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14942 @end table
14943
14944
14945 @node Rmail Babyl
14946 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14947 @cindex nnbabyl
14948 @cindex Rmail mbox
14949
14950 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14951 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14952 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14953 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14954 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14955
14956 Virtual server settings:
14957
14958 @table @code
14959 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14960 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14961 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14962
14963 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14964 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14965 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14966 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14967
14968 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14969 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14970 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14971 @code{t}
14972 @end table
14973
14974
14975 @node Mail Spool
14976 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14977 @cindex nnml
14978 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14979
14980 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14981 format. It should be used with some caution.
14982
14983 @vindex nnml-directory
14984 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14985 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14986 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14987 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14988
14989 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14990 care of all that.
14991
14992 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14993 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14994 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14995 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14996 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14997 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14998 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14999 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
15000
15001 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
15002 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
15003 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
15004 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
15005
15006 @cindex self contained nnml servers
15007 @cindex marks
15008 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
15009 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15010 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15011 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
15012 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
15013 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
15014 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
15015 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
15016 directory).
15017
15018 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
15019 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
15020 them next time it starts.
15021
15022 Virtual server settings:
15023
15024 @table @code
15025 @item nnml-directory
15026 @vindex nnml-directory
15027 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
15028 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
15029 is @file{~/Mail}).
15030
15031 @item nnml-active-file
15032 @vindex nnml-active-file
15033 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
15034 @file{~/Mail/active}.
15035
15036 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
15037 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
15038 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15039 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
15040
15041 @item nnml-get-new-mail
15042 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15043 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
15044 @code{t}.
15045
15046 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
15047 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
15048 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15049 default is @code{nil}.
15050
15051 @item nnml-nov-file-name
15052 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
15053 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
15054
15055 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15056 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15057 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
15058
15059 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
15060 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
15061 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15062 default is @code{nil}.
15063
15064 @item nnml-marks-file-name
15065 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
15066 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
15067
15068 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
15069 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
15070 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
15071 files.
15072
15073 @end table
15074
15075 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
15076 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
15077 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
15078 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
15079 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
15080 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
15081 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
15082 Commands}).
15083
15084
15085 @node MH Spool
15086 @subsubsection MH Spool
15087 @cindex nnmh
15088 @cindex mh-e mail spool
15089
15090 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
15091 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
15092 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
15093 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
15094 for.
15095
15096 Virtual server settings:
15097
15098 @table @code
15099 @item nnmh-directory
15100 @vindex nnmh-directory
15101 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
15102 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15103 @file{~/Mail})
15104
15105 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
15106 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15107 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15108 @code{t}.
15109
15110 @item nnmh-be-safe
15111 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
15112 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15113 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15114 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15115 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15116 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15117 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15118 @end table
15119
15120
15121 @node Maildir
15122 @subsubsection Maildir
15123 @cindex nnmaildir
15124 @cindex maildir
15125
15126 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15127 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15128 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15129 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15130 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15131 within a maildir.
15132
15133 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15134 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15135 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15136 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15137 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15138 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15139 that appear as group in Gnus.
15140
15141 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15142 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15143 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15144
15145 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15146 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15147 another, and you will keep your marks.
15148
15149 Virtual server settings:
15150
15151 @table @code
15152 @item directory
15153 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15154 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15155 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15156 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15157 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15158 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15159 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15160 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15161 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15162 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15163
15164 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15165 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15166 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15167 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15168 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15169 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15170 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15171 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15172 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15173 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15174 value.
15175
15176 @item target-prefix
15177 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15178 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15179 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15180 closed.
15181
15182 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15183 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15184 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15185 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15186 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15187 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15188 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15189 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15190 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15191
15192 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15193 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15194 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15195 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15196 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15197
15198 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15199 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15200 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15201 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15202 @code{force} argument.
15203
15204 @item directory-files
15205 This should be a function with the same interface as
15206 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15207 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15208 parameter is optional; the default is
15209 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15210 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15211 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15212 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15213 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15214 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15215
15216 @item get-new-mail
15217 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15218 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15219 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15220 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15221 value is @code{nil}.
15222
15223 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15224 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15225 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15226 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15227 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15228 @end table
15229
15230 @subsubsection Group parameters
15231
15232 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15233 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15234 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15235 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15236 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15237 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15238 another back end.
15239
15240 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15241 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15242 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15243 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15244 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15245 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15246 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15247 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15248 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15249
15250 @table @code
15251 @item expire-age
15252 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15253 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15254 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15255 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15256 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15257 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15258 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15259 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15260 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15261 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15262 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15263 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15264 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15265
15266 @item expire-group
15267 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15268 @example
15269 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15270 @end example
15271 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15272 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15273 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15274 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15275 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15276 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15277 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15278 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15279 article. So that form can refer to
15280 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15281 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15282 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15283 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15284
15285 @item read-only
15286 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15287 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15288 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15289 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15290 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15291 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15292 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15293 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15294 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15295 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15296 contain extra copies of the articles.
15297
15298 @item directory-files
15299 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15300 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15301 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15302 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15303
15304 @item distrust-Lines:
15305 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15306 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15307 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15308
15309 @item always-marks
15310 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15311 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15312 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15313 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15314 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15315 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15316
15317 @item never-marks
15318 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15319 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15320 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15321 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15322 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15323 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15324 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15325
15326 @item nov-cache-size
15327 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15328 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15329 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15330 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15331 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15332 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15333 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15334 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15335 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15336 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15337 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15338 @end table
15339
15340 @subsubsection Article identification
15341 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15342 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15343 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15344 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15345 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15346 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15347 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15348 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15349 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15350 request the article in the summary buffer.
15351
15352 @subsubsection NOV data
15353 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15354 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15355 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15356 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15357 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15358 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15359 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15360 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15361 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15362 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15363 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15364
15365 @subsubsection Article marks
15366 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15367 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15368 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15369 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15370 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15371 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15372 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15373 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15374
15375 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15376 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15377 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15378 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15379 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15380 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15381 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15382 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15383 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15384
15385
15386 @node Mail Folders
15387 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15388 @cindex nnfolder
15389 @cindex mbox folders
15390 @cindex mail folders
15391
15392 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15393 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15394 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15395 numbers and arrival dates.
15396
15397 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15398 @cindex marks
15399 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15400 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15401 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15402 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15403 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15404 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15405 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15406 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15407 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15408 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15409
15410 Virtual server settings:
15411
15412 @table @code
15413 @item nnfolder-directory
15414 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15415 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15416 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15417 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15418
15419 @item nnfolder-active-file
15420 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15421 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15422
15423 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15424 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15425 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15426 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15427
15428 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15429 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15430 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15431 default is @code{t}
15432
15433 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15434 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15435 @cindex backup files
15436 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15437 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15438 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15439 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15440
15441 @lisp
15442 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15443 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15444
15445 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15446 @end lisp
15447
15448 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15449 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15450 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15451 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15452 extract some information from it before removing it.
15453
15454 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15455 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15456 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15457 default is @code{nil}.
15458
15459 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15460 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15461 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15462
15463 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15464 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15465 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15466 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15467
15468 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15469 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15470 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15471 default is @code{nil}.
15472
15473 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15474 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15475 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15476
15477 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15478 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15479 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15480 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15481
15482 @end table
15483
15484
15485 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15486 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15487 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15488 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15489 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15490 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15491 though.
15492
15493 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15494 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15495
15496 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15497 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15498 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15499 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15500 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15501
15502 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15503 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15504 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15505 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15506 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15507 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15508 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15509 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15510 via NFS).
15511
15512 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15513 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15514 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15515 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15516
15517 @table @code
15518 @item nnmbox
15519
15520 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15521 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15522 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15523 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15524 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15525 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15526 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15527 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15528 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15529 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15530 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15531 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15532 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15533 what's where.
15534
15535 @item nnbabyl
15536
15537 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15538 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15539 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15540 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15541 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15542 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15543 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15544 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15545 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15546 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15547 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15548 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15549 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15550 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15551
15552 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15553 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15554 look at your mail.
15555
15556 @item nnml
15557
15558 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15559 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15560 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15561 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15562 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15563 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15564 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15565 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15566 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15567 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15568 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15569 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15570 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15571 provided by the active file and overviews.
15572
15573 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15574 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15575 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15576 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15577 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15578 wins big.
15579
15580 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15581 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15582 tiny files.
15583
15584 @item nnmh
15585
15586 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15587 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15588 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15589 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15590 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15591 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15592 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15593
15594 @item nnfolder
15595
15596 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15597 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15598 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15599 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15600 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15601 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15602 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15603 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15604 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15605
15606 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15607 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15608 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15609 friendly mail back end all over.
15610
15611 @item nnmaildir
15612
15613 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15614 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15615 mail back ends.
15616
15617 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15618 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15619 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15620 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15621 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15622 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15623 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15624 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15625 file system.
15626
15627 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15628 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15629 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15630 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15631 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15632 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15633 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15634 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15635 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15636 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15637 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15638
15639 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15640 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15641 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15642 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15643 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15644 @code{nnmaildir}.
15645
15646 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15647 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15648 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15649 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15650 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15651 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15652 removed in the future.
15653
15654 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15655 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15656 on your file system.
15657
15658 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15659 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15660
15661 @end table
15662
15663
15664 @node Browsing the Web
15665 @section Browsing the Web
15666 @cindex web
15667 @cindex browsing the web
15668 @cindex www
15669 @cindex http
15670
15671 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15672 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15673 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15674 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15675 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15676 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15677 even know what a news group is.
15678
15679 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15680 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15681 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15682 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15683 you mad in the end.
15684
15685 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15686 to do it instead?
15687
15688 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15689 interfaces to these sources.
15690
15691 @menu
15692 * Archiving Mail::
15693 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15694 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15695 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15696 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15697 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15698 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15699 @end menu
15700
15701 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15702 alternatives to work.
15703
15704 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15705 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15706 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15707 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15708 though, you should be ok.
15709
15710 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15711 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15712 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15713 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15714 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15715
15716 @node Archiving Mail
15717 @subsection Archiving Mail
15718 @cindex archiving mail
15719 @cindex backup of mail
15720
15721 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15722 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15723 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15724 marks is fairly simple.
15725
15726 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15727 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15728 though.)
15729
15730 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15731 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15732 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15733 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15734 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15735 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15736 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15737 before you restore the data.
15738
15739 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15740 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15741 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15742 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15743 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15744 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15745 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15746 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15747 is unnecessary in that case.
15748
15749 @node Web Searches
15750 @subsection Web Searches
15751 @cindex nnweb
15752 @cindex Google
15753 @cindex dejanews
15754 @cindex gmane
15755 @cindex Usenet searches
15756 @cindex searching the Usenet
15757
15758 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15759 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15760 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15761 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15762 searches without having to use a browser.
15763
15764 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15765 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15766 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15767 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15768 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15769
15770 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15771 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15772 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15773 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15774 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15775 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15776 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15777 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15778 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15779 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15780 group as read.
15781
15782 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15783 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15784 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15785 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15786 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15787 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15788
15789 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15790 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15791 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15792
15793 Virtual server variables:
15794
15795 @table @code
15796 @item nnweb-type
15797 @vindex nnweb-type
15798 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15799 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15800 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15801
15802 @item nnweb-search
15803 @vindex nnweb-search
15804 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15805
15806 @item nnweb-max-hits
15807 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15808 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15809 999.
15810
15811 @item nnweb-type-definition
15812 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15813 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15814 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15815 present:
15816
15817 @table @code
15818 @item article
15819 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15820 understands.
15821
15822 @item map
15823 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15824
15825 @item search
15826 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15827
15828 @item address
15829 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15830 to.
15831
15832 @item id
15833 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15834 @end table
15835
15836 @end table
15837
15838
15839 @node Slashdot
15840 @subsection Slashdot
15841 @cindex Slashdot
15842 @cindex nnslashdot
15843
15844 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15845 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15846 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15847
15848 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15849 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15850
15851 @lisp
15852 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15853 '((nnslashdot "")))
15854 @end lisp
15855
15856 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15857 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15858 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15859 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15860 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15861 Methods}).
15862
15863 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15864 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15865
15866 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15867 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15868 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15869 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15870 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15871 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15872 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15873
15874 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15875
15876 @table @code
15877 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15878 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15879 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15880 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15881 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15882 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15883 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15884
15885 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15886 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15887 The login name to use when posting.
15888
15889 @item nnslashdot-password
15890 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15891 The password to use when posting.
15892
15893 @item nnslashdot-directory
15894 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15895 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15896 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15897
15898 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15899 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15900 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15901 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15902 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15903
15904 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15905 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15906 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15907
15908 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15909 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15910 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15911 article. The default is
15912 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15913
15914 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15915 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15916 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15917
15918 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15919 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15920 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15921 updated. The default is 0.
15922
15923 @end table
15924
15925
15926
15927 @node Ultimate
15928 @subsection Ultimate
15929 @cindex nnultimate
15930 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15931
15932 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15933 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15934 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15935 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15936
15937 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15938 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15939 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15940 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15941 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15942 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15943 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15944
15945 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15946
15947 @table @code
15948 @item nnultimate-directory
15949 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15950 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15951 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15952 @end table
15953
15954
15955 @node Web Archive
15956 @subsection Web Archive
15957 @cindex nnwarchive
15958 @cindex Web Archive
15959
15960 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15961 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15962 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15963 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15964 groups updated.
15965
15966 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15967 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15968 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15969 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15970 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15971 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15972 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15973 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15974
15975 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15976
15977 @table @code
15978 @item nnwarchive-directory
15979 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15980 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15981 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15982
15983 @item nnwarchive-login
15984 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15985 The account name on the web server.
15986
15987 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15988 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15989 The password for your account on the web server.
15990 @end table
15991
15992 @node RSS
15993 @subsection RSS
15994 @cindex nnrss
15995 @cindex RSS
15996
15997 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15998 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15999 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16000 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16001 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16002
16003 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16004 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16005
16006 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16007 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16008 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16009 group names.
16010
16011 @kindex G R (Group)
16012 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16013 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16014 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16015 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16016
16017 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16018 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16019 subscribe to groups.
16020
16021 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16022 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16023 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16024 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16025 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
16026 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
16027 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
16028 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
16029
16030 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16031 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16032 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16033
16034 @cindex OPML
16035 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16036 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16037 Markup Language).
16038
16039 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16040 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16041 file.
16042 @end defun
16043
16044 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16045 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16046 @acronym{OPML} format.
16047 @end defun
16048
16049 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16050
16051 @table @code
16052 @item nnrss-directory
16053 @vindex nnrss-directory
16054 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16055 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16056
16057 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16058 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16059 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16060 data files. The default is the value of
16061 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16062 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16063
16064 @item nnrss-use-local
16065 @vindex nnrss-use-local
16066 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16067 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16068 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16069 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16070 download script using @command{wget}.
16071
16072 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
16073 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
16074 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
16075 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
16076 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
16077 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
16078 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
16079 @samp{text/html} parts.
16080 @end table
16081
16082 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16083 the summary buffer.
16084
16085 @lisp
16086 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16087 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16088
16089 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16090 (let ((descr
16091 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
16092 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
16093 @end lisp
16094
16095 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
16096 summary buffer.
16097
16098 @lisp
16099 (require 'browse-url)
16100
16101 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
16102 (interactive "p")
16103 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16104 (mail-header-extra
16105 (gnus-data-header
16106 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16107 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16108 (if url
16109 (progn
16110 (browse-url (cdr url))
16111 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16112 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16113
16114 (eval-after-load "gnus"
16115 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16116 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16117 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16118 @end lisp
16119
16120 Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
16121 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16122 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16123 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16124 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16125 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16126 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16127 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16128 @code{nnrss} groups:
16129
16130 @lisp
16131 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16132 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16133 '(add-to-list
16134 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16135 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16136 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16137
16138 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16139 (add-to-list
16140 'gnus-parameters
16141 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16142 @end lisp
16143
16144
16145 @node Customizing W3
16146 @subsection Customizing W3
16147 @cindex W3
16148 @cindex html
16149 @cindex url
16150 @cindex Netscape
16151
16152 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16153 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16154 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16155 users.
16156
16157 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16158 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16159 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16160
16161 @lisp
16162 (eval-after-load "w3"
16163 '(progn
16164 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16165 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16166 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16167 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16168 (browse-url url)
16169 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16170 @end lisp
16171
16172 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16173 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16174 follow the link.
16175
16176
16177 @node IMAP
16178 @section IMAP
16179 @cindex nnimap
16180 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16181
16182 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16183 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16184 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16185 specify the network address of the server.
16186
16187 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16188 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16189 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16190 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16191 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16192 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16193
16194 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16195 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16196 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16197 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16198
16199 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16200 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16201 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16202 usage explained in this section.
16203
16204 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16205 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16206 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16207 see below.)
16208
16209 @lisp
16210 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16211 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16212 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16213 (nnimap "dolk"
16214 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16215 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16216 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16217 (nnimap "barbar"
16218 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16219 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16220 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16221 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16222 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16223 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16224 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16225 (nnimap-stream network))
16226 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16227 (nnimap "vic20"
16228 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16229 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16230 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16231 @end lisp
16232
16233 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16234 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16235 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16236 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16237
16238 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16239 server:
16240
16241 @table @code
16242
16243 @item nnimap-address
16244 @vindex nnimap-address
16245
16246 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16247 server name if not specified.
16248
16249 @item nnimap-server-port
16250 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16251 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16252
16253 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16254
16255 @lisp
16256 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16257 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16258 @end lisp
16259
16260 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16261 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16262 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16263 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16264 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16265 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16266 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16267
16268 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16269 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16270 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16271 mailbox.
16272
16273 Example server specification:
16274
16275 @lisp
16276 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16277 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16278 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16279 @end lisp
16280
16281 @item nnimap-stream
16282 @vindex nnimap-stream
16283 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16284 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16285 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16286 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16287 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16288
16289 Example server specification:
16290
16291 @lisp
16292 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16293 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16294 @end lisp
16295
16296 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16297
16298 @itemize @bullet
16299 @item
16300 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16301 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16302 @item
16303 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16304 @item
16305 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16306 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16307 @samp{starttls}.
16308 @item
16309 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16310 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16311 @item
16312 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16313 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16314 @item
16315 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16316 @item
16317 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16318 @end itemize
16319
16320 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16321 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16322 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16323 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16324 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16325 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16326 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16327 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16328 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16329 program.
16330
16331 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16332 needed. It is available from
16333 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16334
16335 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16336 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16337 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16338 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16339 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16340 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16341 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16342 tried.
16343
16344 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16345 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16346 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16347 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16348 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16349 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16350 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16351 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16352
16353 @vindex imap-shell-program
16354 @vindex imap-shell-host
16355 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16356 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16357
16358 @item nnimap-authenticator
16359 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16360
16361 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16362 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16363
16364 Example server specification:
16365
16366 @lisp
16367 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16368 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16369 @end lisp
16370
16371 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16372
16373 @itemize @bullet
16374 @item
16375 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16376 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16377 @item
16378 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16379 @code{imtest}.
16380 @item
16381 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16382 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16383 @item
16384 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16385 @item
16386 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16387 @item
16388 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16389 @end itemize
16390
16391 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16392 @cindex expunging
16393 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16394 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16395 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16396 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16397 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16398 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16399 similar).
16400
16401 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16402 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16403 running in circles yet?
16404
16405 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16406 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16407 variable.
16408
16409 The possible options are:
16410
16411 @table @code
16412
16413 @item always
16414 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16415 closing a mailbox.
16416 @item never
16417 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16418 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16419 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16420 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16421 @item ask
16422 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16423 articles or not.
16424
16425 @end table
16426
16427 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16428 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16429
16430 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16431 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16432 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16433 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16434 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16435 has only one.)
16436
16437 Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
16438 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16439
16440 @lisp
16441 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16442 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16443 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16444 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16445 @end lisp
16446
16447 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16448 as ticked for other users.
16449
16450 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16451 @cindex expunging
16452 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16453
16454 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16455 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16456 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16457 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16458
16459 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16460 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16461 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16462 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16463
16464 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16465 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16466
16467 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16468 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16469 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16470 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16471
16472 @example
16473 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16474 @end example
16475
16476 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16477 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16478 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16479 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16480 @code{port imap}.
16481
16482 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16483 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16484
16485 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16486 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16487 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16488
16489 @end table
16490
16491 @menu
16492 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16493 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16494 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16495 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16496 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16497 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16498 @end menu
16499
16500
16501
16502 @node Splitting in IMAP
16503 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16504 @cindex splitting imap mail
16505
16506 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16507 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16508 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16509 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16510 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16511
16512 And it does.
16513
16514 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16515 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16516 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16517
16518 Here are the variables of interest:
16519
16520 @table @code
16521
16522 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16523 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16524 @cindex crosspost
16525 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16526
16527 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16528 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16529 found will be used.
16530
16531 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16532
16533 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16534 @cindex splitting, inbox
16535 @cindex inbox
16536 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16537
16538 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16539 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16540 splitting is disabled!
16541
16542 @lisp
16543 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16544 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16545 @end lisp
16546
16547 No nnmail equivalent.
16548
16549 @item nnimap-split-rule
16550 @cindex splitting, rules
16551 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16552
16553 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16554 this variable.
16555
16556 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16557 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16558 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16559 Neither did I, we need examples.
16560
16561 @lisp
16562 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16563 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16564 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16565 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16566 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16567 @end lisp
16568
16569 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16570 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16571 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16572
16573 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16574 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16575 instance:
16576
16577 @lisp
16578 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16579 @end lisp
16580
16581 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16582 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16583
16584 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16585 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16586 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16587 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16588
16589 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16590 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16591 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16592 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16593 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16594 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16595
16596 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16597 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16598 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16599
16600 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16601 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16602 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16603
16604 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16605
16606 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16607 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16608 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16609
16610 @lisp
16611 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16612 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16613 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16614 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16615 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16616 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16617 @end lisp
16618
16619 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16620 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16621 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16622 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16623 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16624 group/function elements.
16625
16626 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16627
16628 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16629 @cindex splitting
16630 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16631
16632 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16633 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16634
16635 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16636 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16637 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16638 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16639
16640 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16641 @cindex splitting, fancy
16642 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16643 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16644
16645 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16646 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16647 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16648
16649 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16650 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16651 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16652 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16653
16654 Example:
16655
16656 @lisp
16657 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16658 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16659 @end lisp
16660
16661 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16662
16663 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16664 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16665 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16666
16667 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16668 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16669 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16670 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16671
16672 @end table
16673
16674 @node Expiring in IMAP
16675 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16676 @cindex expiring imap mail
16677
16678 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16679 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16680 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16681 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16682 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16683 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16684 process.
16685
16686 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16687 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16688 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16689 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16690 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16691 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16692 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16693 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16694
16695 @table @code
16696
16697 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16698 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16699
16700 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16701 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16702
16703 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16704
16705 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16706 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16707 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16708 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16709
16710 @end table
16711
16712 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16713 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16714 @cindex editing imap acls
16715 @cindex Access Control Lists
16716 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16717 @kindex G l (Group)
16718 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16719
16720 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16721 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16722 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16723 doesn't.
16724
16725 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16726 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16727 editing window with detailed instructions.
16728
16729 Some possible uses:
16730
16731 @itemize @bullet
16732 @item
16733 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16734 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16735 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16736 @item
16737 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16738 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16739 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16740 INBOX.mailbox).
16741 @end itemize
16742
16743 @node Expunging mailboxes
16744 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16745 @cindex expunging
16746
16747 @cindex expunge
16748 @cindex manual expunging
16749 @kindex G x (Group)
16750 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16751
16752 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16753 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16754 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16755
16756 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16757 delete them.
16758
16759 @node A note on namespaces
16760 @subsection A note on namespaces
16761 @cindex IMAP namespace
16762 @cindex namespaces
16763
16764 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16765 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16766
16767 @display
16768 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16769
16770 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16771 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16772 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16773 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16774
16775 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16776 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16777 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16778 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16779 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16780 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16781 @end display
16782
16783 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16784 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16785 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16786
16787 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16788 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16789 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16790 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16791 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16792 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16793 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16794 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16795 Gnus.
16796
16797 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16798 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16799 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16800
16801 @node Debugging IMAP
16802 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16803 @cindex IMAP debugging
16804 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16805
16806 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16807 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16808 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16809 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16810
16811 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16812 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16813 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16814 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16815 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16816 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16817 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16818
16819
16820 @vindex imap-log
16821 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16822 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16823 follows:
16824
16825 @lisp
16826 (setq imap-log t)
16827 @end lisp
16828
16829 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16830 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16831 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16832 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16833 data.
16834
16835 @node Other Sources
16836 @section Other Sources
16837
16838 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16839 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16840 newsgroups.
16841
16842 @menu
16843 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16844 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16845 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16846 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16847 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16848 @end menu
16849
16850
16851 @node Directory Groups
16852 @subsection Directory Groups
16853 @cindex nndir
16854 @cindex directory groups
16855
16856 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16857 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16858 names, of course.
16859
16860 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16861 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16862 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16863 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16864
16865 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16866 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16867 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16868 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16869 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16870
16871 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16872
16873 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16874 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16875 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16876 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16877
16878
16879 @node Anything Groups
16880 @subsection Anything Groups
16881 @cindex nneething
16882
16883 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16884 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16885 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16886 true.
16887
16888 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16889 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16890 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16891 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16892 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16893 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16894 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16895 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16896 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16897 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16898 elements.
16899
16900 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16901 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16902 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16903 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16904
16905 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16906 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16907 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16908 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16909
16910 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16911 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16912 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16913 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16914 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16915 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16916 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16917 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16918
16919 Some variables:
16920
16921 @table @code
16922 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16923 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16924 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16925 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16926
16927 @item nneething-exclude-files
16928 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16929 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16930 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16931
16932 @item nneething-include-files
16933 @vindex nneething-include-files
16934 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16935 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16936
16937 @item nneething-map-file
16938 @vindex nneething-map-file
16939 Name of the map files.
16940 @end table
16941
16942
16943 @node Document Groups
16944 @subsection Document Groups
16945 @cindex nndoc
16946 @cindex documentation group
16947 @cindex help group
16948
16949 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16950 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16951
16952 @table @code
16953 @cindex Babyl
16954 @cindex Rmail mbox
16955 @item babyl
16956 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16957
16958 @cindex mbox
16959 @cindex Unix mbox
16960 @item mbox
16961 The standard Unix mbox file.
16962
16963 @cindex MMDF mail box
16964 @item mmdf
16965 The MMDF mail box format.
16966
16967 @item news
16968 Several news articles appended into a file.
16969
16970 @cindex rnews batch files
16971 @item rnews
16972 The rnews batch transport format.
16973
16974 @item nsmail
16975 Netscape mail boxes.
16976
16977 @item mime-parts
16978 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16979
16980 @item standard-digest
16981 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16982
16983 @item mime-digest
16984 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16985
16986 @item lanl-gov-announce
16987 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16988
16989 @cindex forwarded messages
16990 @item rfc822-forward
16991 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16992
16993 @item outlook
16994 The Outlook mail box.
16995
16996 @item oe-dbx
16997 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16998
16999 @item exim-bounce
17000 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17001
17002 @item forward
17003 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17004
17005 @item rfc934
17006 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17007
17008 @item mailman
17009 A mailman digest.
17010
17011 @item clari-briefs
17012 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17013
17014 @item slack-digest
17015 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17016
17017 @item mail-in-mail
17018 The last resort.
17019 @end table
17020
17021 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17022 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17023 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17024 file is.
17025
17026 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17027 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17028 group. And that's it.
17029
17030 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17031 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17032 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17033 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17034 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17035 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17036 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17037 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17038 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17039 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17040
17041 Virtual server variables:
17042
17043 @table @code
17044 @item nndoc-article-type
17045 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17046 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17047 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17048 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17049 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17050 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17051
17052 @item nndoc-post-type
17053 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17054 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17055 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17056 and @code{news}.
17057 @end table
17058
17059 @menu
17060 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17061 @end menu
17062
17063
17064 @node Document Server Internals
17065 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17066
17067 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17068 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17069 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17070 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17071
17072 First, here's an example document type definition:
17073
17074 @example
17075 (mmdf
17076 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17077 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17078 @end example
17079
17080 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17081 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17082 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17083 types can be defined with very few settings:
17084
17085 @table @code
17086 @item first-article
17087 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17088 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17089 totally ignored.
17090
17091 @item article-begin
17092 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17093 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17094 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17095 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17096
17097 @item article-begin-function
17098 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17099 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17100
17101 @item head-begin
17102 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17103 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17104 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17105
17106 @item head-begin-function
17107 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17108 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17109
17110 @item head-end
17111 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17112 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17113
17114 @item body-begin
17115 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17116 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17117 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17118
17119 @item body-begin-function
17120 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17121 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17122
17123 @item body-end
17124 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17125 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17126 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17127
17128 @item body-end-function
17129 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17130 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17131
17132 @item file-begin
17133 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17134 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17135
17136 @item file-end
17137 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17138 regexp will be totally ignored.
17139
17140 @end table
17141
17142 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17143 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17144 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17145 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17146 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17147
17148 @table @code
17149 @item prepare-body-function
17150 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17151 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17152 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17153
17154 @item article-transform-function
17155 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17156 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17157 body of the article.
17158
17159 @item generate-head-function
17160 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17161 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17162 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17163 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17164
17165 @item generate-article-function
17166 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17167 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17168 parameter when requesting all articles.
17169
17170 @item dissection-function
17171 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17172 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17173 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17174 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17175 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17176 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17177
17178 @end table
17179
17180 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17181 digests:
17182
17183 @example
17184 (standard-digest
17185 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17186 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17187 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17188 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17189 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17190 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17191 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17192 (subtype digest guess))
17193 @end example
17194
17195 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17196 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17197 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17198 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17199 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17200
17201 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17202 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17203 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17204 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17205 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17206 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17207 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17208 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17209 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17210 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17211 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17212 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17213
17214
17215 @node SOUP
17216 @subsection SOUP
17217 @cindex SOUP
17218 @cindex offline
17219
17220 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17221 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17222 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17223
17224 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17225 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17226 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17227 newsreaders.
17228
17229 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17230 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17231 that interested in doing things properly.
17232
17233 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17234 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17235 fiddly.
17236
17237 First some terminology:
17238
17239 @table @dfn
17240
17241 @item server
17242 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17243 get news and/or mail from.
17244
17245 @item home machine
17246 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17247 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17248
17249 @item packet
17250 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17251 of packets:
17252
17253 @table @dfn
17254 @item message packets
17255 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17256 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17257 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17258
17259 @item response packets
17260 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17261 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17262 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17263
17264 @end table
17265
17266 @end table
17267
17268
17269 @enumerate
17270
17271 @item
17272 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17273 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17274 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17275 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17276
17277 @item
17278 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17279
17280 @item
17281 You put the packet in your home directory.
17282
17283 @item
17284 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17285 the native or secondary server.
17286
17287 @item
17288 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17289 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17290
17291 @item
17292 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17293 packet.
17294
17295 @item
17296 You transfer this packet to the server.
17297
17298 @item
17299 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17300
17301 @item
17302 You then repeat until you die.
17303
17304 @end enumerate
17305
17306 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17307 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17308
17309 @menu
17310 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17311 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17312 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17313 @end menu
17314
17315
17316 @node SOUP Commands
17317 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17318
17319 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17320
17321 @table @kbd
17322 @item G s b
17323 @kindex G s b (Group)
17324 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17325 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17326 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17327 process/prefix convention.
17328
17329 @item G s w
17330 @kindex G s w (Group)
17331 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17332 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17333
17334 @item G s s
17335 @kindex G s s (Group)
17336 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17337 Send all replies from the replies packet
17338 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17339
17340 @item G s p
17341 @kindex G s p (Group)
17342 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17343 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17344
17345 @item G s r
17346 @kindex G s r (Group)
17347 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17348 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17349
17350 @item O s
17351 @kindex O s (Summary)
17352 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17353 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17354 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17355 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17356
17357 @end table
17358
17359
17360 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17361 thingies:
17362
17363 @table @code
17364
17365 @item gnus-soup-directory
17366 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17367 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17368 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17369
17370 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17371 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17372 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17373 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17374
17375 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17376 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17377 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17378 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17379
17380 @item gnus-soup-packer
17381 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17382 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17383 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17384
17385 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17386 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17387 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17388 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17389
17390 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17391 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17392 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17393
17394 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17395 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17396 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17397 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17398
17399 @end table
17400
17401
17402 @node SOUP Groups
17403 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17404 @cindex nnsoup
17405
17406 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17407 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17408 you can read them at leisure.
17409
17410 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17411
17412 @table @code
17413
17414 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17415 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17416 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17417 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17418
17419 @item nnsoup-directory
17420 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17421 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17422 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17423
17424 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17425 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17426 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17427 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17428
17429 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17430 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17431 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17432 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17433 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17434
17435 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17436 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17437 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17438 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17439
17440 @item nnsoup-active-file
17441 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17442 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17443 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17444 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17445 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17446
17447 @item nnsoup-packer
17448 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17449 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17450 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17451
17452 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17453 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17454 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17455 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17456
17457 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17458 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17459 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17460 @file{~/}.
17461
17462 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17463 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17464 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17465 @samp{Soupout}.
17466
17467 @item nnsoup-always-save
17468 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17469 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17470
17471 @end table
17472
17473
17474 @node SOUP Replies
17475 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17476
17477 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17478 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17479 more for that to happen.
17480
17481 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17482 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17483 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17484 @sc{soup} system.
17485
17486 In specific, this is what it does:
17487
17488 @lisp
17489 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17490 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17491 @end lisp
17492
17493 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17494 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17495 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17496
17497
17498 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17499 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17500 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17501 @cindex gateways
17502
17503 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17504 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17505 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17506
17507 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17508 used to post with.
17509
17510 Server variables:
17511
17512 @table @code
17513 @item nngateway-address
17514 @vindex nngateway-address
17515 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17516
17517 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17518 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17519 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17520 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17521 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17522 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17523 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17524 gateway address.
17525
17526 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17527 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17528 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17529
17530 @example
17531 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17532 @end example
17533
17534 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17535
17536 @example
17537 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17538 @end example
17539
17540 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17541
17542 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17543 @table @code
17544
17545 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17546 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17547 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17548
17549 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17550
17551 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17552 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17553 @code{nngateway-address}.
17554 @end table
17555
17556 @end table
17557
17558 Here's an example:
17559
17560 @lisp
17561 (setq gnus-post-method
17562 '(nngateway
17563 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17564 (nngateway-header-transformation
17565 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17566 @end lisp
17567
17568 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17569
17570 @lisp
17571 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17572 @end lisp
17573
17574
17575
17576 @node Combined Groups
17577 @section Combined Groups
17578
17579 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17580 groups.
17581
17582 @menu
17583 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17584 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17585 @end menu
17586
17587
17588 @node Virtual Groups
17589 @subsection Virtual Groups
17590 @cindex nnvirtual
17591 @cindex virtual groups
17592 @cindex merging groups
17593
17594 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17595 other groups.
17596
17597 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17598 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17599 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17600
17601 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17602 regexp to match component groups.
17603
17604 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17605 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17606 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17607 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17608 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17609 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17610 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17611 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17612
17613 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17614 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17615
17616 @lisp
17617 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17618 @end lisp
17619
17620 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17621 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17622
17623 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17624 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17625 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17626 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17627
17628 @example
17629 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17630 @end example
17631
17632 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17633 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17634 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17635
17636 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17637 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17638 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17639 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17640 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17641
17642 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17643 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17644 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17645
17646 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17647 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17648 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17649 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17650 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17651 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17652 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17653 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17654 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17655 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17656 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17657
17658 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17659 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17660 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17661 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17662 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17663 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17664 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17665
17666 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17667 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17668
17669 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17670 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17671 inherited.
17672
17673
17674 @node Kibozed Groups
17675 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17676 @cindex nnkiboze
17677 @cindex kibozing
17678
17679 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17680 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17681 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17682 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17683
17684 @kindex G k (Group)
17685 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17686 buffer.
17687
17688 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17689 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17690 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17691 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17692
17693 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17694 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17695 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17696
17697 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17698 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17699 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17700 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17701 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17702 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17703 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17704 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17705
17706 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17707 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17708 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17709 Stranger things have happened.
17710
17711 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17712 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17713
17714 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17715 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17716 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17717 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17718 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17719 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17720 component articles.
17721
17722 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17723 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17724
17725
17726 @node Gnus Unplugged
17727 @section Gnus Unplugged
17728 @cindex offline
17729 @cindex unplugged
17730 @cindex agent
17731 @cindex Gnus agent
17732 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17733
17734 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17735 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17736 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17737 read news. Believe it or not.
17738
17739 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17740 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17741 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17742 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17743 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17744
17745 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17746 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17747 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17748 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17749 reading news on a machine.
17750
17751 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17752 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17753
17754 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17755
17756 @menu
17757 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17758 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17759 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17760 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17761 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17762 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17763 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17764 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17765 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17766 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17767 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17768 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17769 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17770 @end menu
17771
17772
17773 @node Agent Basics
17774 @subsection Agent Basics
17775
17776 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17777
17778 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17779 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17780 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17781 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17782
17783 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17784 connected to the net continuously.
17785
17786 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17787 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17788
17789 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17790 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17791 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17792 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17793 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17794
17795 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17796 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17797 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17798 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17799 they're kinda like plugged always).
17800
17801 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17802 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17803 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17804 the culprit.
17805
17806 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17807 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17808 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17809 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17810 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17811
17812 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17813
17814 @itemize @bullet
17815
17816 @item
17817 @findex gnus-unplugged
17818 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17819 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17820 already fetched while in this mode.
17821
17822 @item
17823 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17824 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17825 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17826 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17827 Source Specifiers}).
17828
17829 @item
17830 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17831 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17832 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17833 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17834 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17835
17836 @item
17837 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17838 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17839 then you read the news offline.
17840
17841 @item
17842 And then you go to step 2.
17843 @end itemize
17844
17845 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17846 the Agent.
17847
17848 @itemize @bullet
17849
17850 @item
17851 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17852 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17853 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17854 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17855 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17856 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17857 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17858 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17859
17860 @item
17861 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17862 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17863 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17864 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17865
17866 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17867 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17868 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17869 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17870 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17871 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17872 configure them.
17873
17874 @item
17875 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17876 @end itemize
17877
17878
17879 @node Agent Categories
17880 @subsection Agent Categories
17881
17882 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17883 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17884 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17885 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17886 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17887 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17888 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17889
17890 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17891 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17892 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17893 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17894 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17895
17896 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17897 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17898 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17899 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17900 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17901 sink.
17902
17903 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17904 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17905 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17906 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17907 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17908 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17909 your settings.
17910
17911 @menu
17912 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17913 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17914 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17915 @end menu
17916
17917
17918 @node Category Syntax
17919 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17920
17921 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17922 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17923 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17924 listed below.
17925
17926 @cindex Agent Parameters
17927 @table @code
17928 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17929 The name of the category.
17930
17931 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17932 The list of groups that are in this category.
17933
17934 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17935 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17936 are eligible for downloading; and
17937
17938 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17939 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17940 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17941 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17942
17943 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17944 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17945 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17946 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17947 only groups that should not be expired.
17948
17949 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17950 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17951 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17952
17953 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17954 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17955
17956 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17957 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17958
17959 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17960 an integer that overrides the value of
17961 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17962
17963 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17964 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17965
17966 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17967 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17968 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17969 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17970 @c all other symbols disable them.
17971
17972 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17973 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17974 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17975 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17976 all other symbols enable them.
17977 @end table
17978
17979 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17980 created.
17981
17982 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17983 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17984 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17985 category.
17986
17987 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17988 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17989 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17990 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17991
17992 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17993 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17994 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17995
17996 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17997 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17998 operators sprinkled in between.
17999
18000 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18001
18002 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18003 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18004
18005 @lisp
18006 short
18007 @end lisp
18008
18009 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18010 short (for some value of ``short'').
18011
18012 Here's a more complex predicate:
18013
18014 @lisp
18015 (or high
18016 (and
18017 (not low)
18018 (not long)))
18019 @end lisp
18020
18021 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18022 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18023 drift.
18024
18025 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18026 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18027 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18028
18029 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18030 you want to do, you can write your own.
18031
18032 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18033 bound to the value determined by calling
18034 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18035 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18036 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18037 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18038 predicate to individual groups.
18039
18040 @table @code
18041 @item short
18042 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18043 lines; default 100.
18044
18045 @item long
18046 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18047 lines; default 200.
18048
18049 @item low
18050 True iff the article has a download score less than
18051 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18052
18053 @item high
18054 True iff the article has a download score greater than
18055 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18056
18057 @item spam
18058 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18059 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18060 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18061
18062 @item true
18063 Always true.
18064
18065 @item false
18066 Always false.
18067 @end table
18068
18069 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18070 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18071 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18072 useful values.
18073
18074 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18075 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
18076 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18077 something along the lines of the following:
18078
18079 @lisp
18080 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18081 "Say whether an article is old."
18082 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18083 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18084 @end lisp
18085
18086 with the predicate then defined as:
18087
18088 @lisp
18089 (not my-article-old-p)
18090 @end lisp
18091
18092 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18093 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18094 wherever.
18095
18096 @lisp
18097 (require 'gnus-agent)
18098 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18099 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18100 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18101 @end lisp
18102
18103 and simply specify your predicate as:
18104
18105 @lisp
18106 (not old)
18107 @end lisp
18108
18109 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18110 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18111 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18112 just don't give a damn.
18113
18114 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18115 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18116 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18117 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18118 parameters like so:
18119
18120 @lisp
18121 (agent-predicate . short)
18122 @end lisp
18123
18124 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18125 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18126 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18127
18128 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18129
18130 @lisp
18131 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18132 @end lisp
18133
18134 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18135 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18136 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18137
18138
18139 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18140 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18141 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18142 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18143 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18144 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18145
18146 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18147 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18148 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18149 if it's to be specific to that group.
18150
18151 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18152 three forms:
18153
18154 @enumerate
18155 @item
18156 Score rule
18157
18158 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18159 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18160
18161 example:
18162
18163 @itemize @bullet
18164 @item
18165 Category specification
18166
18167 @lisp
18168 (("from"
18169 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18170 ("lines"
18171 (500 -100 nil <)))
18172 @end lisp
18173
18174 @item
18175 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18176
18177 @lisp
18178 (agent-score ("from"
18179 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18180 ("lines"
18181 (500 -100 nil <)))
18182 @end lisp
18183
18184 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18185 @end itemize
18186
18187 @item
18188 Agent score file
18189
18190 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18191 keywords stated above.
18192
18193 example:
18194
18195 @itemize @bullet
18196 @item
18197 Category specification
18198
18199 @lisp
18200 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18201 @end lisp
18202
18203 or perhaps
18204
18205 @lisp
18206 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18207 @end lisp
18208
18209 @item
18210 Group Parameter specification
18211
18212 @lisp
18213 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18214 @end lisp
18215
18216 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18217 about parenthesis?
18218 @end itemize
18219
18220 @item
18221 Use @code{normal} score files
18222
18223 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18224 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18225 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18226 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18227
18228 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18229 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18230 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18231 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18232
18233 @itemize @bullet
18234 @item
18235 Category Specification
18236
18237 @lisp
18238 file
18239 @end lisp
18240
18241 @item
18242 Group Parameter specification
18243
18244 @lisp
18245 (agent-score . file)
18246 @end lisp
18247 @end itemize
18248 @end enumerate
18249
18250 @node Category Buffer
18251 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18252
18253 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18254 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18255 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18256
18257 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18258
18259 @table @kbd
18260 @item q
18261 @kindex q (Category)
18262 @findex gnus-category-exit
18263 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18264
18265 @item e
18266 @kindex e (Category)
18267 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18268 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18269 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18270
18271 @item k
18272 @kindex k (Category)
18273 @findex gnus-category-kill
18274 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18275
18276 @item c
18277 @kindex c (Category)
18278 @findex gnus-category-copy
18279 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18280
18281 @item a
18282 @kindex a (Category)
18283 @findex gnus-category-add
18284 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18285
18286 @item p
18287 @kindex p (Category)
18288 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18289 Edit the predicate of the current category
18290 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18291
18292 @item g
18293 @kindex g (Category)
18294 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18295 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18296 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18297
18298 @item s
18299 @kindex s (Category)
18300 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18301 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18302 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18303
18304 @item l
18305 @kindex l (Category)
18306 @findex gnus-category-list
18307 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18308 @end table
18309
18310
18311 @node Category Variables
18312 @subsubsection Category Variables
18313
18314 @table @code
18315 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18316 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18317 Hook run in category buffers.
18318
18319 @item gnus-category-line-format
18320 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18321 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18322 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18323
18324 @table @samp
18325 @item c
18326 The name of the category.
18327
18328 @item g
18329 The number of groups in the category.
18330 @end table
18331
18332 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18333 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18334 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18335
18336 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18337 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18338 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18339
18340 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18341 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18342 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18343
18344 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18345 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18346 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18347 0.
18348
18349 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18350 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18351 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18352 0.
18353
18354 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18355 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18356 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18357 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18358 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18359 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18360 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18361 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18362 read.
18363 Default 7.
18364
18365 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18366 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18367 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18368 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18369 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18370 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18371 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18372
18373 @end table
18374
18375
18376 @node Agent Commands
18377 @subsection Agent Commands
18378 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18379 @kindex J j (Agent)
18380
18381 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18382 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18383 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18384
18385
18386 @menu
18387 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18388 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18389 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18390 @end menu
18391
18392
18393
18394
18395 @node Group Agent Commands
18396 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18397
18398 @table @kbd
18399 @item J u
18400 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18401 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18402 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18403 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18404
18405 @item J c
18406 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18407 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18408 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18409
18410 @item J s
18411 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18412 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18413 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18414 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18415
18416 @item J S
18417 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18418 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18419 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18420 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18421
18422 @item J a
18423 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18424 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18425 Add the current group to an Agent category
18426 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18427 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18428
18429 @item J r
18430 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18431 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18432 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18433 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18434 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18435
18436 @item J Y
18437 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18438 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18439 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18440
18441
18442 @end table
18443
18444
18445 @node Summary Agent Commands
18446 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18447
18448 @table @kbd
18449 @item J #
18450 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18451 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18452 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18453
18454 @item J M-#
18455 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18456 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18457 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18458 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18459
18460 @cindex %
18461 @item @@
18462 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18463 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18464 Toggle whether to download the article
18465 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18466 default.
18467
18468 @item J c
18469 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18470 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18471 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18472
18473 @item J S
18474 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18475 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18476 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18477 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18478
18479 @item J s
18480 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18481 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18482 Download all processable articles in this group.
18483 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18484
18485 @item J u
18486 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18487 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18488 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18489 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18490
18491 @end table
18492
18493
18494 @node Server Agent Commands
18495 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18496
18497 @table @kbd
18498 @item J a
18499 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18500 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18501 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18502 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18503
18504 @item J r
18505 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18506 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18507 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18508 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18509
18510 @end table
18511
18512
18513 @node Agent Visuals
18514 @subsection Agent Visuals
18515
18516 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18517 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18518 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18519 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18520 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18521 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18522 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18523 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18524 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18525 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18526
18527 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18528 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18529 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18530 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18531 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18532 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18533 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18534 articles will be available when unplugged.
18535
18536 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18537 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18538 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18539 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18540 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18541 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18542 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18543 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18544
18545 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18546 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18547 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18548 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18549 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18550 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18551 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18552 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18553 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18554
18555 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18556 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18557 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18558 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18559 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18560
18561 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18562 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18563 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18564 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18565 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18566 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18567 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18568 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
18569 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18570 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
18571 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
18572 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18573 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18574
18575 @node Agent as Cache
18576 @subsection Agent as Cache
18577
18578 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18579 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18580 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18581 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18582 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18583 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18584 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18585 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18586 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18587
18588 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18589 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18590 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18591 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18592 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18593
18594 @node Agent Expiry
18595 @subsection Agent Expiry
18596
18597 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18598 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18599 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18600 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18601 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18602 @cindex agent expiry
18603 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18604 @cindex expiry
18605
18606 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18607 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18608 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18609 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18610 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18611 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18612 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18613 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18614
18615 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18616 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18617 synchronized with the group.
18618
18619 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18620 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18621
18622 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18623 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18624 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18625 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18626 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18627 be kept indefinitely.
18628
18629 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18630 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18631 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18632 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18633
18634 @node Agent Regeneration
18635 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18636
18637 @cindex agent regeneration
18638 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18639 @cindex regeneration
18640
18641 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18642 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18643 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18644 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18645 internal inconsistencies.
18646
18647 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18648 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18649 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18650 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18651 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18652 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18653
18654 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18655 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18656 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18657 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18658 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18659 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18660
18661 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18662 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18663 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18664 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18665 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18666 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18667 agent as unread.
18668
18669 @node Agent and IMAP
18670 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18671
18672 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18673 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18674 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18675 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18676
18677 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18678 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18679 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18680 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18681
18682 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18683 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18684 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18685 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18686
18687 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18688 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18689 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18690 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18691 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18692 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18693
18694 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18695 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18696 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18697 in the group buffer.
18698
18699 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18700 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18701
18702 @itemize @bullet
18703
18704 @item
18705 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18706
18707 @item
18708 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18709
18710 @end itemize
18711
18712 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18713 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18714 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18715 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18716 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18717 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18718 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18719 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18720
18721
18722 @node Outgoing Messages
18723 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18724
18725 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18726 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18727 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18728
18729 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18730 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18731 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18732 messages in the draft group.
18733
18734
18735
18736 @node Agent Variables
18737 @subsection Agent Variables
18738
18739 @table @code
18740 @item gnus-agent-directory
18741 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18742 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18743 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18744
18745 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18746 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18747 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18748 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18749 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18750 by default.
18751
18752 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18753 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18754 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18755
18756 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18757 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18758 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18759
18760 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18761 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18762 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18763
18764 @item gnus-agent-cache
18765 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18766 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18767 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18768 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18769
18770 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18771 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18772 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18773 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18774 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18775 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18776 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18777 online status.
18778
18779 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18780 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18781 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18782 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18783 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18784 read. The default is @code{t}.
18785
18786 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18787 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18788 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18789 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18790 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18791 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18792 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18793 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18794 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18795 over and over again.
18796
18797 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18798 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18799 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18800 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18801 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18802 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18803 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18804 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18805 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18806 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18807 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18808 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18809 see any cycling.
18810
18811 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18812 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18813 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18814 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18815 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18816 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18817 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18818 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18819 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18820
18821 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18822 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18823 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18824 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18825 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18826 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18827
18828 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18829 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18830 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18831 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18832 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18833
18834 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18835 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18836 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18837 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18838 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18839 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18840 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18841 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18842 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18843 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18844 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18845
18846 @end table
18847
18848
18849 @node Example Setup
18850 @subsection Example Setup
18851
18852 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18853 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18854 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18855
18856 @lisp
18857 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18858 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18859 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18860
18861 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18862 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18863 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18864
18865 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18866 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18867
18868 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18869 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18870 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18871 @end lisp
18872
18873 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18874 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18875 gnus}.
18876
18877 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18878 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18879 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18880 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18881 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18882 once.
18883
18884 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18885 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18886 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18887 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18888 back all the killed groups.)
18889
18890 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18891 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18892 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18893
18894
18895 @node Batching Agents
18896 @subsection Batching Agents
18897 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18898
18899 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18900 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18901 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18902
18903 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18904 following incantation:
18905
18906 @example
18907 #!/bin/sh
18908 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18909 @end example
18910
18911
18912 @node Agent Caveats
18913 @subsection Agent Caveats
18914
18915 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18916 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18917 may ask:
18918
18919 @table @dfn
18920 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18921
18922 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
18923 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18924 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18925
18926 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18927 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18928
18929 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18930
18931 @end table
18932
18933 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18934 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18935 locally stored articles.
18936
18937
18938 @node Scoring
18939 @chapter Scoring
18940 @cindex scoring
18941
18942 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18943 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18944 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18945 attention!
18946
18947 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18948 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18949 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18950 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18951 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18952
18953 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18954 before generating the summary buffer.
18955
18956 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18957 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18958 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18959
18960 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18961 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18962 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18963 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18964
18965 @menu
18966 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18967 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18968 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18969 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18970 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18971 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18972 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18973 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18974 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18975 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18976 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18977 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18978 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18979 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18980 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18981 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18982 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18983 @end menu
18984
18985
18986 @node Summary Score Commands
18987 @section Summary Score Commands
18988 @cindex score commands
18989
18990 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18991 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18992 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18993 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18994 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18995
18996 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18997 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18998 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18999 score file the current one.
19000
19001 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19002
19003 @table @kbd
19004
19005 @item V s
19006 @kindex V s (Summary)
19007 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19008 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19009
19010 @item V S
19011 @kindex V S (Summary)
19012 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19013 Display the score of the current article
19014 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19015
19016 @item V t
19017 @kindex V t (Summary)
19018 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19019 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19020 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19021 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19022 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19023 score file and edit it.
19024
19025 @item V w
19026 @kindex V w (Summary)
19027 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19028 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19029
19030 @item V R
19031 @kindex V R (Summary)
19032 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19033 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19034 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19035 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19036 effect you're having.
19037
19038 @item V c
19039 @kindex V c (Summary)
19040 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19041 Make a different score file the current
19042 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19043
19044 @item V e
19045 @kindex V e (Summary)
19046 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19047 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19048 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19049 File Editing}).
19050
19051 @item V f
19052 @kindex V f (Summary)
19053 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19054 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19055 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19056
19057 @item V F
19058 @kindex V F (Summary)
19059 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19060 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19061 after editing score files.
19062
19063 @item V C
19064 @kindex V C (Summary)
19065 @findex gnus-score-customize
19066 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19067 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19068
19069 @end table
19070
19071 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19072
19073 @table @kbd
19074
19075 @item V m
19076 @kindex V m (Summary)
19077 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19078 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19079 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19080
19081 @item V x
19082 @kindex V x (Summary)
19083 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19084 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19085 expunge all articles below this score
19086 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19087 @end table
19088
19089 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19090 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19091 them.)
19092
19093 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19094 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19095
19096 @enumerate
19097 @item
19098 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19099 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19100 @item
19101 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19102 keys are available:
19103 @table @kbd
19104
19105 @item a
19106 Score on the author name.
19107
19108 @item s
19109 Score on the subject line.
19110
19111 @item x
19112 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19113
19114 @item r
19115 Score on the @code{References} line.
19116
19117 @item d
19118 Score on the date.
19119
19120 @item l
19121 Score on the number of lines.
19122
19123 @item i
19124 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19125
19126 @item e
19127 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19128 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19129
19130 @item f
19131 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19132 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19133 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19134
19135 @item b
19136 Score on the body.
19137
19138 @item h
19139 Score on the head.
19140
19141 @item t
19142 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19143 files.)
19144
19145 @end table
19146
19147 @item
19148 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19149 what headers you are scoring on.
19150
19151 @table @code
19152
19153 @item strings
19154
19155 @table @kbd
19156
19157 @item e
19158 Exact matching.
19159
19160 @item s
19161 Substring matching.
19162
19163 @item f
19164 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19165
19166 @item r
19167 Regexp matching
19168 @end table
19169
19170 @item date
19171 @table @kbd
19172
19173 @item b
19174 Before date.
19175
19176 @item a
19177 After date.
19178
19179 @item n
19180 This date.
19181 @end table
19182
19183 @item number
19184 @table @kbd
19185
19186 @item <
19187 Less than number.
19188
19189 @item =
19190 Equal to number.
19191
19192 @item >
19193 Greater than number.
19194 @end table
19195 @end table
19196
19197 @item
19198 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19199 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19200 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19201 file.
19202 @table @kbd
19203
19204 @item t
19205 Temporary score entry.
19206
19207 @item p
19208 Permanent score entry.
19209
19210 @item i
19211 Immediately scoring.
19212 @end table
19213
19214 @item
19215 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19216 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19217 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19218
19219 @end enumerate
19220
19221 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19222 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19223 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19224 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19225
19226 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19227 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19228 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19229 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19230 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19231
19232 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19233 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19234 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19235 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19236 current score file.
19237
19238 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19239 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19240 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19241
19242
19243 @node Group Score Commands
19244 @section Group Score Commands
19245 @cindex group score commands
19246
19247 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19248
19249 @table @kbd
19250
19251 @item W f
19252 @kindex W f (Group)
19253 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19254 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19255 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19256 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19257
19258 @end table
19259
19260 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19261
19262 @findex gnus-batch-score
19263 @cindex batch scoring
19264 @example
19265 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19266 @end example
19267
19268
19269 @node Score Variables
19270 @section Score Variables
19271 @cindex score variables
19272
19273 @table @code
19274
19275 @item gnus-use-scoring
19276 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19277 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19278 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19279
19280 @item gnus-kill-killed
19281 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19282 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19283 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19284 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19285 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19286 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19287 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19288
19289 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19290 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19291 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19292 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19293 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19294
19295 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19296 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19297 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19298 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19299
19300 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19301 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19302 @cindex score cache
19303 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19304 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19305 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19306 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19307 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19308 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19309 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19310 be cached.
19311
19312 @item gnus-save-score
19313 @vindex gnus-save-score
19314 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19315 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19316 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19317
19318 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19319 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19320 across group visits.
19321
19322 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19323 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19324 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19325 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19326 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19327 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19328 manually entered data.
19329
19330 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19331 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19332 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19333
19334 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19335 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19336 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19337 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19338 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19339 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19340
19341 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19342 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19343 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19344 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19345
19346 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19347 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19348 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19349 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19350
19351 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19352 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19353 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19354 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19355
19356 Predefined functions available are:
19357 @table @code
19358
19359 @item gnus-score-find-single
19360 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19361 Only apply the group's own score file.
19362
19363 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19364 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19365 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19366 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19367 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19368 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19369 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19370 then a regexp match is done.
19371
19372 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19373 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19374
19375 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19376 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19377 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19378 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19379
19380 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19381 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19382 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19383 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19384 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19385 server.
19386
19387 @end table
19388 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19389 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19390 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19391 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19392 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19393 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19394 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19395 Phu.
19396
19397 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19398 overall score file, you could use the value
19399 @example
19400 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19401 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19402 @end example
19403
19404 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19405 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19406 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19407 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19408 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19409
19410 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19411 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19412 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19413 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19414 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19415 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19416 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19417 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19418
19419 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19420 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19421 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19422
19423 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19424 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19425 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19426 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19427 threading---according to the current value of
19428 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19429 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19430 simplified in this manner.
19431
19432 @end table
19433
19434
19435 @node Score File Format
19436 @section Score File Format
19437 @cindex score file format
19438
19439 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19440 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19441 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19442
19443 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19444
19445 @lisp
19446 (("from"
19447 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19448 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19449 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19450 ("subject"
19451 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19452 ("xref"
19453 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19454 ("lines"
19455 (2 -100 nil <))
19456 (mark 0)
19457 (expunge -1000)
19458 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19459 (read-only nil)
19460 (orphan -10)
19461 (adapt t)
19462 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19463 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19464 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19465 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19466 (eval (ding)))
19467 @end lisp
19468
19469 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19470 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19471
19472 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19473 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19474 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19475
19476 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19477
19478 @table @code
19479
19480 @item STRING
19481 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19482 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19483 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19484 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19485 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19486 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19487 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19488 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19489 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19490 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19491 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19492 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19493 to articles that matches these score entries.
19494
19495 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19496 score entry has one to four elements.
19497 @enumerate
19498
19499 @item
19500 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19501 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19502 integer.
19503
19504 @item
19505 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19506 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19507 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19508 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19509 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19510 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19511
19512 @item
19513 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19514 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19515 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19516 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19517 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19518
19519 @item
19520 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19521 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19522 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19523 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19524 @table @dfn
19525
19526 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19527 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19528 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19529 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19530 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19531 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19532 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19533 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19534 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19535 instead, if you feel like.
19536
19537 @item Extra
19538 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19539 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19540 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19541 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19542 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19543 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19544 overviews:
19545
19546 @lisp
19547 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19548 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19549 @end lisp
19550
19551 @item Lines, Chars
19552 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19553 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19554
19555 These predicates are true if
19556
19557 @example
19558 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19559 @end example
19560
19561 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19562 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19563 following form:
19564
19565 @lisp
19566 (< header-value 4)
19567 @end lisp
19568
19569 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19570 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19571 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19572 it's not. I think.)
19573
19574 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19575 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19576 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19577 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19578
19579 @item Date
19580 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19581 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19582 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19583 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19584 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19585 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19586 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19587
19588 @cindex ISO8601
19589 @cindex date
19590 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19591 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19592 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19593 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19594 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19595 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19596 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19597 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19598 whole family, eh?)
19599
19600 @item Head, Body, All
19601 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19602 header uses.
19603
19604 @item Followup
19605 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19606 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19607 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19608 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19609 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19610 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19611 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19612 files.)
19613
19614 @item Thread
19615 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19616 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19617 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19618 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19619 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19620 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19621 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19622 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19623 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19624 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19625 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19626 @end table
19627 @end enumerate
19628
19629 @cindex score file atoms
19630 @item mark
19631 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19632 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19633
19634 @item expunge
19635 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19636 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19637
19638 @item mark-and-expunge
19639 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19640 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19641 summary buffer.
19642
19643 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19644 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19645 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19646 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19647 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19648
19649 @item files
19650 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19651 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19652 this one was.
19653
19654 @item exclude-files
19655 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19656 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19657 other.
19658
19659 @item eval
19660 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19661 ignored when handling global score files.
19662
19663 @item read-only
19664 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19665 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19666 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19667 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19668
19669 @item orphan
19670 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19671 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19672 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19673 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19674
19675 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19676
19677 @example
19678 (orphan -500)
19679 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19680 @end example
19681
19682 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19683 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19684 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19685 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19686 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19687
19688 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19689 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19690 scoring rules exist.
19691
19692 @item adapt
19693 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19694 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19695 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19696 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19697 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19698 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19699 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19700 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19701 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19702 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19703 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19704 it.
19705
19706 @item adapt-file
19707 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19708 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19709 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19710 file for a number of groups.
19711
19712 @item local
19713 @cindex local variables
19714 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19715 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19716 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19717 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19718 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19719 be evaluated.
19720 @end table
19721
19722
19723 @node Score File Editing
19724 @section Score File Editing
19725
19726 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19727 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19728 with a mode for that.
19729
19730 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19731 additional commands:
19732
19733 @table @kbd
19734
19735 @item C-c C-c
19736 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19737 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19738 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19739 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19740
19741 @item C-c C-d
19742 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19743 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19744 Insert the current date in numerical format
19745 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19746 you were wondering.
19747
19748 @item C-c C-p
19749 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19750 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19751 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19752 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19753 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19754 you.
19755
19756 @end table
19757
19758 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19759
19760 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19761 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19762
19763 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19764 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19765
19766
19767 @node Adaptive Scoring
19768 @section Adaptive Scoring
19769 @cindex adaptive scoring
19770
19771 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19772 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19773 stupidity, to be precise.
19774
19775 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19776 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19777 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19778 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19779 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19780 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19781 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19782 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19783 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19784
19785 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19786 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19787 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19788 might look something like this:
19789
19790 @lisp
19791 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19792 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19793 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19794 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19795 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19796 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19797 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19798 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19799 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19800 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19801 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19802 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19803 @end lisp
19804
19805 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19806 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19807 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19808 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19809 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19810 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19811 entries.
19812
19813 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19814 will be applied to each article.
19815
19816 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19817 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19818 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19819 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19820
19821 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19822 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19823 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19824 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19825
19826 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19827 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19828 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19829 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19830
19831 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19832 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19833 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19834 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19835 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19836 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19837
19838 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19839 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19840 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19841
19842 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19843 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19844 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19845
19846 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19847 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19848 let you use different rules in different groups.
19849
19850 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19851 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19852 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19853 is @file{ADAPT}.
19854
19855 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19856 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19857 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19858 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19859 the length of the match is less than
19860 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19861 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19862 this problem.
19863
19864 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19865 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19866 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19867 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19868 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19869
19870 @lisp
19871 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19872 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19873 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19874 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19875 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19876 @end lisp
19877
19878 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19879 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19880 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19881 score with 30 points.
19882
19883 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19884 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19885 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19886 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19887 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19888
19889 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19890 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19891 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19892 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19893 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19894
19895 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19896 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19897 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19898 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19899
19900 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19901 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19902 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19903 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19904
19905 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19906 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19907 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19908 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19909 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19910
19911 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19912 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19913 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19914
19915 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19916 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19917 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19918 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19919
19920
19921 @node Home Score File
19922 @section Home Score File
19923
19924 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19925 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19926 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19927 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19928
19929 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19930 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19931 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19932
19933 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19934 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19935 be:
19936
19937 @enumerate
19938 @item
19939 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19940 groups.
19941
19942 @item
19943 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19944 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19945 parameter.
19946
19947 @item
19948 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19949
19950 @enumerate
19951 @item
19952 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19953 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19954
19955 @item
19956 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19957 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
19958 name of the group as the parameter.
19959
19960 @item
19961 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19962 @end enumerate
19963
19964 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19965 for matches.
19966
19967 @end enumerate
19968
19969 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19970
19971 @lisp
19972 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19973 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19974 @end lisp
19975
19976 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19977 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19978
19979 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19980 @lisp
19981 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19982 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19983 @end lisp
19984
19985 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19986 Other functions include
19987
19988 @table @code
19989 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19990 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19991 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19992 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19993
19994 @end table
19995
19996 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19997 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19998 their own home score files:
19999
20000 @lisp
20001 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20002 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20003 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20004 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20005 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20006 @end lisp
20007
20008 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20009 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20010 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20011 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20012 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20013
20014 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20015 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20016 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20017 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20018 precedence over this variable.
20019
20020
20021 @node Followups To Yourself
20022 @section Followups To Yourself
20023
20024 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20025 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20026 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20027 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20028 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20029 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20030
20031 @table @code
20032
20033 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20034 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20035 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20036 article.
20037
20038 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20039 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20040 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20041 your own article.
20042 @end table
20043
20044 @vindex message-sent-hook
20045 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20046 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20047 @lisp
20048 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20049 @end lisp
20050
20051
20052 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20053 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20054 mine:
20055
20056 @example
20057 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20058 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20059 @end example
20060
20061 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20062 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20063 myself:
20064
20065 @lisp
20066 ("references"
20067 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20068 1000 nil r))
20069 @end lisp
20070
20071 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20072 is system-dependent.
20073
20074
20075 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20076 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20077 @cindex scoring on other headers
20078
20079 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20080 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20081 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20082 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20083 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20084
20085 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
20086 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20087 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20088 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20089 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20090
20091 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20092
20093 @lisp
20094 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20095 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20096 @end lisp
20097
20098 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20099 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20100 time if you have much mail.
20101
20102 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20103 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20104
20105 See? Simple.
20106
20107
20108 @node Scoring Tips
20109 @section Scoring Tips
20110 @cindex scoring tips
20111
20112 @table @dfn
20113
20114 @item Crossposts
20115 @cindex crossposts
20116 @cindex scoring crossposts
20117 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20118 the @code{Xref} header.
20119 @lisp
20120 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20121 @end lisp
20122
20123 @item Multiple crossposts
20124 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20125 more than, say, 3 groups:
20126 @lisp
20127 ("xref"
20128 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20129 -1000 nil r))
20130 @end lisp
20131
20132 @item Matching on the body
20133 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20134 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20135 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20136 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20137 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20138 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20139 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20140 the matches.
20141
20142 @item Marking as read
20143 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20144 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20145 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20146 @lisp
20147 ((mark -100))
20148 @end lisp
20149 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20150
20151 @item Negated character classes
20152 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20153 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20154 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20155 @end table
20156
20157
20158 @node Reverse Scoring
20159 @section Reverse Scoring
20160 @cindex reverse scoring
20161
20162 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20163 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20164 like this in your score file:
20165
20166 @lisp
20167 (("subject"
20168 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20169 (mark 1)
20170 (expunge 1))
20171 @end lisp
20172
20173 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20174 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20175
20176
20177 @node Global Score Files
20178 @section Global Score Files
20179 @cindex global score files
20180
20181 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20182 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20183 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20184
20185 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20186 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20187 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20188
20189 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20190 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20191 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20192 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20193 files are applicable to which group.
20194
20195 To use the score file
20196 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20197 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20198 say this:
20199
20200 @lisp
20201 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20202 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20203 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20204 @end lisp
20205
20206 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20207 @noindent
20208 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20209 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20210 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20211 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20212
20213 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20214 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20215
20216 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20217 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20218 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20219 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20220 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20221 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20222
20223 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20224 head:
20225
20226 @itemize @bullet
20227
20228 @item
20229 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20230 @item
20231 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20232 @item
20233 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20234 @item
20235 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20236 lowered out of existence.
20237 @item
20238 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20239 articles completely.
20240
20241 @item
20242 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20243 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20244 old articles for a long time.
20245 @end itemize
20246
20247 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20248 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20249 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20250 holding our breath yet?
20251
20252
20253 @node Kill Files
20254 @section Kill Files
20255 @cindex kill files
20256
20257 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20258 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20259 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20260
20261 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20262 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20263 files into score files.
20264
20265 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20266 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20267 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20268 that isn't a very good idea.
20269
20270 Normal kill files look like this:
20271
20272 @lisp
20273 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20274 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20275 (gnus-expunge "X")
20276 @end lisp
20277
20278 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20279 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20280
20281 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20282 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20283 interpreting it.
20284
20285 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20286
20287 @table @kbd
20288
20289 @item M-k
20290 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20291 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20292 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20293
20294 @item M-K
20295 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20296 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20297 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20298 @end table
20299
20300 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20301
20302 @table @kbd
20303
20304 @item M-k
20305 @kindex M-k (Group)
20306 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20307 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20308
20309 @item M-K
20310 @kindex M-K (Group)
20311 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20312 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20313 @end table
20314
20315 Kill file variables:
20316
20317 @table @code
20318 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20319 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20320 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20321 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20322 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20323 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20324 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20325
20326 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20327 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20328 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20329 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20330 kills.
20331
20332 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20333 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20334 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20335 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20336 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20337 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20338 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20339 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20340 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20341
20342 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20343 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20344 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20345
20346 @end table
20347
20348
20349 @node Converting Kill Files
20350 @section Converting Kill Files
20351 @cindex kill files
20352 @cindex converting kill files
20353
20354 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20355 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20356 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20357 by hand.
20358
20359 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20360 You can fetch it from
20361 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20362
20363 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20364 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20365 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20366 before.
20367
20368
20369 @node GroupLens
20370 @section GroupLens
20371 @cindex GroupLens
20372
20373 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20374 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20375
20376 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20377 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20378 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20379 news articles generated every day.
20380
20381 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20382 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20383 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20384 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20385 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20386 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20387 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20388 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20389 article.
20390
20391 @menu
20392 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20393 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20394 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20395 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20396 @end menu
20397
20398
20399 @node Using GroupLens
20400 @subsection Using GroupLens
20401
20402 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20403 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20404 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20405
20406 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20407
20408 @table @code
20409
20410 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20411 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20412 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20413 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20414
20415 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20416 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20417 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20418 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20419
20420 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20421 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20422 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20423
20424 @end table
20425
20426 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20427 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20428 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20429 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20430 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20431 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20432
20433
20434 @node Rating Articles
20435 @subsection Rating Articles
20436
20437 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20438 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20439 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20440 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20441 like this one?''
20442
20443 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20444
20445 @table @kbd
20446
20447 @item r
20448 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20449 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20450 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20451
20452 @item k
20453 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20454 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20455 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20456 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20457 threads in rec.humor.
20458
20459 @end table
20460
20461 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20462 the score of the article you're reading.
20463
20464 @table @kbd
20465
20466 @item 1-5 n
20467 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20468 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20469 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20470
20471 @item 1-5 ,
20472 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20473 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20474 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20475
20476 @end table
20477
20478 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20479 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20480
20481
20482 @node Displaying Predictions
20483 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20484
20485 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20486 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20487 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20488 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20489 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20490
20491 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20492 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20493 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20494 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20495 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20496 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20497 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20498 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20499 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20500 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20501 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20502 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20503 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20504
20505 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20506 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20507 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20508 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20509
20510 The following are valid values for that variable.
20511
20512 @table @code
20513 @item prediction-spot
20514 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20515 displayed.
20516
20517 @item confidence-interval
20518 A numeric confidence interval.
20519
20520 @item prediction-bar
20521 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20522
20523 @item confidence-bar
20524 Numerical confidence.
20525
20526 @item confidence-spot
20527 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20528
20529 @item prediction-num
20530 Plain-old numeric value.
20531
20532 @item confidence-plus-minus
20533 Prediction +/- confidence.
20534
20535 @end table
20536
20537
20538 @node GroupLens Variables
20539 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20540
20541 @table @code
20542
20543 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20544 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20545 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20546 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20547 %s\n}.
20548
20549 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20550 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20551 default.
20552
20553 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20554 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20555
20556 @item grouplens-score-offset
20557 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20558 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20559 default is 0.
20560
20561 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20562 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20563 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20564
20565 @end table
20566
20567
20568 @node Advanced Scoring
20569 @section Advanced Scoring
20570
20571 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20572 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20573 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20574 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20575 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20576
20577 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20578 scoring patterns.
20579
20580 @menu
20581 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20582 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20583 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20584 @end menu
20585
20586
20587 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20588 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20589
20590 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20591 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20592 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20593 non-@code{nil} value.
20594
20595 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20596 operator, and various match operators.
20597
20598 Logical operators:
20599
20600 @table @code
20601 @item &
20602 @itemx and
20603 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20604 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20605 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20606 @code{true}.
20607
20608 @item |
20609 @itemx or
20610 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20611 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20612 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20613
20614 @item !
20615 @itemx not
20616 @itemx ¬
20617 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20618 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20619
20620 @end table
20621
20622 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20623 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20624 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20625 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20626 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20627 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20628 the ancestry you want to go.
20629
20630 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20631 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20632 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20633 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20634 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20635
20636
20637 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20638 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20639
20640 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20641 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20642 of parentheses.
20643
20644 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20645 when he's talking about Gnus:
20646
20647 @example
20648 @group
20649 ((&
20650 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20651 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20652 1000)
20653 @end group
20654 @end example
20655
20656 Quite simple, huh?
20657
20658 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20659
20660 @example
20661 ((&
20662 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20663 (|
20664 ("subject" "Gnus")
20665 ("lines" 100 >)))
20666 1000)
20667 @end example
20668
20669 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20670 really don't want to read what he's written:
20671
20672 @example
20673 ((&
20674 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20675 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20676 -100000)
20677 @end example
20678
20679 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20680 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20681 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20682 very interesting:
20683
20684 @example
20685 ((&
20686 (1-
20687 (&
20688 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20689 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20690 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20691 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20692 1000)
20693 @end example
20694
20695 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20696 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20697 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20698 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20699
20700 @example
20701 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20702 -200)
20703 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20704 200)
20705 @end example
20706
20707 The possibilities are endless.
20708
20709 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20710 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20711
20712 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20713 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20714 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20715 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20716 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20717 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20718 @samp{subject}) first.
20719
20720 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20721 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20722 something like:
20723
20724 @example
20725 ...
20726 (1-
20727 (1-
20728 ("from" "lars")))
20729 ...
20730 @end example
20731
20732 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20733 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20734
20735 @example
20736 (1-
20737 (&
20738 ("from" "Lars")
20739 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20740 @end example
20741
20742 than it is to say:
20743
20744 @example
20745 (&
20746 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20747 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20748 @end example
20749
20750
20751 @node Score Decays
20752 @section Score Decays
20753 @cindex score decays
20754 @cindex decays
20755
20756 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20757 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20758 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20759 use them in any sensible way.
20760
20761 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20762 @findex gnus-decay-score
20763 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20764 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20765 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20766 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20767 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20768 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20769 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20770 definition of that function:
20771
20772 @lisp
20773 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20774 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20775 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20776 (let ((n (- score
20777 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20778 (min (abs score)
20779 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20780 (* (abs score)
20781 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20782 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20783 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20784 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20785 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20786 (string-to-number
20787 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20788 (floor n))))
20789 @end lisp
20790
20791 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20792 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20793 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20794 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20795
20796 @enumerate
20797 @item
20798 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20799
20800 @item
20801 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20802
20803 @item
20804 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20805 score.
20806 @end enumerate
20807
20808 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20809 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20810 the new score, which should be an integer.
20811
20812 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20813 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20814
20815 @iftex
20816 @iflatex
20817 @chapter Message
20818 @include message.texi
20819 @chapter Emacs MIME
20820 @include emacs-mime.texi
20821 @chapter Sieve
20822 @include sieve.texi
20823 @chapter PGG
20824 @include pgg.texi
20825 @end iflatex
20826 @end iftex
20827
20828 @node Various
20829 @chapter Various
20830
20831 @menu
20832 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20833 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20834 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20835 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20836 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20837 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20838 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20839 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20840 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20841 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20842 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20843 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20844 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20845 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20846 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20847 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20848 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20849 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20850 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
20851 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
20852 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20853 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20854 @end menu
20855
20856
20857 @node Process/Prefix
20858 @section Process/Prefix
20859 @cindex process/prefix convention
20860
20861 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20862 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20863
20864 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20865 command to be performed on.
20866
20867 It goes like this:
20868
20869 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20870 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20871 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20872 with the current one.
20873
20874 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20875 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20876 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20877
20878 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20879 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20880 the process mark.
20881
20882 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20883 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20884
20885 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20886 are avoided.
20887
20888 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20889 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20890 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20891 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20892
20893 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20894 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20895 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20896 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20897 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20898 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20899 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20900 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20901
20902 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20903 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20904 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20905 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20906 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20907
20908
20909 @node Interactive
20910 @section Interactive
20911 @cindex interaction
20912
20913 @table @code
20914
20915 @item gnus-novice-user
20916 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20917 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20918 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20919 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20920 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20921 default.
20922
20923 @item gnus-expert-user
20924 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20925 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20926 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20927 matter how strange.
20928
20929 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20930 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20931 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20932 is @code{t} by default.
20933
20934 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20935 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20936 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20937 default.
20938 @end table
20939
20940
20941 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20942 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20943 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20944
20945 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20946 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20947 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20948 rule of 900 to the current article.
20949
20950 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20951 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20952 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20953 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20954 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20955 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20956 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20957
20958 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20959 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20960 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20961 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20962 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20963 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20964 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20965 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20966 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20967
20968 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20969 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20970 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20971
20972 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20973 Interactive}.
20974
20975
20976 @node Formatting Variables
20977 @section Formatting Variables
20978 @cindex formatting variables
20979
20980 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20981 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20982 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20983 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20984 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20985 be annoyed by.
20986
20987 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20988 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20989 lots of percentages everywhere.
20990
20991 @menu
20992 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20993 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20994 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20995 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20996 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20997 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20998 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20999 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
21000 @end menu
21001
21002 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
21003 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
21004 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
21005 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
21006 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
21007 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
21008 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
21009 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
21010
21011 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
21012 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
21013
21014 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
21015 @findex gnus-update-format
21016 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
21017 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
21018 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
21019 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
21020
21021
21022
21023 @node Formatting Basics
21024 @subsection Formatting Basics
21025
21026 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
21027 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
21028 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
21029
21030 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
21031 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
21032 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
21033 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
21034 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
21035 the right instead.
21036
21037 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
21038 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
21039 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
21040 less than 4 characters wide.
21041
21042 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
21043 @samp{%&user-date;}.
21044
21045
21046 @node Mode Line Formatting
21047 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
21048
21049 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
21050 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
21051 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
21052 with the following two differences:
21053
21054 @enumerate
21055
21056 @item
21057 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
21058
21059 @item
21060 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
21061 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
21062 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
21063 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
21064 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
21065 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
21066 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
21067
21068 @end enumerate
21069
21070
21071 @node Advanced Formatting
21072 @subsection Advanced Formatting
21073
21074 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
21075 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
21076 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
21077 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
21078
21079 These are the valid modifiers:
21080
21081 @table @code
21082 @item pad
21083 @itemx pad-left
21084 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
21085 length.
21086
21087 @item pad-right
21088 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
21089 length.
21090
21091 @item max
21092 @itemx max-left
21093 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
21094
21095 @item max-right
21096 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
21097 length.
21098
21099 @item cut
21100 @itemx cut-left
21101 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
21102
21103 @item cut-right
21104 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
21105
21106 @item ignore
21107 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
21108
21109 @item form
21110 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
21111 used.
21112
21113 Here's an example:
21114
21115 @lisp
21116 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
21117 @end lisp
21118
21119 @end table
21120
21121 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
21122 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
21123 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
21124 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
21125 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
21126 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
21127 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
21128
21129 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
21130 last operation, padding.
21131
21132 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
21133 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
21134 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
21135 @xref{Compilation}.
21136
21137
21138 @node User-Defined Specs
21139 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21140
21141 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21142 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21143 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21144 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21145 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21146 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21147 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21148 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21149 should protect against that.
21150
21151 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21152 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21153
21154 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21155 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21156 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21157 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21158 inserted.
21159
21160
21161 @node Formatting Fonts
21162 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21163
21164 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21165 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21166 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21167 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21168 over it.
21169
21170 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21171 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21172 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21173 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21174 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21175 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21176
21177 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21178 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21179 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21180 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21181 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21182 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21183 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21184 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21185 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21186 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21187 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21188 paragraph.)
21189
21190 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21191
21192 @lisp
21193 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21194 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21195 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21196
21197 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21198 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21199 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21200 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21201 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21202 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21203 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21204
21205 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21206 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21207 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21208 @end lisp
21209
21210 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21211 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21212
21213 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21214 mode-line variables.
21215
21216 @node Positioning Point
21217 @subsection Positioning Point
21218
21219 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21220 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21221 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21222
21223 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21224
21225 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21226 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21227 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21228
21229 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21230 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21231 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21232 place point there.
21233
21234
21235 @node Tabulation
21236 @subsection Tabulation
21237
21238 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21239 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21240 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21241 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21242
21243 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21244 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21245
21246 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21247 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21248 This is the soft tabulator.
21249
21250 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21251 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21252 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21253
21254
21255 @node Wide Characters
21256 @subsection Wide Characters
21257
21258 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21259 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21260 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21261
21262 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21263 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21264 these countries, that's not true.
21265
21266 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21267 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21268 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21269 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21270 for Emacs.
21271
21272
21273 @node Window Layout
21274 @section Window Layout
21275 @cindex window layout
21276
21277 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21278
21279 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21280 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21281 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21282 @code{t} by default.
21283
21284 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21285 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21286
21287 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21288 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21289 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21290
21291 @lisp
21292 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21293 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21294 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21295 (article 1.0))))
21296 @end lisp
21297
21298 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21299 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21300 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21301 possible names is listed below.
21302
21303 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21304 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21305
21306 @lisp
21307 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21308 (article 1.0)))
21309 @end lisp
21310
21311 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21312 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21313 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21314 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21315 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21316 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21317 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21318 size spec per split.
21319
21320 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21321 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21322 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21323 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21324 present) gets focus.
21325
21326 Here's a more complicated example:
21327
21328 @lisp
21329 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21330 (summary 0.25 point)
21331 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21332 (article 1.0)))
21333 @end lisp
21334
21335 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21336 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21337 occupy, not a percentage.
21338
21339 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21340 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21341 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21342 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21343 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21344 is non-@code{nil}.
21345
21346 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21347
21348 @lisp
21349 (article (horizontal 1.0
21350 (vertical 0.5
21351 (group 1.0)
21352 (gnus-carpal 4))
21353 (vertical 1.0
21354 (summary 0.25 point)
21355 (summary-carpal 4)
21356 (article 1.0))))
21357 @end lisp
21358
21359 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21360 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21361
21362 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21363 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21364 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21365 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21366 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21367
21368 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21369 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21370 lines from the splits.
21371
21372 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21373 may look like:
21374
21375 @example
21376 @group
21377 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21378 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21379 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21380 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21381 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21382 size = number | frame-params
21383 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21384 @end group
21385 @end example
21386
21387 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21388 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21389 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21390 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21391
21392 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21393 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21394 @cindex window height
21395 @cindex window width
21396 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21397 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21398 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21399 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21400 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21401 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21402
21403 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21404 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21405 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21406 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21407
21408 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21409 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21410 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21411 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21412 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21413 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21414 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21415 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21416 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21417 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21418 configuration list.
21419
21420 @lisp
21421 (gnus-configure-frame
21422 '(horizontal 1.0
21423 (vertical 10
21424 (group 1.0)
21425 (article 0.3 point))
21426 (vertical 1.0
21427 (article 1.0)
21428 (horizontal 4
21429 (group 1.0)
21430 (article 10)))))
21431 @end lisp
21432
21433 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21434 @code{frame} split:
21435
21436 @lisp
21437 (gnus-configure-frame
21438 '(frame 1.0
21439 (vertical 1.0
21440 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21441 (article 1.0))
21442 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21443 (user-position . t)
21444 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21445 (picon 1.0))))
21446
21447 @end lisp
21448
21449 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21450 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21451 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21452 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21453 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21454 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21455 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21456 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21457 is such a plist.
21458 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21459 be found in its default value.
21460
21461 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21462 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21463 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21464 might be used:
21465
21466 @lisp
21467 (message (horizontal 1.0
21468 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21469 (vertical 0.24
21470 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21471 '(summary 0.5))
21472 (group 1.0))))
21473 @end lisp
21474
21475 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21476 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21477 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21478
21479 @lisp
21480 (message
21481 (frame 1.0
21482 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21483 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21484 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21485 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21486 (name . "Message"))
21487 (message 1.0 point))))
21488 @end lisp
21489
21490 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21491 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21492 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21493 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21494 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21495
21496 @lisp
21497 (gnus-add-configuration
21498 '(article (vertical 1.0
21499 (group 4)
21500 (summary .25 point)
21501 (article 1.0))))
21502 @end lisp
21503
21504 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21505 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21506 Gnus has been loaded.
21507
21508 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21509 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21510 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21511 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21512 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21513
21514 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21515 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21516 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21517 windows resized.
21518
21519 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21520
21521 @itemize @bullet
21522 @item
21523 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21524 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21525
21526 @ifinfo
21527 @example
21528 +---+---------+
21529 | G | Summary |
21530 | r +---------+
21531 | o | |
21532 | u | Article |
21533 | p | |
21534 +---+---------+
21535 @end example
21536 @end ifinfo
21537
21538 @lisp
21539 (gnus-add-configuration
21540 '(article
21541 (horizontal 1.0
21542 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21543 (vertical 1.0
21544 (summary 0.16 point)
21545 (article 1.0)))))
21546
21547 (gnus-add-configuration
21548 '(summary
21549 (horizontal 1.0
21550 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21551 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21552 @end lisp
21553
21554 @end itemize
21555
21556
21557 @node Faces and Fonts
21558 @section Faces and Fonts
21559 @cindex faces
21560 @cindex fonts
21561 @cindex colors
21562
21563 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21564 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21565 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21566 interface.
21567
21568
21569 @node Compilation
21570 @section Compilation
21571 @cindex compilation
21572 @cindex byte-compilation
21573
21574 @findex gnus-compile
21575
21576 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21577 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21578 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21579 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21580 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21581 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21582 course.)
21583
21584 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21585 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21586 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21587 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21588 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21589 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21590 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21591
21592
21593 @node Mode Lines
21594 @section Mode Lines
21595 @cindex mode lines
21596
21597 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21598 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21599 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21600 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21601 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21602 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21603 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21604 quicker.
21605
21606 @cindex display-time
21607
21608 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21609 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21610 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21611 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21612 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21613 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21614 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21615 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21616 this variable:
21617
21618 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21619 @lisp
21620 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21621 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21622 (+ 21
21623 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21624 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21625 (length display-time-string)))))
21626 @end lisp
21627
21628 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21629 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21630 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21631 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21632 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21633
21634
21635 @node Highlighting and Menus
21636 @section Highlighting and Menus
21637 @cindex visual
21638 @cindex highlighting
21639 @cindex menus
21640
21641 @vindex gnus-visual
21642 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21643 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21644 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21645 file.
21646
21647 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21648 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21649
21650 @table @code
21651 @item group-highlight
21652 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21653 @item summary-highlight
21654 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21655 @item article-highlight
21656 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21657 @item highlight
21658 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21659 @item group-menu
21660 Create menus in the group buffer.
21661 @item summary-menu
21662 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21663 @item article-menu
21664 Create menus in the article buffer.
21665 @item browse-menu
21666 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21667 @item server-menu
21668 Create menus in the server buffer.
21669 @item score-menu
21670 Create menus in the score buffers.
21671 @item menu
21672 Create menus in all buffers.
21673 @end table
21674
21675 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21676 buffers, you could say something like:
21677
21678 @lisp
21679 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21680 @end lisp
21681
21682 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21683
21684 @lisp
21685 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21686 @end lisp
21687
21688 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21689 in all Gnus buffers.
21690
21691 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21692
21693 @table @code
21694 @item gnus-mouse-face
21695 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21696 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21697 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21698
21699 @end table
21700
21701 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21702
21703 @table @code
21704
21705 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21706 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21707 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21708
21709 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21710 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21711 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21712
21713 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21714 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21715 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21716
21717 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21718 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21719 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21720
21721 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21722 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21723 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21724
21725 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21726 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21727 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21728
21729 @end table
21730
21731
21732 @node Buttons
21733 @section Buttons
21734 @cindex buttons
21735 @cindex mouse
21736 @cindex click
21737
21738 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21739 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21740 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21741 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21742 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21743
21744 Right.
21745
21746 @vindex gnus-carpal
21747 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21748 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21749 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21750
21751
21752 @table @code
21753
21754 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21755 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21756 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21757
21758 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21759 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21760 Face used on buttons.
21761
21762 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21763 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21764 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21765
21766 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21767 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21768 Buttons in the group buffer.
21769
21770 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21771 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21772 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21773
21774 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21775 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21776 Buttons in the server buffer.
21777
21778 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21779 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21780 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21781 @end table
21782
21783 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21784 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21785 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21786
21787
21788 @node Daemons
21789 @section Daemons
21790 @cindex demons
21791 @cindex daemons
21792
21793 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21794 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21795 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21796 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21797 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21798
21799 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21800 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21801 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21802
21803 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21804 been idle for thirty minutes:
21805
21806 @lisp
21807 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21808 @end lisp
21809
21810 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21811 Emacs is idle:
21812
21813 @lisp
21814 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21815 @end lisp
21816
21817 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21818 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21819 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21820
21821 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21822 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21823 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21824 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21825
21826 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21827 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21828 @var{idle} minutes.
21829
21830 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21831 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21832 minutes.
21833
21834 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21835 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21836 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21837
21838 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21839 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21840 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21841 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21842
21843 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21844 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21845
21846 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21847 @lisp
21848 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21849 @end lisp
21850
21851 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21852 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21853 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21854 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21855 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21856 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21857 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21858 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21859 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21860 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21861 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21862
21863 @findex gnus-demon-init
21864 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21865 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21866 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21867 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21868 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21869
21870 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21871 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21872 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21873 behave.
21874
21875
21876 @node NoCeM
21877 @section NoCeM
21878 @cindex nocem
21879 @cindex spam
21880
21881 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21882 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21883
21884 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21885 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21886 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21887 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21888 away.
21889
21890 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21891 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21892 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21893 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21894
21895 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21896 this will make spam disappear.
21897
21898 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21899
21900 @table @code
21901 @item gnus-use-nocem
21902 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21903 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21904 by default.
21905
21906 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
21907 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
21908 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
21909 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
21910 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
21911 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
21912 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
21913 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
21914
21915 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21916 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21917 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21918 default is
21919 @lisp
21920 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21921 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21922 @end lisp
21923
21924 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21925 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21926 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21927 people you want to listen to. The default is
21928 @lisp
21929 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21930 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21931 @end lisp
21932 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21933
21934 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21935 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21936
21937 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21938 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21939 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21940 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21941 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21942 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21943 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21944 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21945 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21946 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21947
21948 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21949 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21950
21951 @lisp
21952 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21953 @end lisp
21954
21955 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21956 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21957
21958 @lisp
21959 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21960 @end lisp
21961
21962 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21963
21964
21965 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21966 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21967 @findex pgg-verify
21968 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21969 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
21970 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
21971 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
21972 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
21973 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21974
21975 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21976 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
21977 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
21978 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
21979
21980 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21981 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21982 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21983 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21984
21985 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21986 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21987 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21988 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21989 might then see old spam.
21990
21991 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21992 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21993 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21994 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21995 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21996 issuers.
21997
21998 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21999 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22000 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
22001 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
22002
22003 @end table
22004
22005 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
22006 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
22007 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
22008 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
22009
22010
22011 @node Undo
22012 @section Undo
22013 @cindex undo
22014
22015 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
22016 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
22017 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
22018
22019 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
22020 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
22021 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
22022 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
22023 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
22024 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
22025 @code{undo} function.
22026
22027 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
22028 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
22029 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
22030 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
22031 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
22032 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
22033 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
22034 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
22035 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
22036 never be totally undoable.
22037
22038 @findex gnus-undo-mode
22039 @vindex gnus-use-undo
22040 @findex gnus-undo
22041 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
22042 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
22043 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
22044 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
22045 command.
22046
22047
22048 @node Predicate Specifiers
22049 @section Predicate Specifiers
22050 @cindex predicate specifiers
22051
22052 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
22053 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
22054 to type all that much.
22055
22056 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
22057
22058 Here's an example:
22059
22060 @lisp
22061 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
22062 gnus-article-unread-p)
22063 @end lisp
22064
22065 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
22066 functions all take one parameter.
22067
22068 @findex gnus-make-predicate
22069 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
22070 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
22071 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
22072 specifier.
22073
22074
22075 @node Moderation
22076 @section Moderation
22077 @cindex moderation
22078
22079 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
22080 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
22081 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
22082 get a copy.
22083
22084 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
22085 buffers. Put
22086
22087 @lisp
22088 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
22089 @end lisp
22090
22091 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22092
22093 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
22094 supposed to work:
22095
22096 @enumerate
22097 @item
22098 You split your incoming mail by matching on
22099 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
22100 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
22101
22102 @item
22103 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
22104 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
22105
22106 @item
22107 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
22108 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
22109 @kbd{c} command.
22110 @end enumerate
22111
22112 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
22113
22114 @lisp
22115 (setq gnus-moderated-list
22116 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
22117 @end lisp
22118
22119
22120 @node Fetching a Group
22121 @section Fetching a Group
22122 @cindex fetching a group
22123
22124 @findex gnus-fetch-group
22125 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
22126 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
22127 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
22128 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
22129 It takes the group name as a parameter.
22130
22131
22132 @node Image Enhancements
22133 @section Image Enhancements
22134
22135 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
22136 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
22137 taken advantage of that.
22138
22139 @menu
22140 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
22141 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
22142 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
22143 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
22144 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
22145 @end menu
22146
22147
22148 @node X-Face
22149 @subsection X-Face
22150 @cindex x-face
22151
22152 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22153 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22154 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22155 readers.
22156
22157 @cindex x-face
22158 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22159 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22160 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22161 @iftex
22162 @iflatex
22163 \include{xface}
22164 @end iflatex
22165 @end iftex
22166 @c @anchor{X-Face}
22167
22168 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22169 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
22170 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
22171 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
22172 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
22173 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
22174 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends. For XEmacs it's faster if
22175 XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The default action
22176 under Emacs without image support is to fork off the @code{display}
22177 program.
22178
22179 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is from the
22180 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
22181 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
22182
22183 The variable that controls this is the
22184 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
22185 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22186 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22187 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
22188 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22189
22190 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22191 @code{xface}).
22192
22193 @noindent
22194 Face and variable:
22195
22196 @table @code
22197 @item gnus-x-face
22198 @vindex gnus-x-face
22199 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22200 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22201 default colors are black and white.
22202 @end table
22203
22204 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
22205 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
22206 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
22207 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
22208 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
22209 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
22210
22211 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22212 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22213 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22214 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22215 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22216 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22217 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22218 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22219 header data as a string.
22220
22221 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22222 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22223 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22224 randomly generated data.
22225
22226 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22227 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22228 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22229 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22230 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22231
22232 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22233 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22234
22235 @lisp
22236 (setq message-required-news-headers
22237 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22238 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22239 @end lisp
22240
22241 Using the last function would be something like this:
22242
22243 @lisp
22244 (setq message-required-news-headers
22245 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22246 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22247 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22248 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22249 @end lisp
22250
22251
22252 @node Face
22253 @subsection Face
22254 @cindex face
22255
22256 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
22257
22258 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22259 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22260 represent the author of the message.
22261
22262 @cindex face
22263 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22264 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22265 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22266 specifications.
22267
22268 Viewing an @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
22269 PNG images.
22270 @c Maybe add this:
22271 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
22272 @c (featurep 'png)
22273 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
22274
22275 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22276 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22277
22278 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22279 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22280 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22281
22282 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22283 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22284 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22285 converts the file to Face format by using the
22286 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22287
22288 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22289 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22290
22291 @lisp
22292 (setq message-required-news-headers
22293 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22294 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22295 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22296 @end lisp
22297
22298
22299 @node Smileys
22300 @subsection Smileys
22301 @cindex smileys
22302
22303 @iftex
22304 @iflatex
22305 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22306 \input{smiley}
22307 @end iflatex
22308 @end iftex
22309
22310 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22311 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22312
22313 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22314 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22315
22316 @lisp
22317 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22318 @end lisp
22319
22320 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22321 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22322 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22323 text and maps that to file names.
22324
22325 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22326 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22327 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22328 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22329 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22330 displayed.
22331
22332 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22333 files:
22334
22335 @table @code
22336
22337 @item smiley-data-directory
22338 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22339 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22340
22341 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22342 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22343 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22344
22345 @end table
22346
22347
22348 @node Picons
22349 @subsection Picons
22350
22351 @iftex
22352 @iflatex
22353 \include{picons}
22354 @end iflatex
22355 @end iftex
22356
22357 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22358 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22359 over your shoulder as you read news.
22360
22361 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22362
22363 @iftex
22364 @iflatex
22365 \margindex{}
22366 @end iflatex
22367 @end iftex
22368
22369 @quotation
22370 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22371 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22372 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22373 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22374 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22375 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22376 @code{GIF} formats.
22377 @end quotation
22378
22379 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22380 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22381 point your Web browser at
22382 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22383
22384 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22385 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22386
22387 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22388 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22389 Picons databases.
22390
22391 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22392
22393 @table @code
22394
22395 @item gnus-picon-databases
22396 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22397 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22398 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22399 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22400 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22401
22402 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22403 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22404 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22405 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22406
22407 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22408 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22409 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22410 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22411
22412 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22413 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22414 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22415 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22416 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22417
22418 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22419 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22420 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22421 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22422
22423 @end table
22424
22425
22426 @node XVarious
22427 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22428
22429 @table @code
22430 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22431 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22432 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22433 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22434 unusual directory structure.
22435
22436 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22437 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22438 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22439 default.
22440
22441 @end table
22442
22443 @subsubsection Toolbar
22444
22445 @table @code
22446
22447 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22448 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22449 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
22450 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
22451 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
22452 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
22453 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
22454 names show. The default is @code{default}.
22455
22456 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
22457 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
22458 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
22459 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
22460 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
22461 The default is that of the default toolbar.
22462
22463 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22464 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22465 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22466
22467 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22468 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22469 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22470
22471 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22472 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22473 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22474
22475 @end table
22476
22477 @iftex
22478 @iflatex
22479 \margindex{}
22480 @end iflatex
22481 @end iftex
22482
22483
22484 @node Fuzzy Matching
22485 @section Fuzzy Matching
22486 @cindex fuzzy matching
22487
22488 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22489 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22490
22491 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22492 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22493 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22494
22495 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22496 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22497 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22498 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22499 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22500
22501
22502 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22503 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22504 @cindex email spam
22505 @cindex spam
22506 @cindex UCE
22507 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22508
22509 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22510 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22511 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22512 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22513 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22514 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22515 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22516 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22517 in the end.
22518
22519 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22520 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22521 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22522 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22523 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22524 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22525
22526 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22527
22528 @menu
22529 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22530 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22531 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22532 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22533 @end menu
22534
22535 @node The problem of spam
22536 @subsection The problem of spam
22537 @cindex email spam
22538 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22539 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22540 @cindex UCE
22541 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22542
22543 First, some background on spam.
22544
22545 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22546 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22547 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22548 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22549 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22550 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22551 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22552 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22553 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22554
22555 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22556 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22557 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22558 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22559 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22560 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22561 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22562 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22563 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22564 and processing.
22565
22566 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22567 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22568 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22569 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22570 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22571 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22572 from Bulgarian IPs.
22573
22574 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22575 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22576 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22577 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22578
22579 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22580 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22581 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22582 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22583
22584 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22585 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22586 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22587 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22588 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22589 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22590 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22591 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22592 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22593
22594 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22595 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22596 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22597 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22598 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22599 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22600 down for some time because of the incident.
22601
22602 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22603 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22604 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22605 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22606 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22607 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22608 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22609 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
22610 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22611 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22612 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22613
22614 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22615 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22616 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22617 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22618 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22619 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22620 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22621 spam plague.
22622
22623 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22624 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22625 @cindex email spam
22626 @cindex spam
22627 @cindex UCE
22628 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22629
22630 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22631 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22632
22633 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22634 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22635 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22636 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22637 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22638 part of the mail address.)
22639
22640 @lisp
22641 (setq message-default-news-headers
22642 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22643 @end lisp
22644
22645 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22646 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22647
22648 @lisp
22649 (...
22650 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22651 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22652 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22653 "spam"))
22654 ...)
22655 @end lisp
22656
22657 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22658 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22659 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22660 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22661
22662 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22663 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22664 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22665 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22666 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22667 your fancy split rule in this way:
22668
22669 @lisp
22670 (
22671 ...
22672 (to "larsi" "misc")
22673 "spam")
22674 @end lisp
22675
22676 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22677 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22678 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22679 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22680 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22681
22682 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22683 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22684 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22685 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22686
22687 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22688
22689
22690 @node SpamAssassin
22691 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22692 @cindex SpamAssassin
22693 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22694 @cindex DCC
22695
22696 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22697 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22698 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22699 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22700 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22701 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22702 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22703
22704 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22705 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22706 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22707 recipes.
22708
22709 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22710 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22711 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22712 Specifiers}) follow.
22713
22714 @lisp
22715 (setq mail-sources
22716 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22717 (pop :user "jrl"
22718 :server "pophost"
22719 :postscript
22720 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22721 @end lisp
22722
22723 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22724 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22725 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22726
22727 @lisp
22728 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22729 ...))
22730 @end lisp
22731
22732 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22733
22734 @lisp
22735 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22736 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22737 ...))
22738 @end lisp
22739
22740 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22741 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22742 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22743 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22744
22745 @lisp
22746 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22747 ...))
22748 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22749 (save-excursion
22750 (save-restriction
22751 (widen)
22752 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22753 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22754 "spam"))))
22755 @end lisp
22756
22757 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22758 downloaded by default. You need to set
22759 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22760 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22761
22762 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22763 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22764 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22765
22766 @lisp
22767 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22768 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22769 (interactive)
22770 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22771 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22772 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22773 @end lisp
22774
22775 @node Hashcash
22776 @subsection Hashcash
22777 @cindex hashcash
22778
22779 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22780 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22781 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22782 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22783 in smaller communities.
22784
22785 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22786 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22787 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22788 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22789 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22790 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22791 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22792 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22793 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22794 one of them separately.
22795
22796 @cindex X-Hashcash
22797 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22798 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22799 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22800 header. For more details, and for the external application
22801 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22802 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22803 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22804
22805 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22806 like:
22807
22808 @lisp
22809 (require 'hashcash)
22810 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22811 @end lisp
22812
22813 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22814 contrib directory or at
22815 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22816
22817 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22818
22819 @table @code
22820
22821 @item hashcash-default-payment
22822 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22823 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22824 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22825 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22826
22827 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22828 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22829 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22830 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22831 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22832 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22833 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22834 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22835 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22836
22837 @item hashcash
22838 @vindex hashcash
22839 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22840
22841 @end table
22842
22843 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22844 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22845 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22846 a useful contribution, however.
22847
22848 @node Spam Package
22849 @section Spam Package
22850 @cindex spam filtering
22851 @cindex spam
22852
22853 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
22854 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
22855 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
22856 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
22857
22858 @menu
22859 * Spam Package Introduction::
22860 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
22861 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
22862 * Spam and Ham Processors::
22863 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
22864 * Spam Back Ends::
22865 * Extending the Spam package::
22866 * Spam Statistics Package::
22867 @end menu
22868
22869 @node Spam Package Introduction
22870 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
22871 @cindex spam filtering
22872 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22873 @cindex spam
22874
22875 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
22876 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22877
22878 @cindex spam-initialize
22879 @vindex spam-use-stat
22880 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
22881 @code{spam-initialize}:
22882
22883 @example
22884 (spam-initialize)
22885 @end example
22886
22887 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
22888 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
22889 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
22890 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
22891 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
22892
22893 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
22894 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
22895
22896 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
22897 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
22898
22899 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
22900 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
22901 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
22902 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
22903 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
22904
22905 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
22906 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
22907 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
22908 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
22909 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
22910 Groups}.
22911
22912 @cindex spam back ends
22913 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
22914 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
22915 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
22916 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
22917 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
22918
22919 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
22920 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
22921
22922 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
22923 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
22924 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
22925 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
22926 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
22927 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
22928 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
22929
22930 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
22931 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
22932 point, the Spam package does several things:
22933
22934 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
22935 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
22936 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
22937 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
22938 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
22939 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
22940 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
22941 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
22942 Ham Processors}.
22943
22944 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
22945 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
22946 group:
22947
22948 @table @kbd
22949 @item M-d
22950 @itemx M s x
22951 @itemx S x
22952 @kindex M-d
22953 @kindex S x
22954 @kindex M s x
22955 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22956 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22957 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
22958 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
22959 @end table
22960
22961 @noindent
22962 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
22963 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
22964
22965 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
22966 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
22967 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
22968 to be processed as ham by setting
22969 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22970 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
22971
22972 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
22973 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
22974 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
22975 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
22976 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
22977 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
22978 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
22979 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
22980 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
22981 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
22982 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
22983 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
22984
22985 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
22986 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
22987 want each article to be processed only once, load the
22988 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
22989 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
22990 Configuration Examples}.
22991
22992 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
22993 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
22994 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
22995 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
22996
22997 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
22998 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22999
23000 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
23001 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
23002 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
23003
23004 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
23005 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
23006 @cindex spam filtering
23007 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
23008 @cindex spam
23009
23010 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
23011 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
23012 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
23013 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
23014 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
23015
23016 @example
23017 (: spam-split)
23018 @end example
23019
23020 @vindex spam-split-group
23021 @noindent
23022 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
23023 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
23024 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
23025 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
23026 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
23027 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
23028 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
23029 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
23030 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
23031
23032 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
23033
23034 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
23035 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
23036 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
23037 you should also set set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body}
23038 to @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can
23039 ``scan'' the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only
23040 retrieves the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells
23041 it to retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by
23042 default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
23043 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Splitting
23044 in IMAP}.
23045
23046 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
23047 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
23048 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
23049 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
23050 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
23051 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
23052 ends, and the following split rule:
23053
23054 @example
23055 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23056 (any "ding" "ding")
23057 (: spam-split)
23058 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23059 "mail")
23060 @end example
23061
23062 @noindent
23063 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
23064 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
23065 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
23066 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
23067 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
23068 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
23069
23070 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
23071 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
23072 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
23073 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
23074
23075 @example
23076 nnimap-split-fancy
23077 '(|
23078 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
23079 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23080 (any "ding" "ding")
23081 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
23082 (: spam-split)
23083 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23084 "mail")
23085 @end example
23086
23087 @noindent
23088 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
23089 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
23090 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
23091 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
23092 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
23093 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
23094 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
23095
23096 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23097 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23098 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23099 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23100
23101 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
23102 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
23103 @c don't.}
23104
23105 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
23106 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
23107
23108 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
23109 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
23110 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
23111 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
23112
23113 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23114 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23115 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23116 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
23117
23118 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
23119 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
23120 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
23121
23122 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
23123 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
23124 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
23125 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
23126 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
23127 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
23128 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
23129
23130 @node Spam and Ham Processors
23131 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
23132 @cindex spam filtering
23133 @cindex spam filtering variables
23134 @cindex spam variables
23135 @cindex spam
23136
23137 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
23138 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
23139 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
23140 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
23141 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
23142 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
23143 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
23144
23145 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
23146 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
23147 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
23148 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
23149
23150 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23151 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23152 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23153 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23154 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23155 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23156 by customizing the corresponding variable
23157 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23158 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23159 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23160 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23161 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23162 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23163 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23164 default.
23165
23166 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23167 @cindex $
23168 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23169 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23170 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23171 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23172 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23173 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23174 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23175 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23176 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23177 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23178 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23179 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23180 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23181
23182 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23183 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23184 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23185 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23186 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23187 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23188 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23189 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23190
23191 @defvar ham-marks
23192 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23193 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23194 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23195 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23196 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23197 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23198 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23199 happy for you.
23200 @end defvar
23201
23202 @defvar spam-marks
23203 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23204 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23205 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23206 you really want to.
23207 @end defvar
23208
23209 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23210 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23211 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23212 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23213 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23214 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23215 and nothing else.
23216
23217 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23218 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23219 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23220 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23221 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23222 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23223 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23224 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23225 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23226 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23227 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23228 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23229 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23230 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23231 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23232
23233 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23234 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23235
23236 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23237 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23238 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23239
23240 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23241 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23242
23243 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23244 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23245 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23246 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23247 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23248
23249 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23250 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23251 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23252 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23253 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23254 it there.
23255
23256 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23257 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23258 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23259 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23260 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23261 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23262 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23263 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23264 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23265 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23266 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23267 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23268 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23269
23270 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23271 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23272
23273 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23274 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23275 training} groups.
23276
23277 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23278 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23279 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23280 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23281 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23282 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23283 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23284
23285 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23286 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23287 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23288 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23289
23290 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23291 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23292 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23293 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23294 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23295 from the mail server.
23296
23297 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23298 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23299 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23300 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23301
23302 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
23303 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
23304 @cindex spam filtering
23305 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23306 @cindex spam configuration examples
23307 @cindex spam
23308
23309 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23310
23311 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23312 @example
23313 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23314 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23315 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23316 (spam-initialize)
23317
23318 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23319 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23320
23321 (setq
23322 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23323 spam-use-BBDB t
23324 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23325 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23326 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23327 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23328 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23329 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23330 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23331 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23332 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23333 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23334 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23335 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23336 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23337 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23338 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23339 (any "ding" "ding")
23340 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23341 (: spam-split)
23342 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23343 "mail"))
23344
23345 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23346
23347 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23348 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23349 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23350 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23351
23352 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23353
23354 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23355 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23356 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23357 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23358 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23359
23360 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23361 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23362
23363 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23364
23365 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23366 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23367
23368 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23369 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23370 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23371
23372 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23373
23374 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23375 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23376
23377 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23378 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23379 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23380 (ham-marks
23381 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23382 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23383 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23384 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23385
23386 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23387 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23388 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23389
23390 @end example
23391
23392 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23393 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23394
23395 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23396 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23397 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23398 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23399 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23400 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23401 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23402 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23403 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23404
23405 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23406 does most of the job for me:
23407
23408 @lisp
23409 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23410 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23411 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23412 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23413 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23414 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23415 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23416 @end lisp
23417
23418 @itemize
23419
23420 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23421
23422 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23423 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23424 bogofilter or DCC).
23425
23426 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23427 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23428 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
23429 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
23430 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
23431 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
23432 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23433
23434 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23435 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23436 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23437 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23438 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23439 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23440
23441 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23442
23443 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23444 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23445 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23446 @samp{training.ham}.
23447 @end itemize
23448
23449 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23450
23451 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23452
23453 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23454 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23455 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23456
23457 @lisp
23458 ("^gmane\\."
23459 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23460 @end lisp
23461
23462 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23463 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23464 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23465 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23466 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23467
23468 @node Spam Back Ends
23469 @subsection Spam Back Ends
23470 @cindex spam back ends
23471
23472 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
23473 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
23474 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
23475 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
23476 Processors}).
23477
23478 @menu
23479 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
23480 * BBDB Whitelists::
23481 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
23482 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
23483 * Blackholes::
23484 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
23485 * Bogofilter::
23486 * ifile spam filtering::
23487 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
23488 * SpamOracle::
23489 @end menu
23490
23491 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23492 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23493 @cindex spam filtering
23494 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23495 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23496 @cindex spam
23497
23498 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23499
23500 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23501 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23502 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23503 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23504 be spammers.
23505
23506 @end defvar
23507
23508 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23509
23510 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23511 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23512 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23513 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23514 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23515
23516 @end defvar
23517
23518 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23519
23520 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23521 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23522 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23523
23524 @end defvar
23525
23526 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23527
23528 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23529 customizing the group parameters or the
23530 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23531 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23532 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23533
23534 @emph{WARNING}
23535
23536 Instead of the obsolete
23537 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23538 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23539 the same way, we promise.
23540
23541 @end defvar
23542
23543 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23544
23545 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23546 customizing the group parameters or the
23547 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23548 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23549 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23550 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23551 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23552
23553 @emph{WARNING}
23554
23555 Instead of the obsolete
23556 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23557 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23558 the same way, we promise.
23559
23560 @end defvar
23561
23562 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23563 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23564 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23565 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23566 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23567
23568 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23569 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23570 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23571 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23572
23573 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23574 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23575 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23576 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23577 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23578 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23579
23580 @node BBDB Whitelists
23581 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23582 @cindex spam filtering
23583 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23584 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23585 @cindex spam
23586
23587 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23588
23589 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23590 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23591 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23592 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23593 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23594 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23595 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23596
23597 @end defvar
23598
23599 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23600
23601 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23602 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23603 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23604 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23605 classified as spammers.
23606
23607 @end defvar
23608
23609 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23610
23611 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23612 customizing the group parameters or the
23613 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23614 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23615 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23616 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23617 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23618
23619 @emph{WARNING}
23620
23621 Instead of the obsolete
23622 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23623 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23624 the same way, we promise.
23625
23626 @end defvar
23627
23628 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23629 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23630 @cindex spam reporting
23631 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23632 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23633 @cindex spam
23634
23635 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23636
23637 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23638 customizing the group parameters or the
23639 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23640 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23641 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23642 HTTP request.
23643
23644 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23645
23646 @emph{WARNING}
23647
23648 Instead of the obsolete
23649 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23650 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23651 same way, we promise.
23652
23653 @end defvar
23654
23655 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23656
23657 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23658 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23659 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23660 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23661 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23662 Gmane provides.
23663
23664 @end defvar
23665
23666 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23667 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23668 @cindex spam filtering
23669 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23670 @cindex spam
23671
23672 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23673
23674 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23675 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23676 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23677 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23678 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23679 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23680 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23681 ham.
23682
23683 @end defvar
23684
23685 @node Blackholes
23686 @subsubsection Blackholes
23687 @cindex spam filtering
23688 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23689 @cindex spam
23690
23691 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23692
23693 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23694 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23695 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23696 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23697 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23698 contains outdated servers.
23699
23700 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23701 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23702 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23703 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23704 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23705 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23706
23707 @end defvar
23708
23709 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23710
23711 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23712
23713 @end defvar
23714
23715 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23716
23717 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23718 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23719
23720 @end defvar
23721
23722 @defvar spam-use-dig
23723
23724 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23725 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23726
23727 @end defvar
23728
23729 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23730 ham processor for blackholes.
23731
23732 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23733 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23734 @cindex spam filtering
23735 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23736 @cindex spam
23737
23738 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23739
23740 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23741 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23742 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23743 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23744 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23745 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23746
23747 @end defvar
23748
23749 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23750
23751 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23752 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23753
23754 @end defvar
23755
23756 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23757
23758 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23759 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23760
23761 @end defvar
23762
23763 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23764 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23765
23766 @node Bogofilter
23767 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23768 @cindex spam filtering
23769 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23770 @cindex spam
23771
23772 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23773
23774 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23775 speedy Bogofilter.
23776
23777 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23778 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23779 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23780 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23781 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23782 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23783
23784 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23785 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23786 documentation.
23787
23788 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23789 processing will be turned off.
23790
23791 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23792
23793 @end defvar
23794
23795 @table @kbd
23796 @item M s t
23797 @itemx S t
23798 @kindex M s t
23799 @kindex S t
23800 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
23801 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
23802 @end table
23803
23804 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23805
23806 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23807 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23808 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23809 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23810 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23811 installation documents for details.
23812
23813 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23814
23815 @end defvar
23816
23817 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23818 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23819 customizing the group parameters or the
23820 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23821 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23822 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23823
23824 @emph{WARNING}
23825
23826 Instead of the obsolete
23827 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23828 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23829 the same way, we promise.
23830 @end defvar
23831
23832 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23833 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23834 customizing the group parameters or the
23835 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23836 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23837 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23838 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23839 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23840
23841 @emph{WARNING}
23842
23843 Instead of the obsolete
23844 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23845 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23846 the same way, we promise.
23847 @end defvar
23848
23849 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23850
23851 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23852 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23853 database directory.
23854
23855 @end defvar
23856
23857 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23858 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23859 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23860 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23861 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23862 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23863
23864 @node ifile spam filtering
23865 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23866 @cindex spam filtering
23867 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23868 @cindex spam
23869
23870 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23871
23872 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23873 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23874
23875 @end defvar
23876
23877 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23878
23879 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23880 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23881 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23882
23883 @end defvar
23884
23885 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23886
23887 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23888 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23889 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23890 @end defvar
23891
23892 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23893
23894 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23895 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23896
23897 @end defvar
23898
23899 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23900 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23901 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23902 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23903 functionality.
23904
23905 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
23906 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
23907 @cindex spam filtering
23908 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23909 @cindex spam-stat
23910 @cindex spam
23911
23912 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
23913 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
23914 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
23915 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
23916 spam-stat dictionary}.
23917
23918 @defvar spam-use-stat
23919
23920 @end defvar
23921
23922 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23923 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23924 customizing the group parameters or the
23925 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23926 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23927 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23928
23929 @emph{WARNING}
23930
23931 Instead of the obsolete
23932 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23933 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23934 the same way, we promise.
23935 @end defvar
23936
23937 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23938 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23939 customizing the group parameters or the
23940 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23941 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23942 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23943 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23944 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23945
23946 @emph{WARNING}
23947
23948 Instead of the obsolete
23949 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23950 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23951 the same way, we promise.
23952 @end defvar
23953
23954 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23955 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23956 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23957 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23958 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23959
23960 @node SpamOracle
23961 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23962 @cindex spam filtering
23963 @cindex SpamOracle
23964 @cindex spam
23965
23966 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23967 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23968 installed separately.
23969
23970 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23971 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23972 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23973 mail as a spam mail or not.
23974
23975 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23976 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23977 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23978
23979 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
23980 call SpamOracle.
23981
23982 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23983 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23984 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23985 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
23986 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
23987 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
23988 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
23989 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
23990
23991 @example
23992 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23993 spam-split-group "Junk"
23994 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23995 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23996 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23997 @end example
23998
23999 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
24000 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
24001 SpamOracle.
24002 @end defvar
24003
24004 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
24005 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
24006 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
24007 can be customized.
24008 @end defvar
24009
24010 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
24011 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
24012 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
24013 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
24014 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
24015 database to live somewhere special, set
24016 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
24017 @end defvar
24018
24019 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
24020 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
24021 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
24022 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
24023 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
24024 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
24025 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
24026 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
24027 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
24028 @xref{Spam Package}.
24029
24030 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
24031 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24032 customizing the group parameter or the
24033 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24034 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
24035 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
24036
24037 @emph{WARNING}
24038
24039 Instead of the obsolete
24040 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24041 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24042 the same way, we promise.
24043 @end defvar
24044
24045 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
24046 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24047 customizing the group parameter or the
24048 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24049 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
24050 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
24051 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
24052 @emph{unclassified} groups.
24053
24054 @emph{WARNING}
24055
24056 Instead of the obsolete
24057 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24058 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24059 the same way, we promise.
24060 @end defvar
24061
24062 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
24063 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
24064 messages.
24065 @example
24066 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
24067 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
24068 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
24069 @end example
24070 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
24071 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
24072 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
24073 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
24074 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
24075 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
24076
24077 @node Extending the Spam package
24078 @subsection Extending the Spam package
24079 @cindex spam filtering
24080 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
24081 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
24082
24083 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
24084 incoming mail, provide the following:
24085
24086 @enumerate
24087
24088 @item
24089 Code
24090
24091 @lisp
24092 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
24093 "True if blackbox should be used.")
24094 @end lisp
24095
24096 Add
24097 @lisp
24098 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
24099 @end lisp
24100 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
24101
24102 Add
24103 @lisp
24104 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
24105 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
24106 @end lisp
24107
24108 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
24109
24110 Add
24111 @lisp
24112 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
24113 nil
24114 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
24115 nil)
24116 @end lisp
24117
24118 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
24119 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
24120 start, or other register/unregister routines more appropriate to
24121 Blackbox.
24122
24123 @item
24124 Functionality
24125
24126 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
24127 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
24128 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
24129 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
24130 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
24131
24132 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
24133 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
24134 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
24135
24136 @end enumerate
24137
24138 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
24139
24140 @enumerate
24141
24142 @item
24143 Code
24144
24145 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
24146 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
24147
24148 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
24149 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
24150 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
24151 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
24152
24153 @lisp
24154 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
24155 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
24156 Only applicable to spam groups.")
24157
24158 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
24159 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
24160 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
24161
24162 @end lisp
24163
24164 @item
24165 Gnus parameters
24166
24167 Add
24168 @lisp
24169 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
24170 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
24171 @end lisp
24172 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
24173 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24174 variable customization.
24175
24176 Add
24177 @lisp
24178 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24179 @end lisp
24180 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24181 @code{gnus.el}.
24182
24183 @end enumerate
24184
24185 @node Spam Statistics Package
24186 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
24187 @cindex Paul Graham
24188 @cindex Graham, Paul
24189 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24190 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24191 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24192
24193 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24194 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24195 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24196 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24197 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24198 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24199 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24200 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24201 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24202 or not.
24203
24204 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24205 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24206 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24207 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24208 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24209 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24210 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24211 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24212
24213 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
24214 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
24215 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
24216
24217 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
24218 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24219 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24220 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24221 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24222
24223 @menu
24224 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24225 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24226 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24227 @end menu
24228
24229 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24230 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24231
24232 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24233 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24234 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24235 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24236 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24237
24238 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24239 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24240 per mail. Use the following:
24241
24242 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24243 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24244 is treated as one spam mail.
24245 @end defun
24246
24247 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24248 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24249 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24250 @end defun
24251
24252 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24253 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
24254 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24255 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24256 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
24257 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24258
24259 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24260 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24261 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24262 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24263 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24264
24265 @defvar spam-stat
24266 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24267 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24268 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24269 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24270 @end defvar
24271
24272 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24273 reset the dictionary.
24274
24275 @defun spam-stat-reset
24276 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24277 @end defun
24278
24279 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24280 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24281 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24282 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24283 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24284 only non-spam mails.
24285
24286 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24287 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24288 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24289 @end defun
24290
24291 @defun spam-stat-save
24292 Save the dictionary.
24293 @end defun
24294
24295 @defvar spam-stat-file
24296 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24297 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24298 @end defvar
24299
24300 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24301 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24302
24303 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
24304 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
24305
24306 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24307
24308 @lisp
24309 (require 'spam-stat)
24310 (spam-stat-load)
24311 @end lisp
24312
24313 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24314 created.
24315
24316 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24317 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24318 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24319 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24320
24321 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24322 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24323 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24324 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24325
24326 @lisp
24327 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24328 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24329 "mail.misc"))
24330 @end lisp
24331
24332 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24333 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24334 @end defvar
24335
24336 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24337 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24338 expression are considered potential spam.
24339
24340 @lisp
24341 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24342 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24343 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24344 "mail.misc"))
24345 @end lisp
24346
24347 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24348 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24349 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24350 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24351 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24352
24353 @lisp
24354 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24355 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24356 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24357 "mail.misc"))
24358 @end lisp
24359
24360 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24361 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24362 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24363 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24364 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24365 dictionary!
24366
24367 @lisp
24368 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24369 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24370 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24371 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24372 "mail.misc"))
24373 @end lisp
24374
24375
24376 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24377 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24378
24379 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24380
24381 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24382 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24383 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24384 @end defun
24385
24386 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24387 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24388 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24389 @end defun
24390
24391 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24392 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24393 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24394 already been processed as non-spam.
24395 @end defun
24396
24397 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24398 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24399 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24400 been processed as spam.
24401 @end defun
24402
24403 @defun spam-stat-save
24404 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24405 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24406 @end defun
24407
24408 @defun spam-stat-load
24409 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24410 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24411 @end defun
24412
24413 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24414 Return the spam score for a word.
24415 @end defun
24416
24417 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24418 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24419 @end defun
24420
24421 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24422 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24423 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24424 @end defun
24425
24426 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24427 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24428
24429 @lisp
24430 (require 'spam-stat)
24431 (spam-stat-load)
24432 @end lisp
24433
24434 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24435
24436 @smallexample
24437 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24438 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24439 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24440 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24441 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24442 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24443 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24444 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24445 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24446 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24447 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24448 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24449 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24450 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24451 @end smallexample
24452
24453 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24454
24455 @smallexample
24456 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24457 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24458 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24459 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24460 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24461 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24462 @end smallexample
24463
24464 @node Other modes
24465 @section Interaction with other modes
24466
24467 @subsection Dired
24468 @cindex dired
24469
24470 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24471 buffers. It is enabled with
24472 @lisp
24473 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24474 @end lisp
24475
24476 @table @kbd
24477 @item C-c C-m C-a
24478 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24479 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24480 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24481
24482 @item C-c C-m C-l
24483 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24484 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24485 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24486 buffer.
24487
24488 @item C-c C-m C-p
24489 @findex gnus-dired-print
24490 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24491 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24492 @end table
24493
24494 @node Various Various
24495 @section Various Various
24496 @cindex mode lines
24497 @cindex highlights
24498
24499 @table @code
24500
24501 @item gnus-home-directory
24502 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24503 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24504 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24505
24506 @item gnus-directory
24507 @vindex gnus-directory
24508 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24509 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24510 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24511
24512 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24513 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24514 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24515 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24516
24517 @item gnus-default-directory
24518 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24519 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24520 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24521 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24522 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24523 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24524 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24525
24526 @item gnus-verbose
24527 @vindex gnus-verbose
24528 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24529 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24530 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24531 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24532 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24533
24534 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24535 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24536 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24537 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24538
24539 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24540 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24541 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24542 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
24543 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24544 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24545 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24546 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24547 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24548 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24549
24550 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24551 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24552 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24553 read when doing the operation described above.
24554
24555 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24556 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24557 @cindex file names
24558 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24559 @cindex characters in file names
24560 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24561 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24562 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24563
24564 @lisp
24565 @group
24566 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24567 '((?: . ?_)))
24568 @end group
24569 @end lisp
24570
24571 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24572 Windows (phooey) systems.
24573
24574 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24575 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24576 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24577 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24578 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24579
24580 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24581 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24582 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24583 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24584 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24585
24586 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24587 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24588 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24589
24590 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24591 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24592
24593 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24594 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24595 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24596 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24597 group).
24598
24599 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24600
24601
24602 @end table
24603
24604 @node The End
24605 @chapter The End
24606
24607 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24608 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24609
24610 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24611
24612 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24613
24614 @quotation
24615 @strong{Te Deum}
24616
24617 @sp 1
24618 Not because of victories @*
24619 I sing,@*
24620 having none,@*
24621 but for the common sunshine,@*
24622 the breeze,@*
24623 the largess of the spring.
24624
24625 @sp 1
24626 Not for victory@*
24627 but for the day's work done@*
24628 as well as I was able;@*
24629 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24630 but at the common table.@*
24631 @end quotation
24632
24633
24634 @node Appendices
24635 @chapter Appendices
24636
24637 @menu
24638 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24639 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24640 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24641 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24642 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24643 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24644 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24645 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24646 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24647 @end menu
24648
24649
24650 @node XEmacs
24651 @section XEmacs
24652 @cindex XEmacs
24653 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24654
24655 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24656 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24657 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24658 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24659 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
24660 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24661
24662
24663 @node History
24664 @section History
24665
24666 @cindex history
24667 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24668 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24669
24670 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24671 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24672 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24673 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24674 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24675
24676 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24677 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24678 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24679 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24680 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24681 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24682
24683 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24684 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24685 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24686 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24687
24688 @menu
24689 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24690 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24691 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24692 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24693 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24694 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24695 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24696 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24697 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24698 @end menu
24699
24700
24701 @node Gnus Versions
24702 @subsection Gnus Versions
24703 @cindex ding Gnus
24704 @cindex September Gnus
24705 @cindex Red Gnus
24706 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24707 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24708 @cindex Oort Gnus
24709 @cindex No Gnus
24710 @cindex Gnus versions
24711
24712 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24713 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24714 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24715
24716 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24717 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24718
24719 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24720 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24721
24722 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24723 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24724
24725 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24726 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24727 1999.
24728
24729 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
24730 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
24731
24732 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
24733
24734 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24735 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24736 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
24737 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
24738 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
24739 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24740
24741
24742 @node Other Gnus Versions
24743 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24744 @cindex Semi-gnus
24745
24746 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24747 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24748 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24749 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24750
24751 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24752 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24753 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24754 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24755 Japanese users.
24756
24757
24758 @node Why?
24759 @subsection Why?
24760
24761 What's the point of Gnus?
24762
24763 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24764 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24765 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24766 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24767 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24768 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24769 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24770 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24771 keep track of millions of people who post?
24772
24773 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24774 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24775 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24776 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24777 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24778 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24779 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24780 every one of you to explore and invent.
24781
24782 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24783 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24784
24785
24786 @node Compatibility
24787 @subsection Compatibility
24788
24789 @cindex compatibility
24790 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24791 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24792 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24793
24794 Our motto is:
24795 @quotation
24796 @cartouche
24797 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24798 @end cartouche
24799 @end quotation
24800
24801 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24802 their names.
24803
24804 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24805 Articles}.
24806
24807 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24808 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24809 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24810 important variables have their values copied into their global
24811 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24812 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24813
24814 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24815 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24816 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24817 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24818 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24819 peculiar results.
24820
24821 @cindex hilit19
24822 @cindex highlighting
24823 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24824 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24825 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24826 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24827 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24828 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24829 Away!
24830
24831 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24832 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24833 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24834 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24835
24836 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24837 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24838 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24839 to stop doing it the old way.
24840
24841 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24842
24843 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24844 @findex gnus-bug
24845 @cindex reporting bugs
24846 @cindex bugs
24847 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24848 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24849 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24850
24851 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24852 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24853 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24854 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24855 up at you.
24856
24857
24858 @node Conformity
24859 @subsection Conformity
24860
24861 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24862 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24863 with, of course.
24864
24865 @table @strong
24866
24867 @item RFC (2)822
24868 @cindex RFC 822
24869 @cindex RFC 2822
24870 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24871
24872 @item RFC 1036
24873 @cindex RFC 1036
24874 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24875
24876 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24877 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24878 We do have some breaches to this one.
24879
24880 @table @emph
24881
24882 @item X-Newsreader
24883 @itemx User-Agent
24884 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24885 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24886 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24887 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24888 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24889 @end table
24890
24891 @item USEFOR
24892 @cindex USEFOR
24893 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24894 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24895 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24896 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24897
24898 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24899 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24900 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24901
24902 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24903 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24904
24905 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24906 @cindex RFC 1991
24907 @cindex RFC 2440
24908 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24909 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24910 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24911 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24912 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24913 decryption).
24914
24915 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24916 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24917 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
24918 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24919
24920 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24921 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24922
24923 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24924 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24925 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24926 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24927 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24928 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24929 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24930 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24931
24932 @end table
24933
24934 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24935 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24936 know.
24937
24938
24939 @node Emacsen
24940 @subsection Emacsen
24941 @cindex Emacsen
24942 @cindex XEmacs
24943 @cindex Mule
24944 @cindex Emacs
24945
24946 Gnus should work on:
24947
24948 @itemize @bullet
24949
24950 @item
24951 Emacs 21.1 and up.
24952
24953 @item
24954 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
24955
24956 @end itemize
24957
24958 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24959 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24960 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
24961 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
24962
24963 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24964 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24965 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24966 Emacsen.
24967
24968
24969 @node Gnus Development
24970 @subsection Gnus Development
24971
24972 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24973 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24974 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24975 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24976 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24977 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24978 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24979 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24980
24981 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24982 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24983 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24984 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24985 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24986
24987 @cindex Incoming*
24988 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24989 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24990 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24991 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24992 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24993
24994 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24995 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24996 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24997 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24998 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24999 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
25000 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
25001 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
25002 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
25003 can't be assumed to do so.
25004
25005
25006
25007 @node Contributors
25008 @subsection Contributors
25009 @cindex contributors
25010
25011 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
25012 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
25013 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
25014 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
25015 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
25016 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
25017 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
25018 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
25019 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
25020 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
25021
25022 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
25023 wrong show.
25024
25025 @itemize @bullet
25026
25027 @item
25028 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
25029
25030 @item
25031 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
25032 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
25033 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
25034 functionality and stuff.
25035
25036 @item
25037 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
25038 well as numerous other things).
25039
25040 @item
25041 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
25042
25043 @item
25044 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
25045
25046 @item
25047 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
25048
25049 @item
25050 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
25051
25052 @item
25053 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
25054 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
25055
25056 @item
25057 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
25058
25059 @item
25060 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
25061 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25062
25063 @item
25064 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
25065
25066 @item
25067 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
25068
25069 @item
25070 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
25071
25072 @item
25073 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
25074
25075 @item
25076 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
25077 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
25078
25079 @item
25080 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
25081
25082 @item
25083 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
25084
25085 @item
25086 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
25087
25088 @item
25089 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
25090 .newsrc files.
25091
25092 @item
25093 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
25094
25095 @item
25096 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
25097
25098 @item
25099 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
25100
25101 @item
25102 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
25103 well as autoconf support.
25104
25105 @end itemize
25106
25107 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
25108 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
25109
25110 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
25111
25112 Christopher Davis,
25113 Andrew Eskilsson,
25114 Kai Grossjohann,
25115 Kevin Greiner,
25116 Jesper Harder,
25117 Paul Jarc,
25118 Simon Josefsson,
25119 David KÃ¥gedal,
25120 Richard Pieri,
25121 Fabrice Popineau,
25122 Daniel Quinlan,
25123 Michael Shields,
25124 Reiner Steib,
25125 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
25126 Jack Vinson,
25127 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
25128 and
25129 Teodor Zlatanov.
25130
25131 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
25132
25133 Jari Aalto,
25134 Adrian Aichner,
25135 Vladimir Alexiev,
25136 Russ Allbery,
25137 Peter Arius,
25138 Matt Armstrong,
25139 Marc Auslander,
25140 Miles Bader,
25141 Alexei V. Barantsev,
25142 Frank Bennett,
25143 Robert Bihlmeyer,
25144 Chris Bone,
25145 Mark Borges,
25146 Mark Boyns,
25147 Lance A. Brown,
25148 Rob Browning,
25149 Kees de Bruin,
25150 Martin Buchholz,
25151 Joe Buehler,
25152 Kevin Buhr,
25153 Alastair Burt,
25154 Joao Cachopo,
25155 Zlatko Calusic,
25156 Massimo Campostrini,
25157 Castor,
25158 David Charlap,
25159 Dan Christensen,
25160 Kevin Christian,
25161 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
25162 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
25163 Laura Conrad,
25164 Michael R. Cook,
25165 Glenn Coombs,
25166 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
25167 Neil Crellin,
25168 Frank D. Cringle,
25169 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
25170 Andre Deparade,
25171 Ulrik Dickow,
25172 Dave Disser,
25173 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
25174 Joev Dubach,
25175 Michael Welsh Duggan,
25176 Dave Edmondson,
25177 Paul Eggert,
25178 Mark W. Eichin,
25179 Karl Eichwalder,
25180 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25181 Michael Ernst,
25182 Luc Van Eycken,
25183 Sam Falkner,
25184 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25185 Sigbjorn Finne,
25186 Sven Fischer,
25187 Paul Fisher,
25188 Decklin Foster,
25189 Gary D. Foster,
25190 Paul Franklin,
25191 Guy Geens,
25192 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25193 David S. Goldberg,
25194 Michelangelo Grigni,
25195 Dale Hagglund,
25196 D. Hall,
25197 Magnus Hammerin,
25198 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25199 Raja R. Harinath,
25200 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25201 P. E. Jareth Hein,
25202 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25203 Scott Hofmann,
25204 Marc Horowitz,
25205 Gunnar Horrigmo,
25206 Richard Hoskins,
25207 Brad Howes,
25208 Miguel de Icaza,
25209 François Felix Ingrand,
25210 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25211 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25212 Lee Iverson,
25213 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25214 Rajappa Iyer,
25215 Andreas Jaeger,
25216 Adam P. Jenkins,
25217 Randell Jesup,
25218 Fred Johansen,
25219 Gareth Jones,
25220 Greg Klanderman,
25221 Karl Kleinpaste,
25222 Michael Klingbeil,
25223 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25224 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25225 Petr Konecny,
25226 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25227 Thor Kristoffersen,
25228 Jens Lautenbacher,
25229 Martin Larose,
25230 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25231 Joerg Lenneis,
25232 Carsten Leonhardt,
25233 James LewisMoss,
25234 Christian Limpach,
25235 Markus Linnala,
25236 Dave Love,
25237 Mike McEwan,
25238 Tonny Madsen,
25239 Shlomo Mahlab,
25240 Nat Makarevitch,
25241 Istvan Marko,
25242 David Martin,
25243 Jason R. Mastaler,
25244 Gordon Matzigkeit,
25245 Timo Metzemakers,
25246 Richard Mlynarik,
25247 Lantz Moore,
25248 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25249 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25250 Hrvoje Niksic,
25251 Andy Norman,
25252 Fred Oberhauser,
25253 C. R. Oldham,
25254 Alexandre Oliva,
25255 Ken Olstad,
25256 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25257 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25258 Ettore Perazzoli,
25259 William Perry,
25260 Stephen Peters,
25261 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25262 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25263 Matt Pharr,
25264 Andy Piper,
25265 John McClary Prevost,
25266 Bill Pringlemeir,
25267 Mike Pullen,
25268 Jim Radford,
25269 Colin Rafferty,
25270 Lasse Rasinen,
25271 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25272 Joe Reiss,
25273 Renaud Rioboo,
25274 Roland B. Roberts,
25275 Bart Robinson,
25276 Christian von Roques,
25277 Markus Rost,
25278 Jason Rumney,
25279 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25280 Jay Sachs,
25281 Dewey M. Sasser,
25282 Conrad Sauerwald,
25283 Loren Schall,
25284 Dan Schmidt,
25285 Ralph Schleicher,
25286 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25287 Andreas Schwab,
25288 Randal L. Schwartz,
25289 Danny Siu,
25290 Matt Simmons,
25291 Paul D. Smith,
25292 Jeff Sparkes,
25293 Toby Speight,
25294 Michael Sperber,
25295 Darren Stalder,
25296 Richard Stallman,
25297 Greg Stark,
25298 Sam Steingold,
25299 Paul Stevenson,
25300 Jonas Steverud,
25301 Paul Stodghill,
25302 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25303 Kurt Swanson,
25304 Samuel Tardieu,
25305 Teddy,
25306 Chuck Thompson,
25307 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25308 Philippe Troin,
25309 James Troup,
25310 Trung Tran-Duc,
25311 Jack Twilley,
25312 Aaron M. Ucko,
25313 Aki Vehtari,
25314 Didier Verna,
25315 Vladimir Volovich,
25316 Jan Vroonhof,
25317 Stefan Waldherr,
25318 Pete Ware,
25319 Barry A. Warsaw,
25320 Christoph Wedler,
25321 Joe Wells,
25322 Lee Willis,
25323 and
25324 Lloyd Zusman.
25325
25326
25327 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25328 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25329 (550kB and counting).
25330
25331 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25332 sure.
25333
25334 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25335 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25336
25337
25338 @node New Features
25339 @subsection New Features
25340 @cindex new features
25341
25342 @menu
25343 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25344 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25345 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25346 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25347 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25348 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25349 @end menu
25350
25351 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25352 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25353 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25354
25355 @node ding Gnus
25356 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25357
25358 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25359
25360 @itemize @bullet
25361
25362 @item
25363 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25364 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25365
25366 @item
25367 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25368 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25369
25370 @item
25371 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25372
25373 @item
25374 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25375 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25376 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25377
25378 @item
25379 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25380 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25381 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25382 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25383
25384 @item
25385 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25386 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25387
25388 @item
25389 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25390 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25391 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25392
25393 @item
25394 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25395 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25396
25397 @item
25398 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25399 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25400 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25401
25402 @item
25403 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25404 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25405 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25406
25407 @item
25408 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25409 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25410
25411 @item
25412 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25413 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25414
25415 @item
25416 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25417 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25418
25419 @item
25420 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25421 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25422
25423 @item
25424 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25425 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25426
25427 @item
25428 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25429 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25430
25431 @item
25432 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25433
25434 @item
25435 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25436 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25437
25438 @item
25439 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25440 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25441
25442 @item
25443 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25444 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25445
25446 @item
25447 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25448
25449 @item
25450 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25451 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25452
25453 @item
25454 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25455 Articles}).
25456
25457 @item
25458 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25459 Buttons}).
25460
25461 @item
25462 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25463 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25464
25465 @item
25466 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25467 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25468
25469 @end itemize
25470
25471
25472 @node September Gnus
25473 @subsubsection September Gnus
25474
25475 @iftex
25476 @iflatex
25477 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25478 @end iflatex
25479 @end iftex
25480
25481 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25482
25483 @itemize @bullet
25484
25485 @item
25486 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25487 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25488 now obsolete.
25489
25490 @item
25491 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25492 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25493 Threading}).
25494
25495 @lisp
25496 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25497 @end lisp
25498
25499 @item
25500 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25501 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25502
25503 @item
25504 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25505 referred.
25506
25507 @item
25508 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25509
25510 @item
25511 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25512
25513 @item
25514 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25515
25516 @lisp
25517 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25518 @end lisp
25519
25520 @item
25521 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25522 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25523
25524 @lisp
25525 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25526 @end lisp
25527
25528 @item
25529 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25530 Groups}).
25531
25532 @item
25533 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25534 Topics}).
25535
25536 @lisp
25537 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25538 @end lisp
25539
25540 @item
25541 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25542
25543 @item
25544 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25545 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25546
25547 @lisp
25548 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25549 @end lisp
25550
25551 @item
25552 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25553 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25554
25555 @item
25556 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25557
25558 @item
25559 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25560 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25561 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25562
25563 @item
25564 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25565 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25566
25567 @item
25568 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25569
25570 @item
25571 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25572 Groups}).
25573
25574 @item
25575 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25576 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25577
25578 @item
25579 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25580 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25581
25582 @item
25583 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25584 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25585
25586 @item
25587 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25588 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25589 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25590
25591 @item
25592 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25593 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25594
25595 @item
25596 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25597
25598 @item
25599 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25600
25601 @item
25602 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25603
25604 @item
25605 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25606
25607 @item
25608 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25609 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25610
25611 @item
25612 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25613 Layout}).
25614
25615 @item
25616 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25617 @iftex
25618 @iflatex
25619 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25620 @end iflatex
25621 @end iftex
25622
25623 @item
25624 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25625
25626 @lisp
25627 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25628 @end lisp
25629
25630 @item
25631 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25632
25633 @lisp
25634 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25635 @end lisp
25636
25637 @item
25638 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25639
25640 @item
25641 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25642
25643 @item
25644 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25645 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25646
25647 @lisp
25648 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25649 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25650 @end lisp
25651
25652 @item
25653 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25654 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25655
25656 @lisp
25657 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25658 @end lisp
25659
25660 @item
25661 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25662 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25663
25664 @item
25665 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25666
25667 @item
25668 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25669 Articles}).
25670
25671 @lisp
25672 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25673 @end lisp
25674
25675 @item
25676 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25677 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25678
25679 @lisp
25680 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25681 @end lisp
25682
25683 @item
25684 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25685 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25686
25687 @item
25688 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25689 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25690
25691 @lisp
25692 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25693 @end lisp
25694
25695 @item
25696 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25697
25698 @item
25699 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25700
25701 @item
25702 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25703
25704 @end itemize
25705
25706
25707 @node Red Gnus
25708 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25709
25710 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25711
25712 @iftex
25713 @iflatex
25714 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25715 @end iflatex
25716 @end iftex
25717
25718 @itemize @bullet
25719
25720 @item
25721 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25722
25723 @item
25724 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25725 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25726
25727 @item
25728 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25729 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25730 Scoring}).
25731
25732 @item
25733 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25734 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25735
25736 @item
25737 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25738
25739 @item
25740 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25741 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25742
25743 @lisp
25744 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25745 @end lisp
25746
25747 @item
25748 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25749 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25750 been added.
25751
25752 @item
25753 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25754 Server Internals}).
25755
25756 @item
25757 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25758 Parameters}).
25759
25760 @item
25761 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25762
25763 @item
25764 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25765 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25766
25767 @item
25768 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25769 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25770 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25771
25772 @item
25773 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25774 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25775
25776 @item
25777 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25778 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25779
25780 @item
25781 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25782 (@pxref{Undo}).
25783
25784 @item
25785 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25786 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25787
25788 @item
25789 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25790 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25791
25792 @lisp
25793 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25794 @end lisp
25795
25796 @item
25797 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25798
25799 @lisp
25800 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25801 @end lisp
25802
25803 @item
25804 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25805 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25806
25807 @item
25808 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25809 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25810
25811 @item
25812 A new command for reading collections of documents
25813 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25814 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25815
25816 @item
25817 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25818 Marks}).
25819
25820 @item
25821 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25822 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25823
25824 @item
25825 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25826 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25827 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25828
25829 @item
25830 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25831 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25832 Sorting}).
25833
25834 @item
25835 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25836 Groups}).
25837
25838 @item
25839 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25840 Commands}).
25841 @iftex
25842 @iflatex
25843 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25844 @end iflatex
25845 @end iftex
25846
25847 @item
25848 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25849 Variables}).
25850
25851 @item
25852 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25853 Mail}).
25854
25855 @item
25856 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25857 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25858
25859 @item
25860 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25861
25862 @end itemize
25863
25864
25865 @node Quassia Gnus
25866 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25867
25868 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25869
25870 @itemize @bullet
25871
25872 @item
25873 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25874 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25875 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25876
25877 @item
25878 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25879 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25880 group, which is created automatically.
25881
25882 @item
25883 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25884 values.
25885
25886 @item
25887 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25888
25889 @item
25890 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25891 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25892
25893 @item
25894 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25895 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
25896
25897 @item
25898 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25899
25900 @item
25901 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25902 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25903
25904 @item
25905 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25906
25907 @item
25908 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25909 details.
25910
25911 @item
25912 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25913 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25914
25915 @item
25916 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25917 control over simplification.
25918
25919 @item
25920 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25921
25922 @item
25923 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25924 limit.
25925
25926 @item
25927 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25928
25929 @item
25930 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25931
25932 @item
25933 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25934 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25935 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25936
25937 @item
25938 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25939 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25940
25941 @item
25942 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25943 text---@kbd{W d}.
25944
25945 @item
25946 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25947 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25948
25949 @item
25950 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25951 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25952
25953 @item
25954 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25955 has been added.
25956
25957 @item
25958 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25959
25960 @item
25961 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25962
25963 @item
25964 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25965 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25966
25967 @item
25968 A new function for citing in Message has been
25969 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25970
25971 @item
25972 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25973
25974 @item
25975 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25976 been added.
25977
25978 @item
25979 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25980 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25981
25982 @item
25983 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25984 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25985
25986 @item
25987 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25988
25989 @item
25990 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25991
25992 @end itemize
25993
25994 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25995 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25996
25997 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25998
25999 @itemize @bullet
26000
26001 @item
26002 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
26003 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
26004
26005 If you used procmail like in
26006
26007 @lisp
26008 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
26009 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
26010 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
26011 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
26012 @end lisp
26013
26014 this now has changed to
26015
26016 @lisp
26017 (setq mail-sources
26018 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
26019 :suffix ".in")))
26020 @end lisp
26021
26022 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
26023
26024 @item
26025 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
26026 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
26027
26028 @item
26029 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
26030 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
26031
26032 @item
26033 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
26034 called to position point.
26035
26036 @item
26037 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
26038 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
26039
26040 @item
26041 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
26042 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
26043
26044 @item
26045 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
26046 subtly different manner.
26047
26048 @item
26049 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
26050 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
26051 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
26052
26053 @item
26054 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
26055
26056 @end itemize
26057
26058 @node Oort Gnus
26059 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
26060 @cindex Oort Gnus
26061
26062 New features in Gnus 5.10:
26063
26064 @itemize @bullet
26065
26066 @item Installation changes
26067 @c ***********************
26068
26069 @itemize @bullet
26070 @item
26071 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
26072
26073 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
26074 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
26075 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
26076 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
26077 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
26078 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
26079 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
26080 isn't save in general.
26081
26082 @item
26083 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
26084 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
26085 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
26086 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
26087 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
26088 remove-installed-shadows}.
26089
26090 @item
26091 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26092
26093 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26094 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26095 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
26096 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26097 the second parameter.
26098
26099 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26100 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26101 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26102 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26103 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26104 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26105 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26106 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26107 cycle used under Unix systems.
26108
26109 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
26110 superfluous, so they have been removed.
26111
26112 @item
26113 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26114
26115 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26116 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26117 hierarchy.
26118
26119 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
26120 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
26121 @item
26122 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26123
26124 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26125 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26126 lisp directory into load-path.
26127
26128 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26129 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26130
26131 @end itemize
26132
26133 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
26134 @c *****************************************
26135
26136 @itemize @bullet
26137
26138 @item
26139 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
26140 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
26141
26142 @item
26143 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26144
26145 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26146 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26147 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26148 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26149
26150 @item
26151 Improved anti-spam features.
26152
26153 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26154 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26155 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26156 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26157 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26158 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
26159
26160 @item
26161 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26162
26163 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26164 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26165 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26166 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26167 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26168
26169 @end itemize
26170
26171 @item Changes in group mode
26172 @c ************************
26173
26174 @itemize @bullet
26175
26176 @item
26177 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
26178 using @kbd{G M}.
26179
26180 @item
26181 Retrieval of charters and control messages
26182
26183 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
26184 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
26185
26186 @item
26187 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26188
26189 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26190 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26191 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26192 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26193 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26194 parameters, a'la:
26195 @lisp
26196 (setq gnus-parameters
26197 '(("mail\\..*"
26198 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26199 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26200 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26201 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26202 @end lisp
26203
26204 @item
26205 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26206
26207 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26208 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26209 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26210 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26211 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26212 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26213 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26214 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26215 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26216
26217 @item
26218 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26219
26220 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26221 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26222 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26223
26224 @item
26225 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26226 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26227
26228 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26229 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26230 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26231 @lisp
26232 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26233 @end lisp
26234
26235 @end itemize
26236
26237 @item Changes in summary and article mode
26238 @c **************************************
26239
26240 @itemize @bullet
26241
26242 @item
26243 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
26244 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
26245 region if the region is active.
26246
26247 @item
26248 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
26249 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
26250
26251 @item
26252 Article Buttons
26253
26254 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
26255 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
26256 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
26257 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
26258
26259 @item
26260 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
26261
26262 @item
26263 Picons
26264
26265 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
26266 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
26267
26268 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
26269 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
26270 @xref{Picons}.
26271
26272 @item
26273 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
26274 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
26275
26276 @item
26277 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
26278
26279 @item
26280 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
26281 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
26282
26283 @item
26284 Warn about email replies to news
26285
26286 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
26287 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
26288 you.
26289
26290 @item
26291 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
26292 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
26293 built.
26294
26295 @item
26296 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
26297 opposed to old but unread messages).
26298
26299 @item
26300 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26301 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26302
26303 @item
26304 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26305 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26306
26307 @item
26308 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26309 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26310
26311 @item
26312 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26313
26314 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26315 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26316 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26317 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26318 citations.
26319
26320 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
26321 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
26322 Outlook (Express) articles.
26323
26324 @item
26325 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26326
26327 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26328 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26329 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26330 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26331
26332 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26333 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26334 message cited below.
26335
26336 @item
26337 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
26338 Emacs too.
26339
26340 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26341 disable it.
26342
26343 @item
26344 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
26345
26346 @item
26347 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26348 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26349
26350 @item
26351 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26352
26353 @item
26354 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26355
26356 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26357 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26358 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26359 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26360 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26361 groups.
26362
26363 @item
26364 Deleting of attachments.
26365
26366 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26367 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26368 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26369 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26370 that support editing.
26371
26372 @item
26373 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26374
26375 The default value is determined from the
26376 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26377 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26378 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26379
26380 @item
26381 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26382
26383 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26384 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26385 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26386
26387 @item
26388 Extended format specs.
26389
26390 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26391 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26392 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26393 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26394 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26395 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26396
26397 @item
26398 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26399 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
26400
26401 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26402 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26403 out other articles.
26404
26405 @item
26406 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26407
26408 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26409 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26410 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26411 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26412
26413 @item
26414 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26415
26416 @end itemize
26417
26418 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
26419 @c ****************************************************
26420
26421 @itemize @bullet
26422
26423 @item
26424 Delayed articles
26425
26426 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
26427 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
26428 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
26429
26430 @item
26431 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
26432 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
26433
26434 @item
26435 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
26436 Gcc articles as read.
26437
26438 @item
26439 Externalizing of attachments
26440
26441 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26442 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26443 local files as external parts.
26444
26445 @item
26446 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
26447 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
26448
26449 @item
26450 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26451
26452 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26453 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26454 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26455 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26456 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26457 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26458 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26459 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26460 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26461
26462 @item
26463 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26464
26465 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26466 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26467 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26468 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26469 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26470 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26471
26472 @item
26473 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
26474 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26475 @code{nil}.
26476
26477 @item
26478 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
26479
26480 @item
26481 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26482
26483 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26484 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26485 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26486 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26487 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26488 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26489 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26490 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26491 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26492 was inserted directly.
26493
26494 @item
26495 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26496
26497 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26498 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26499 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26500 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26501
26502 @item
26503 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26504
26505 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26506 @lisp
26507 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26508 'bbdb-complete-name)
26509 @end lisp
26510
26511 @item
26512 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26513
26514 Add a new format of match like
26515 @lisp
26516 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26517 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26518 @end lisp
26519 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26520 @lisp
26521 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26522 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26523 @end lisp
26524
26525 @item
26526 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26527
26528 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26529 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26530 need add those two headers too.
26531
26532 @item
26533 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26534 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26535 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26536 versions.
26537
26538 @item
26539 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
26540 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
26541 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
26542 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
26543 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
26544
26545 @item
26546 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26547
26548 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26549
26550 @item
26551 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26552
26553 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26554 the valid values.
26555
26556 @item
26557 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26558
26559 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26560 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26561 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26562 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26563 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26564 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26565 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26566 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26567
26568 @item
26569 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26570 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26571
26572 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26573 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26574 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26575 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26576
26577 @item
26578 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26579 C-m}.
26580
26581 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26582 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26583
26584 @item
26585 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
26586 @code{best}.
26587
26588 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26589 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26590 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26591 invalidate the digital signature.
26592
26593 @item
26594 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
26595 decompressed when activated.
26596 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
26597
26598 @item
26599 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
26600
26601 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
26602 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
26603 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
26604 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
26605 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
26606 controls this.
26607
26608 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
26609 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
26610 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
26611 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11
26612
26613 @end itemize
26614
26615 @item Changes in back ends
26616 @c ***********************
26617
26618 @itemize @bullet
26619 @item
26620 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
26621
26622 @item
26623 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
26624
26625 @item
26626 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26627
26628 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26629
26630 @item
26631 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26632
26633 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26634 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26635 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26636 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26637 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26638 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26639 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26640 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26641 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26642 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26643 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26644
26645 @end itemize
26646
26647 @item Appearance
26648 @c *************
26649
26650 @itemize @bullet
26651
26652 @item
26653 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26654 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26655
26656 @item
26657 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26658 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26659 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26660 message, Message Manual}).
26661
26662 @item
26663 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
26664 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars. This is a new
26665 feature in Gnus 5.10.9. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
26666
26667 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
26668 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
26669 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
26670 in Gnus 5.10.9.
26671 @end itemize
26672
26673
26674 @item Miscellaneous changes
26675 @c ************************
26676
26677 @itemize @bullet
26678
26679 @item
26680 @code{gnus-agent}
26681
26682 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26683 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26684 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26685 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26686 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26687 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26688 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26689 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26690 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26691 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26692 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26693 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26694 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26695 is not needed any more.
26696
26697 @item
26698 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26699
26700 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26701 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26702 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26703
26704 @item
26705 Dired integration
26706
26707 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
26708 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
26709 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
26710 entry.
26711
26712 @item
26713 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
26714
26715 @item
26716 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26717
26718 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26719
26720 @end itemize
26721
26722 @end itemize
26723
26724 @iftex
26725
26726 @page
26727 @node The Manual
26728 @section The Manual
26729 @cindex colophon
26730 @cindex manual
26731
26732 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26733 either @code{texi2dvi}
26734 @iflatex
26735 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26736 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26737 @end iflatex
26738 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26739
26740 The following conventions have been used:
26741
26742 @enumerate
26743
26744 @item
26745 This is a @samp{string}
26746
26747 @item
26748 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26749
26750 @item
26751 This is a @file{file}
26752
26753 @item
26754 This is a @code{symbol}
26755
26756 @end enumerate
26757
26758 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26759 mean:
26760
26761 @lisp
26762 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26763 @end lisp
26764
26765 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26766
26767 @lisp
26768 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26769 @end lisp
26770
26771 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26772 ever get them confused.
26773
26774 @iflatex
26775 @c @head
26776 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26777 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26778 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26779 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26780 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26781 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26782 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26783 @end iflatex
26784
26785 @end iftex
26786
26787
26788 @node On Writing Manuals
26789 @section On Writing Manuals
26790
26791 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26792 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26793 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26794 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26795 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26796 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26797 hand in hand.
26798
26799 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26800 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26801 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26802 started with Gnus.
26803
26804 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26805 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26806
26807
26808 @page
26809 @node Terminology
26810 @section Terminology
26811
26812 @cindex terminology
26813 @table @dfn
26814
26815 @item news
26816 @cindex news
26817 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26818 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26819 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26820 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26821 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26822
26823 @item mail
26824 @cindex mail
26825 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26826 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26827 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26828 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26829
26830 @item reply
26831 @cindex reply
26832 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26833
26834 @item follow up
26835 @cindex follow up
26836 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26837 are reading.
26838
26839 @item back end
26840 @cindex back end
26841 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26842 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26843 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26844 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26845 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26846 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26847 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26848 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26849 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26850 number 4711''.
26851
26852 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26853 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26854 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26855 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26856 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26857 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26858
26859 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26860 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26861 access the articles.
26862
26863 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26864 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26865 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26866 confusing.
26867
26868 @item native
26869 @cindex native
26870 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26871 default, way of getting news.
26872
26873 @item foreign
26874 @cindex foreign
26875 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26876 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26877 news.
26878
26879 @item secondary
26880 @cindex secondary
26881 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26882 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26883
26884 @item article
26885 @cindex article
26886 A message that has been posted as news.
26887
26888 @item mail message
26889 @cindex mail message
26890 A message that has been mailed.
26891
26892 @item message
26893 @cindex message
26894 A mail message or news article
26895
26896 @item head
26897 @cindex head
26898 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26899 put.
26900
26901 @item body
26902 @cindex body
26903 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26904 body.
26905
26906 @item header
26907 @cindex header
26908 A line from the head of an article.
26909
26910 @item headers
26911 @cindex headers
26912 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26913 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26914
26915 @item @acronym{NOV}
26916 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26917 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26918 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26919 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26920 normal @sc{head} format.
26921
26922 @item level
26923 @cindex levels
26924 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26925 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26926 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26927 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26928 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26929 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26930
26931 @item killed groups
26932 @cindex killed groups
26933 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26934 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26935
26936 @item zombie groups
26937 @cindex zombie groups
26938 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26939
26940 @item active file
26941 @cindex active file
26942 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26943 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26944 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26945
26946 @item bogus groups
26947 @cindex bogus groups
26948 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26949 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26950 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26951
26952 @item activating
26953 @cindex activating groups
26954 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26955 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26956 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26957
26958 @item spool
26959 @cindex spool
26960 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
26961 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
26962 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
26963
26964 @item server
26965 @cindex server
26966 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26967
26968 @item select method
26969 @cindex select method
26970 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26971 server settings.
26972
26973 @item virtual server
26974 @cindex virtual server
26975 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26976 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26977 whole is a virtual server.
26978
26979 @item washing
26980 @cindex washing
26981 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26982 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26983 original.
26984
26985 @item ephemeral groups
26986 @cindex ephemeral groups
26987 @cindex temporary groups
26988 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26989 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26990 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26991
26992 @item solid groups
26993 @cindex solid groups
26994 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26995 group buffer are solid groups.
26996
26997 @item sparse articles
26998 @cindex sparse articles
26999 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
27000 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
27001
27002 @item threading
27003 @cindex threading
27004 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
27005 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
27006
27007 @item root
27008 @cindex root
27009 @cindex thread root
27010 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
27011 articles in the thread.
27012
27013 @item parent
27014 @cindex parent
27015 An article that has responses.
27016
27017 @item child
27018 @cindex child
27019 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
27020
27021 @item digest
27022 @cindex digest
27023 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
27024 specified by RFC 1153.
27025
27026 @item splitting
27027 @cindex splitting, terminology
27028 @cindex mail sorting
27029 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
27030 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
27031 incorrectly called mail filtering.
27032
27033 @end table
27034
27035
27036 @page
27037 @node Customization
27038 @section Customization
27039 @cindex general customization
27040
27041 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
27042 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
27043 for some quite common situations.
27044
27045 @menu
27046 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
27047 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
27048 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
27049 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
27050 @end menu
27051
27052
27053 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
27054 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
27055
27056 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
27057 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
27058 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
27059
27060 @table @code
27061
27062 @item gnus-read-active-file
27063 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
27064 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
27065 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27066 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
27067 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
27068
27069 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
27070 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
27071 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
27072 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
27073 @end table
27074
27075
27076 @node Slow Terminal Connection
27077 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
27078
27079 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
27080 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
27081 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
27082
27083 @table @code
27084
27085 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
27086 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
27087 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
27088 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
27089 horizontal and vertical recentering.
27090
27091 @item gnus-visible-headers
27092 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
27093 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
27094 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
27095 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
27096
27097 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
27098 @lisp
27099 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
27100 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
27101 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
27102 @end lisp
27103
27104 @item gnus-use-full-window
27105 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
27106 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
27107 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
27108 want to read them anyway.
27109
27110 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
27111 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
27112 hidden initially.
27113
27114
27115 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
27116 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
27117 lines, which might save some time.
27118 @end table
27119
27120
27121 @node Little Disk Space
27122 @subsection Little Disk Space
27123 @cindex disk space
27124
27125 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
27126 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
27127
27128 @table @code
27129
27130 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
27131 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
27132 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27133 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27134 default.
27135
27136 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
27137 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
27138 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27139 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27140 default.
27141
27142 @item gnus-save-killed-list
27143 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
27144 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
27145 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
27146 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
27147
27148 @end table
27149
27150
27151 @node Slow Machine
27152 @subsection Slow Machine
27153 @cindex slow machine
27154
27155 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
27156 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
27157
27158 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27159 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
27160
27161 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
27162 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
27163 summary buffer faster.
27164
27165
27166 @page
27167 @node Troubleshooting
27168 @section Troubleshooting
27169 @cindex troubleshooting
27170
27171 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
27172 problems, really.
27173
27174 Ahem.
27175
27176 @enumerate
27177
27178 @item
27179 Make sure your computer is switched on.
27180
27181 @item
27182 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
27183 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
27184 Gnus will work.
27185
27186 @item
27187 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
27188 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
27189 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
27190
27191 @item
27192 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
27193 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
27194
27195 @item
27196 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
27197 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
27198 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
27199 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
27200 something like that.
27201 @end enumerate
27202
27203 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
27204
27205 @cindex bugs
27206 @cindex reporting bugs
27207
27208 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
27209 @findex gnus-bug
27210 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
27211 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
27212 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
27213 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
27214
27215 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
27216 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
27217 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
27218 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
27219 time.
27220
27221 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
27222 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
27223 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
27224 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
27225 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
27226 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
27227
27228 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
27229 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
27230 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
27231 the bug report.
27232
27233 @cindex patches
27234 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
27235 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
27236
27237 @cindex edebug
27238 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
27239 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
27240 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
27241 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
27242 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
27243 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
27244 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
27245 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
27246 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
27247 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
27248 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
27249 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
27250 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
27251 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
27252
27253 @cindex elp
27254 @cindex profile
27255 @cindex slow
27256 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
27257 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
27258 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
27259 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
27260 helps isolating the real problem areas).
27261
27262 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
27263 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
27264 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
27265 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
27266 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
27267 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27268 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27269 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27270 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27271 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27272 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27273 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27274 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27275 work perfectly.
27276
27277 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27278 @cindex ding mailing list
27279 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27280 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27281 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27282 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27283
27284
27285 @page
27286 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27287 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27288
27289 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27290 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27291 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27292 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27293 it.
27294
27295 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27296 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27297 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27298 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27299 and general methods of operation.
27300
27301 @menu
27302 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27303 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27304 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27305 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27306 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27307 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27308 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27309 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27310 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27311 @end menu
27312
27313
27314 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27315 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27316 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27317 @cindex utility functions
27318 @cindex functions
27319 @cindex internal variables
27320
27321 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27322 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27323 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27324
27325 @table @code
27326
27327 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27328 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27329 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27330
27331 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27332 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27333 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27334
27335 @item gnus-group-real-name
27336 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27337 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27338 name.
27339
27340 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27341 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27342 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27343 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27344
27345 @item gnus-get-info
27346 @findex gnus-get-info
27347 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27348
27349 @item gnus-group-unread
27350 @findex gnus-group-unread
27351 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27352 unknown.
27353
27354 @item gnus-active
27355 @findex gnus-active
27356 The active entry for @var{group}.
27357
27358 @item gnus-set-active
27359 @findex gnus-set-active
27360 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27361
27362 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27363 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27364 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27365 exit.
27366
27367 @item gnus-continuum-version
27368 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27369 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27370 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27371 versions.
27372
27373 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27374 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27375 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27376
27377 @item gnus-news-group-p
27378 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27379 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27380
27381 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27382 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27383 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27384
27385 @item gnus-server-to-method
27386 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27387 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27388
27389 @item gnus-server-equal
27390 @findex gnus-server-equal
27391 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27392
27393 @item gnus-group-native-p
27394 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27395 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27396
27397 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27398 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27399 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27400
27401 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27402 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27403 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27404
27405 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27406 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27407 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27408 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27409
27410 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27411 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27412 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27413
27414 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27415 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27416 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27417
27418 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27419 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27420 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27421 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27422
27423 @lisp
27424 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27425 @result{} t
27426 @end lisp
27427
27428 @item gnus-read-method
27429 @findex gnus-read-method
27430 Prompts the user for a select method.
27431
27432 @end table
27433
27434
27435 @node Back End Interface
27436 @subsection Back End Interface
27437
27438 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27439 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27440 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27441 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27442 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27443 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27444
27445 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27446 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27447 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27448 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27449 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27450 been opened, the function should fail.
27451
27452 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27453 name. Take this example:
27454
27455 @lisp
27456 (nntp "odd-one"
27457 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27458 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27459 @end lisp
27460
27461 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27462 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27463
27464 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27465 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27466 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27467
27468 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27469 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27470 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27471
27472 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27473 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27474 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27475 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27476 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27477 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27478 return value.
27479
27480 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27481 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27482 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27483 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27484 more.
27485
27486 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27487 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27488 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27489 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27490 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27491 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27492 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27493 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27494 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27495 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27496
27497 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27498 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27499 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27500 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27501 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27502 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27503 of numbers as long as possible.
27504
27505 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27506 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27507 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27508
27509 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27510 @code{nnchoke}.
27511
27512 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27513
27514 @menu
27515 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27516 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27517 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27518 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27519 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27520 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27521 @end menu
27522
27523
27524 @node Required Back End Functions
27525 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27526
27527 @table @code
27528
27529 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27530
27531 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27532 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27533 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27534 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27535
27536 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27537 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27538 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27539 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27540
27541 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27542 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27543 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27544 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27545 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27546 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27547 number, do maximum fetches.
27548
27549 Here's an example HEAD:
27550
27551 @example
27552 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27553 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27554 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27555 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27556 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27557 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27558 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27559 Lines: 26
27560 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27561 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27562 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27563 .
27564 @end example
27565
27566 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27567 these in the data buffer.
27568
27569 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27570
27571 @example
27572 headers = *head
27573 head = error / valid-head
27574 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27575 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27576 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27577 header = <text> eol
27578 @end example
27579
27580 @cindex BNF
27581 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27582
27583 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27584 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27585 separated by tabs.
27586
27587 @example
27588 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27589 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27590 field = <text except TAB>
27591 @end example
27592
27593 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27594 @pxref{Headers}.
27595
27596
27597 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27598
27599 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27600 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27601
27602 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27603 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27604 server. In fact, it should do so.
27605
27606 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27607 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27608
27609
27610 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27611
27612 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27613 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27614 reason.
27615
27616 There should be no data returned.
27617
27618
27619 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27620
27621 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27622 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27623 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27624 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27625
27626 There should be no data returned.
27627
27628
27629 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27630
27631 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27632 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27633 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27634 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27635
27636 There should be no data returned.
27637
27638
27639 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27640
27641 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27642
27643 There should be no data returned.
27644
27645
27646 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27647
27648 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27649 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27650 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27651 it would be nice if that were possible.
27652
27653 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27654 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27655 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27656 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27657 into its article buffer.
27658
27659 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27660 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27661 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27662 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27663 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27664 on successful article retrieval.
27665
27666
27667 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27668
27669 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27670 making @var{group} the current group.
27671
27672 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27673 the current group.
27674
27675 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27676
27677 @example
27678 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27679 @end example
27680
27681 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27682 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27683 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27684 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27685 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27686 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27687 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27688 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27689 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27690 highest as 0.
27691
27692 @example
27693 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27694 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27695 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27696 @end example
27697
27698
27699 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27700
27701 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27702 a no-op on most back ends.
27703
27704 There should be no data returned.
27705
27706
27707 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27708
27709 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27710 @emph{all}.
27711
27712 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27713
27714 @example
27715 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27716 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27717 @end example
27718
27719 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27720 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27721 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27722 and the highest as 0.
27723
27724 @example
27725 active-file = *active-line
27726 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27727 name = <string>
27728 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27729 @end example
27730
27731 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27732 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27733 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27734
27735
27736 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27737
27738 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27739 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27740 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27741 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27742 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27743 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27744
27745 There should be no result data from this function.
27746
27747 @end table
27748
27749
27750 @node Optional Back End Functions
27751 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27752
27753 @table @code
27754
27755 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27756
27757 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27758 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27759 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27760
27761 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27762 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27763 former is in the same format as the data from
27764 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27765 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27766
27767 @example
27768 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27769 @end example
27770
27771
27772 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27773
27774 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27775 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27776 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27777 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27778 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27779
27780 There should be no result data from this function.
27781
27782
27783 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27784
27785 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27786 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27787 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27788 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27789 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27790 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27791 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27792 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27793
27794 There should be no result data from this function.
27795
27796
27797 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27798
27799 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27800 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27801 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27802 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27803 propagate the mark information to the server.
27804
27805 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27806
27807 @example
27808 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27809 @end example
27810
27811 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27812 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27813 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27814 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27815 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27816 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27817 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27818 possible, not limit itself to these.
27819
27820 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27821 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27822 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27823 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27824
27825 An example action list:
27826
27827 @example
27828 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27829 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27830 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27831 @end example
27832
27833 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27834 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27835
27836 There should be no result data from this function.
27837
27838 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27839
27840 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27841 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27842 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27843 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27844 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27845
27846 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27847 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27848 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27849 expirable.
27850
27851 There should be no result data from this function.
27852
27853
27854 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27855
27856 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27857 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27858 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27859 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27860 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27861 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27862 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27863 local if that's practical.
27864
27865 There should be no result data from this function.
27866
27867
27868 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27869
27870 The result data from this function should be a description of
27871 @var{group}.
27872
27873 @example
27874 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27875 name = <string>
27876 description = <text>
27877 @end example
27878
27879 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27880
27881 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27882 groups available on the server.
27883
27884 @example
27885 description-buffer = *description-line
27886 @end example
27887
27888
27889 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27890
27891 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27892 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27893 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27894 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27895 in the active buffer format.
27896
27897 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27898 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27899 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27900 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27901 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27902 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27903 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27904
27905
27906 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27907
27908 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27909
27910 There should be no return data.
27911
27912
27913 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27914
27915 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27916 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27917 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27918 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27919 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27920 they are.
27921
27922 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27923 able to delete.
27924
27925 There should be no result data returned.
27926
27927
27928 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27929
27930 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27931 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27932
27933 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27934 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27935 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27936 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27937 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27938 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27939
27940 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27941 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27942 optimizations.
27943
27944 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27945 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27946
27947 There should be no data returned.
27948
27949
27950 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27951
27952 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27953 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27954 this function in short order.
27955
27956 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27957 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27958
27959 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27960 article for that group.
27961
27962 There should be no data returned.
27963
27964
27965 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27966
27967 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27968 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27969
27970 There should be no data returned.
27971
27972
27973 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27974
27975 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27976 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27977 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27978
27979 There should be no data returned.
27980
27981
27982 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27983
27984 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27985 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27986
27987 There should be no data returned.
27988
27989 @end table
27990
27991
27992 @node Error Messaging
27993 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27994
27995 @findex nnheader-report
27996 @findex nnheader-get-report
27997 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27998 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27999 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
28000 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
28001 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
28002 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
28003
28004 @lisp
28005 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
28006
28007 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
28008 @end lisp
28009
28010 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
28011 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
28012 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
28013 takes one argument---the server symbol.
28014
28015 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
28016 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
28017 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
28018
28019
28020 @node Writing New Back Ends
28021 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
28022
28023 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
28024 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
28025 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
28026 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
28027 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
28028 editing articles.
28029
28030 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
28031 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
28032 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
28033
28034 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
28035 package called @code{nnoo}.
28036
28037 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
28038 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
28039 following macros:
28040
28041 @table @code
28042
28043 @item nnoo-declare
28044 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
28045 parameters. For instance:
28046
28047 @lisp
28048 (nnoo-declare nndir
28049 nnml nnmh)
28050 @end lisp
28051
28052 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
28053 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
28054
28055 @item defvoo
28056 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
28057 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
28058 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
28059
28060 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
28061 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
28062 a function in those back ends.
28063
28064 @lisp
28065 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28066 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28067 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28068 @end lisp
28069
28070 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
28071 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
28072 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
28073
28074 @item nnoo-define-basics
28075 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
28076 have.
28077
28078 @lisp
28079 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28080 @end lisp
28081
28082 @item deffoo
28083 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
28084 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
28085 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
28086
28087 @item nnoo-map-functions
28088 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
28089 functions from the parent back ends.
28090
28091 @lisp
28092 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28093 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28094 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
28095 @end lisp
28096
28097 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
28098 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
28099 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
28100 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
28101
28102 @item nnoo-import
28103 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
28104 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
28105 haven't already been defined.
28106
28107 @lisp
28108 (nnoo-import nndir
28109 (nnmh
28110 nnmh-request-list
28111 nnmh-request-newgroups)
28112 (nnml))
28113 @end lisp
28114
28115 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
28116 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
28117 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
28118 defined now.
28119
28120 @end table
28121
28122 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
28123
28124 @lisp
28125 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
28126 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
28127
28128 ;;; @r{Code:}
28129
28130 (require 'nnheader)
28131 (require 'nnmh)
28132 (require 'nnml)
28133 (require 'nnoo)
28134 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
28135
28136 (nnoo-declare nndir
28137 nnml nnmh)
28138
28139 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28140 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28141 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28142
28143 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
28144 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
28145 nnml-nov-is-evil)
28146
28147 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
28148 nil
28149 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
28150 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
28151 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
28152
28153 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
28154 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
28155
28156 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
28157
28158 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28159
28160 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
28161 (setq nndir-directory
28162 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
28163 server))
28164 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
28165 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
28166 (push `(nndir-current-group
28167 ,(file-name-nondirectory
28168 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28169 defs)
28170 (push `(nndir-top-directory
28171 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28172 defs)
28173 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
28174
28175 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28176 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28177 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28178 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
28179 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
28180
28181 (nnoo-import nndir
28182 (nnmh
28183 nnmh-status-message
28184 nnmh-request-list
28185 nnmh-request-newgroups))
28186
28187 (provide 'nndir)
28188 @end lisp
28189
28190
28191 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28192 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28193
28194 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
28195 @findex gnus-declare-backend
28196 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
28197 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
28198 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
28199
28200 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
28201 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
28202
28203 Here's an example:
28204
28205 @lisp
28206 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
28207 @end lisp
28208
28209 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
28210
28211 The abilities can be:
28212
28213 @table @code
28214 @item mail
28215 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
28216 @item post
28217 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
28218 @item post-mail
28219 This back end supports both mail and news.
28220 @item none
28221 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
28222 different.
28223 @item respool
28224 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
28225 articles and groups.
28226 @item address
28227 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
28228 true for almost all back ends.
28229 @item prompt-address
28230 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
28231 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
28232 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
28233 @end table
28234
28235
28236 @node Mail-like Back Ends
28237 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
28238
28239 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
28240 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
28241 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
28242 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
28243
28244 @lisp
28245 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
28246 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
28247 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
28248 @end lisp
28249
28250 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
28251 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
28252 mail.
28253
28254 This function takes four parameters.
28255
28256 @table @var
28257 @item method
28258 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
28259 the call.
28260
28261 @item exit-function
28262 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
28263
28264 @item temp-directory
28265 Where the temporary files should be stored.
28266
28267 @item group
28268 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28269 performed for one group only.
28270 @end table
28271
28272 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28273 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28274 find the article number assigned to this article.
28275
28276 The function also uses the following variables:
28277 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28278 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28279 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28280 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28281 this:
28282
28283 @example
28284 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28285 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28286 @end example
28287
28288
28289 @node Score File Syntax
28290 @subsection Score File Syntax
28291
28292 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28293 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28294 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28295
28296 Here's a typical score file:
28297
28298 @lisp
28299 (("summary"
28300 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28301 ("Gnus"))
28302 ("from"
28303 ("Lars" -1000))
28304 (mark -100))
28305 @end lisp
28306
28307 BNF definition of a score file:
28308
28309 @example
28310 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28311 element = rule / atom
28312 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28313 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28314 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28315 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28316 quote = <ascii 34>
28317 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28318 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28319 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28320 date-header = "date"
28321 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28322 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28323 score = "nil" / <integer>
28324 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28325 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28326 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28327 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28328 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28329 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28330 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28331 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28332 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28333 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28334 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28335 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28336 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28337 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28338 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28339 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28340 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28341 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28342 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28343 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28344 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28345 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28346 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28347 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28348 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28349 eval = "eval" space <form>
28350 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28351 @end example
28352
28353 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28354 discarded.
28355
28356 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28357 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28358 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28359 one looong line, then that's ok.
28360
28361 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28362 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28363
28364
28365 @node Headers
28366 @subsection Headers
28367
28368 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28369 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28370 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28371 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28372
28373 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28374 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28375 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28376 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28377 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28378 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28379 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28380
28381 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28382 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28383 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28384 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28385 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28386
28387 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28388 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28389
28390
28391 @node Ranges
28392 @subsection Ranges
28393
28394 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28395 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28396
28397 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28398 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28399 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28400 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28401
28402 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28403 sequence.
28404
28405 @example
28406 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28407 @end example
28408
28409 is transformed into
28410
28411 @example
28412 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28413 @end example
28414
28415 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28416 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28417
28418 @example
28419 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28420 @end example
28421
28422 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28423 is slightly tricky:
28424
28425 @example
28426 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28427 @end example
28428
28429 and
28430
28431 @example
28432 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28433 @end example
28434
28435 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28436
28437 @example
28438 (1 2 3 4 5)
28439 @end example
28440
28441 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28442 also valid:
28443
28444 @example
28445 (1 . 5)
28446 @end example
28447
28448 and is equal to the previous range.
28449
28450 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28451 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28452 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28453 range handling.)
28454
28455 @example
28456 range = simple-range / normal-range
28457 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28458 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28459 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28460 number *[ " " contents ]
28461 @end example
28462
28463 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28464 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28465 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28466 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28467 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28468 sequences.)
28469
28470
28471 @node Group Info
28472 @subsection Group Info
28473
28474 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28475 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28476 describes the group.
28477
28478 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28479 second is a more complex one:
28480
28481 @example
28482 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28483
28484 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28485 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28486 (nnml "")
28487 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28488 @end example
28489
28490 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28491 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28492 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28493 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28494 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28495 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28496 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28497 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28498 this section is about.
28499
28500 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28501 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28502 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28503
28504 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28505
28506 @example
28507 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28508 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28509 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28510 group = quote <string> quote
28511 ralevel = rank / level
28512 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28513 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28514 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28515 read = range
28516 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28517 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28518 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28519 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28520 @end example
28521
28522 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28523 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28524 in pseudo-BNF.
28525
28526 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28527 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28528
28529 @table @code
28530 @item gnus-info-group
28531 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28532 @findex gnus-info-group
28533 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28534 Get/set the group name.
28535
28536 @item gnus-info-rank
28537 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28538 @findex gnus-info-rank
28539 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28540 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28541
28542 @item gnus-info-level
28543 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28544 @findex gnus-info-level
28545 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28546 Get/set the group level.
28547
28548 @item gnus-info-score
28549 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28550 @findex gnus-info-score
28551 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28552 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28553
28554 @item gnus-info-read
28555 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28556 @findex gnus-info-read
28557 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28558 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28559
28560 @item gnus-info-marks
28561 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28562 @findex gnus-info-marks
28563 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28564 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28565
28566 @item gnus-info-method
28567 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28568 @findex gnus-info-method
28569 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28570 Get/set the group select method.
28571
28572 @item gnus-info-params
28573 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28574 @findex gnus-info-params
28575 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28576 Get/set the group parameters.
28577 @end table
28578
28579 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28580 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28581
28582 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28583 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28584 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28585 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28586
28587
28588 @node Extended Interactive
28589 @subsection Extended Interactive
28590 @cindex interactive
28591 @findex gnus-interactive
28592
28593 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28594 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28595 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28596
28597 @lisp
28598 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28599 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28600 ...
28601 )
28602 @end lisp
28603
28604 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28605 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28606 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28607 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28608 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28609 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28610 @code{interactive}.
28611
28612 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28613 adds a few more.
28614
28615 @table @samp
28616 @item y
28617 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28618 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28619 variable.
28620
28621 @item Y
28622 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28623 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28624 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28625
28626 @item A
28627 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28628 function.
28629
28630 @item H
28631 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28632 function.
28633
28634 @item g
28635 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28636 function.
28637
28638 @end table
28639
28640
28641 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28642 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28643 @cindex XEmacs
28644 @cindex Emacsen
28645
28646 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28647 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28648 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28649
28650 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28651 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28652 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28653 Gnus, that's very useful.
28654
28655 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28656 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28657 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28658 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28659 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28660 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28661 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28662 following function:
28663
28664 @lisp
28665 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28666 (start-itimer
28667 "gnus-run-at-time"
28668 `(lambda ()
28669 (,function ,@@args))
28670 time repeat))
28671 @end lisp
28672
28673 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28674 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28675 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28676 all over.
28677
28678 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28679 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28680 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28681
28682 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28683 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28684 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28685
28686
28687 @node Various File Formats
28688 @subsection Various File Formats
28689
28690 @menu
28691 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28692 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28693 @end menu
28694
28695
28696 @node Active File Format
28697 @subsubsection Active File Format
28698
28699 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28700 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28701 in each group.
28702
28703 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28704
28705 @example
28706 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28707 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28708 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28709 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28710 no.general 1000 900 y
28711 @end example
28712
28713 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28714
28715 @example
28716 active = *group-line
28717 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28718 group = <non-white-space string>
28719 spc = " "
28720 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28721 low-number = <positive integer>
28722 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28723 @end example
28724
28725 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28726 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28727
28728
28729 @node Newsgroups File Format
28730 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28731
28732 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28733 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28734 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28735 the user.
28736
28737 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28738 Here's the definition:
28739
28740 @example
28741 newsgroups = *line
28742 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28743 group = <non-white-space string>
28744 tab = <TAB>
28745 description = <string>
28746 @end example
28747
28748
28749 @page
28750 @node Emacs for Heathens
28751 @section Emacs for Heathens
28752
28753 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28754 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28755 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28756 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28757 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28758 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28759 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28760 cat instead.
28761
28762 @menu
28763 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28764 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28765 @end menu
28766
28767
28768 @node Keystrokes
28769 @subsection Keystrokes
28770
28771 @itemize @bullet
28772 @item
28773 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28774
28775 @item
28776 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28777 @end itemize
28778
28779 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28780 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28781 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28782 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28783 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28784 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28785
28786 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28787 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28788 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28789 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28790 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28791 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28792 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28793
28794 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28795 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28796 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28797 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28798 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28799 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28800 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28801
28802 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28803 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28804 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28805 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28806 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28807 it.
28808
28809
28810
28811 @node Emacs Lisp
28812 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28813
28814 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28815 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28816 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28817 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28818
28819 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28820 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28821 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28822 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28823 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28824 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28825 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
28826 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
28827 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
28828 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
28829
28830 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28831 write the following:
28832
28833 @lisp
28834 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28835 @end lisp
28836
28837 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28838 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28839 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
28840 change how Gnus works.
28841
28842 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
28843 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28844 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28845 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28846 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28847
28848 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28849 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28850 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28851
28852 Some pitfalls:
28853
28854 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28855 that means:
28856
28857 @lisp
28858 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28859 @end lisp
28860
28861 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28862 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28863
28864 @lisp
28865 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28866 @end lisp
28867
28868 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28869 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28870
28871 @page
28872 @include gnus-faq.texi
28873
28874 @node Index
28875 @chapter Index
28876 @printindex cp
28877
28878 @node Key Index
28879 @chapter Key Index
28880 @printindex ky
28881
28882 @summarycontents
28883 @contents
28884 @bye
28885
28886 @iftex
28887 @iflatex
28888 \end{document}
28889 @end iflatex
28890 @end iftex
28891
28892 @c Local Variables:
28893 @c mode: texinfo
28894 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28895 @c End:
28896
28897 @ignore
28898 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
28899 @end ignore